0% found this document useful (0 votes)
194 views236 pages

AText Bookof Mining Geologyforthe Useof Mining Studentsand Miner

This document provides information on several books related to mining, geology, and food supply. It lists the titles, authors, descriptions, prices and other details of publications from Griffin's Standard Publications including books on gold extraction, prospecting for minerals, new lands, mining law, and practical geology.

Uploaded by

Rakesh Ranjan
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
0% found this document useful (0 votes)
194 views236 pages

AText Bookof Mining Geologyforthe Useof Mining Studentsand Miner

This document provides information on several books related to mining, geology, and food supply. It lists the titles, authors, descriptions, prices and other details of publications from Griffin's Standard Publications including books on gold extraction, prospecting for minerals, new lands, mining law, and practical geology.

Uploaded by

Rakesh Ranjan
Copyright
© © All Rights Reserved
We take content rights seriously. If you suspect this is your content, claim it here.
Available Formats
Download as PDF, TXT or read online on Scribd
You are on page 1/ 236

G RI FFIN S S TA N DARD P U B LI G A T I ON S

T H E OV A N I B E P R O C E SS O F G O L D E " T R A C T I O N B y .

J A M ES P A R K T H I R D ENGL I S H E D I T I O N I n lar g e 8 v o
F u ll y I ll u s t ra ted C l o th
. .
,

. . 73 . 6d .

EW L A N DS
N H U G H R O B ER T M I LL B s L L D P r o p ti e A dv t g : Th eir R eo re s u c s and s ec v an a es By
F ll y I ll s t ra ted 5
.

, . e .
,
. .
,
u u . 8 .

R O S P E C T I N G FO R M I N E R A L S A Pra ti l H db o ok By
P s H ER B ER T c ox
. F G S TH E mm I ll t ra ted 5 , . . . I RD
.

on .
c ca
us
an
. 5 .
.

FOO D S U P P L Y B y R O B E RT B R U C E W i th A pp ndi x . e on P RE
R D F D b y C A M I T C H E LL M A F I C 4 6 d
.

SE VE OO S . . , . .
, . . . s . .

M I N I NG L A W O F T H E B R IT I SH EM P I R E . B y C HA RL ES
J ALFO R D ,
I n C ro wn 8v o C l ot h 83 6 d , . . . net .

I DS I N
A T OL OG Y P R AC T I C A L G E O LO G Y . With a S e tio n
c on PA L E ON
B y R OF P G RE N V I LL E COL E F G S F I FT H E ITI D O N
Revi s ed
. .
.
, . .
,

. 1 08 6d . .

P E N -A I R S T U D I ES I N G E O LO G Y By P G REN VI L LE
O COLE ,
S E CO N D E DI T I O N , Revi s ed
.

. P r of u s e l y
R O F.
I ll u s t ra ted . 88 6d. .

S S A YI N G B y J J B E RI N G ER an d C B ER I N GER
A F C S
. . . N I
.

N T H ED I T I O N
. .

,
R ev ise d . Wi th
,

Di g a ram s . 108 6d . .
.
,

M ET A L L U R G IC AL ANAL YSI S A N D A SS A Y I N G . A T hre e


Y e ars
C ou r s e f o r tu de n ts o f S c h oo l s o f

in S
B y W A M es M A C LE O D B A B Sc
a n d C H A S WA L K F u ll y I ll u s t ra t e d ER s
. . . .
, .
, . .
,

,
F C S . 12 6d . . . . . . net .

A T E" T -B OO K O F E L E M E N TA R Y M E T A L L U R GY B .

A H U M B OL D T
. S E" T ON ,
F C S . . . T HI RD E D I T I ON Revi s ed I ll u strate , .

Gs .

E TT I N G G OL D A G old-m in in g Ha n dbook fo r Practi c a l M e n


G J C F J OH N S O N ,
.

T H I R D E D IT I O N Re vis ed
B y
Wi th P la te s and
.

I ll s ra ti o s
.
. . .
,

u t n 3s 6 d . . .

O L D S EE Kl N G IN S OU T H A F R I C A B y T H E O KA S S N E R
G I n o C
r wn 8 v o u y F ll I ll s tra ted u With C ha p te r on t h e Ag r i c u l t u ral P rosp e c ts of
. . .

o h A ri a
. .

S ut f c 4 3 6d . . .

YAN I D ING G OL D A N D SI L VER O R ES B y H F O R B ES


C JU L I A N an d E DG AR S M ART Wi th nu m e ro u s
.

M ap s ,
.

Pl at e s an d
I u ll s tra io
t ns . 21 3 n e t . .
, ,

O RE A N D S T ON E M IN IN G . B y S I R 0 L E N E VE FOS T ER
S
.

E D I T IO N R e vise d E n l arg e d
,
D Sc , F R S I" T H and b y B EN N ET T H B R O U G H ,
i I ll s t ra t io s
. . . . .
, .

F G 8 W th 7 1 5 u
. . n . 34 s .

T HE E L E M E N T S O F M I N I N G A N D QU A R R Y I N G By
0 L E N E V E F OS T ER D S c W i th n e arl y 300 I ll u s t rat i o n s
.

SI R . FR S , . .
, . . . . 7s 6 d
. .

ne t .

L A S T I N G : A N D T H E U S E O F E " P LO S I V E S By OS CAR
B G U T T MA N N S E CO N D E D IT IO N t h o ro u g hl y Revi s ed
.

I n l a rg e
Wi th I ll u st ra t i o n s a n d F ol ding P la te s 10 3 6 d
, , .

8vo . . . .

L O N DON : C HA R LE S G R I FF I N 8: C O .
, L T D .
,
E" ET ER S T R EET , S T R A N D .
A T E" T B OOK DE -

MI N I N G G E OL OG Y
FO R T H E U S E OF MI N I N G S T U D EN T S
A N D M I N ER S .

JA M ES I A RK
P B OW
' Z
R OF HI N I F Q A N D MI N I N G
,

EOL OG Y ;
G
D I R EO I O B O F OT A G O U N I V ER S I T Y S C HOO L O F M I N E S

M E MB E R OF T H E I N S T I T U T IO N O F M I N I N G A N D M ET A L L U R G Y ;
M E M B E R O F T H E AM ER IC AN I N S T IT U T E O F M I N I N G EN G I N EE R S
FEL L O W OF T H E G EO L OG I CA L S OC I ET Y O F L O N D O N ;
L A T ] P R ES I D ENT OF T H E N EW Z E A L A N D
I N S T I T U T E OF m 9 EN G I N E ER S .

m m: 7 8 s umma tions anb 3 p late s .

C H A R L ES G R I FF I N CO M P A N Y , L I M I T ED ,

E " E TE R S T R EE T ,
S T RA ND .

1 90 6 .

[ A l l R ig h ts R e served ]
P R E F A CE .

I T i s only in rec e nt y e a rs tha t M in i ng G e ology has b e e n r e garded


as o f s u f c ie n t impo r tanc e to warran t i ts e l e vation to the di g ni ty
"

of a distinct depa rt ment in t h e M ining Schools a n d Colleg e s of


'

E nglish speak i ng communi t ies F or long e nough it was t r eate d


-
.

as a subord i nat e subj ect b e ing taught for th e most pa rt as


,

an introduc ti on t o th e principl e s of mining a t a time in h i s ,

academic car ee r when t he young und e rgradua te posse ssi n g no ,

pe rsonal e xp e rience of or e bodi e s as t hey oc c u r in N ature was


-
,

l e as t abl e to gra sp t h e t ru e b e aring of the s ubj e c t i n i ts


relation to th e economics of th e mining indus t ry I n th e .

mining acad e mi e s of Contin e ntal E urop e e con omic g e ology has


,

always occupi e d a prom i n e n t and respec te d place .

Th e ma t ter i n the follow i ng pag e s compris e s a series of


l e c t ur e s issued i n Bulle t in for m at t h e e nd of 1 90 2 T h e .

e xhaus ti on of that li ttl e publicat ion has e ncourag e d t he au thor


to pr e s e n t t h e sam e mat te r i n t h i s revi s ed a n d e nlarg e d form .

The n e w chap te rs on O r e s and Mi n e rals Consi de re d E conomi



cally , Mi n e Sampl i ng and O r e Valua t ion and Th e E xamina
-
,

ti on and V aluation of Mi n e s hav e b ee n added t o comply w i th the


requir e men t s of th e n e w curr i culum for th e as s ociate d iplomas -

in M ining Met allurgy and G eology


, , .

Th e g e nes i s of or e d e posits is a subj e ct surr o u nd e d by ma n y


'

perplexing problems Th e ch ie f dif c u l ty en c ountered by th e


.

tea cher is t hat th e g e neral i sat i ons have no t yet been crys tall i sed
in forms s u f c ie n tly de n it e to be un i versally a cc e pted as rs t
principles .

The publication of th e lat e Professor P ose pn y s classic pap e r

on T he G enesis of O re D ep osi ts in 1888 may b e sai d to


'

-
vi P R EFA C E .

hav e mark e d t he beginning of a new era in the history of


e conomic geology Since that dat e t he lit e ratur e of the subj ect
.

has been e nriched by the writings of V ogt S t e lzn e r B e ck , , ,

de L aunay Van His e Rickard Becker E mmons G r e gory K e mp


, , , , , , ,

Chamberlain L indgren Weed Spurr Sir C L e N eve Foster


, , , ,
.
,

S H e rbert Cox G renville Cole and oth e r distinguished g e ologists


.
, ,
.

The Am e rican School has not e ndorsed th e e xtreme vi e ws of


P os e p n y or the fascinating th e ori e s of S a n db e rg e r but gradually
, ,

d e v e lop e d a c onception lying somewher e betw e en th e two with ,

a d i st i nct leaning towards th e t e achings of th e form e r .

With r e spect t o M in e Sampling and Va lu a t ion it is manifest ,


that no hard and fast rul e s can b e lai d down O i Am e rican .


,

E nglish and G e rman mining e ngin ee rs with whom th e author


,

has be e n associated i n min e e xam i na ti on i t is noteworthy that ,

all w e r e agr e ed as t o the prim e ess e n t ials although d i ffe rin g ,

within ce rtain small limi ts in mat te rs of procedure and routine .

D iiTe r e n c e s in minor details must always e xist wh e r e men vary


i n e xp e rience and temperament .

Stud e nts r e ading for advanced work a n d honours will n d a


f e rtile e ld of r e f e r e nce in such e xc e llent works as T h e G enes is
of Or e D ep oszts publ i sh e d by th e American I ns t i t u t e of M ining
'

-
,

E ngine e rs 5 the treatis e s on O r e D e pos i ts by S te lzn e r Beck -


, ,

Phill i ps and L ouis T h e S a mp lin g a nd Va lu a tion of M ines


, ,

by R i ckard ; t h e spl e nd i d M emo i rs and Repo rts of the G eological


Surv e y of th e Unit e d States ; and t h e valuabl e pap e rs scatt e r e d
thro u gh th e Transact i ons of th e Am e rican I nstitut e of M ining
E ng i n ee rs of th e I ns t itut i on of M in i ng E ng i n ee rs of th e
, ,

I ns ti tution of M ining a n d Me tallurgy and of th e N ew Z e aland ,

I nsti t ute of M ining E ngin ee rs Th e acknowl e dgmen t s of th e .

author are due t o th e writers of th e s e pap e rs and to fri e nds


in many places for much valuabl e assistanc e in th e pr e paration
of these pages .

T H E AUTH O R .

U N I V E RS I T Y , DU N ED I N , N . Z .
,

Al a rch 1 90 6 .
CO N T E N T S .

CHAPT ER I .

I N T R O D U CT O RY .

P A G E
T he Sc ope d P r
an po e o f G eo
u l ogy
G eosl ogi l S tr c t re o f t h E rth ca u u e a

B egi n i ng o f G eo l ogi l T im T h A tio n o f W ter i D t y i g


n ca e e c a n e s ro n

d R fo rm i ng T h E rth C r t m o tly S edi m e t ry T h


an e -
e a s us s n a e

Al terati on o f S edim ent rie F o il C onte t G eolog i al T i me a s ss n s c

m arked b y D i ti n ti ve L i fe O rig in o f I gne


s c R oc k O w ou s s ver o

R o k
c D
sy ke R o k P l to n i B oc e Asl te r ti o n o fu I gn eo c ss s a us

R o k
c M etal
s d M i neral i I gn eo
s an Ro k T h I s of n us c s e n u e nc e

D y k Cl i ti o f I gneo
es a ss ca R o k I m po rtan e
on f Petro us c s c o

C HAPT ER II .

C LAS S I F I CAT I ON OF M I N E R A L D E P OS IT S .

Ba i o f Cl i ti M orph o logi l Cl i ti S p i l
s s a ss ca on ca ass ca on u er c a

D epo it G old Pl er Ri ver Pla er I m t i Pl er B la k


s s ac s c s cu s r n e ac s c

S and B e h e D eep Le d o f V i t ia C em ent Pla er D y


ac s a s c or c s r

bl owi ng P la r F orm o f A lluvi al G o ld A o iate o f A ll vial


ce s s ss c s u

Go l d O rig in o f A ll ial G o ld S tre m T i O rigi n o f S tre m T i


uv a n a n
Plati m P l er P latin m i R
nu ac ia d A m eri a Iron S and
s u n u ss an c

Pl G m P l er D iam ond Ru by S app h ire Ma ive D


ac e l s e ac s, , ,
ss e

po it B g Iro A tion o f De endi g Water S alt B orax


s s o n c sc n s

G y p m S l ph
su S t t i d D epo it S trike n d D ip o f Bed
u ur ra e s s a s
I l inatio n o f Bed T h i kne
nc f B ed Exam pl e o f B edded
s c ss o s s

Depo it C oal Origi


s s d F o rmatio M od e o f O nrr e an n cc u e nc

A g In l i ed Po itio n Fa l ti g E xt ent o f Fa l t Intr i e


e c n s u n u s us v

Dy ke s d th eir E t Irreg laritie B endi g o f S eam


an
'

ec s u s n s

V rietie o f C o l R d B anket Ree f Ma feld Copper S h ale


a s a an s ns s
S il ver S an d to ne o f U tah L ead S and tone o f Pr
s s i Copper s uss a

C o gl o merate o f L ke S perior C oprolite B ed G y p m Bed


n s a u s su s
U t ti ed D epo it
n s ra Depo it o f V o l ni Origi S to kwork
s s s s ca c n c

D epo it Conta t d Repl ement D epo it Fahl b nd I m


s s c an ac s s a s

p g
re n ti a S egreg ate
on s d V ei n Ga h V ei T r e Fi Vein s s ns u ss ure s,

Vl l
C O N T EN T S .

CHAP T E R III .

ORE V E I N S T H E I R F I LL I N G ,
A G E S T RU CT U R E WA L L M OV E M E N T S
, ,

P A Y S H OO T S , ET C .

F i lli n g o f C vitie nd Vei Origin o f Vein C vitie A g o f Vei


a s a ns a s e n

lli g Wi dth o f L o de L e gth S troke In l i nation D epth


n s n c

A rr gem e t o f L ode MatterHor e i Vei O t rop o f Vein


an n s s n ns u c s s
-
Co ditio o f Metall i Content Po ition o f Valuable Co te nt
n n c s s n s
- P y S h oot G o l d Bo na z Wal l M ov m ents I
a s of n as e n u enc e

Cou n it y Pro d ti ve Z o e Verti l D i trib tio


uc o f Ore n s ca s u n s

S e o dary E i h m e t o f V ei I m po e i h m e t o f V ei
c n nr c n i ns v r s n ns n

D epth I di ator B ed P rage e i T em perat re i D eep


n c s a n s s u s n

M i i g Re ordi g R ook T em perat re L i m it f D eep M i ni ng


n n c n u s s o

M t o mati Repl eme t


e as c ac n

CHAPT ER IV .

T H E D Y NA MI CS OF L on s s A ND B E DS .

D e n ition o f Fa lt Fa lt par llel with B dD ip F lt S tep


u s u s a e au s

F lt T ro gh Fa lt R le fo In li ed L ode Z i mm erm n
au s u u s u s r c n s a

s

G raph i M eth o d
c ,

C HAPT E R V .

O R E D EP O S I T S G E N ET I CALL Y CO N S I D E R ED .

G e eti
n c g ti eg eg tio C o ite Peri dotite
Cl as s i ca tion M a ma c S r a n hr m in
i ke o ti e Coppe P ti
N c l Ir n N a v et O e form ed by
r la nu m M a l s r s
Eru pti e A te tio o t i A tio o A e i g A lkal i e
v f r ac n S l fa ar c c n f s c nd n
-
n

Water F ma oli Cont t M et m orph i D epo it Regio l


s u r c ac a c s s na

M et m orph i D epo it M eteori W ter O rg ni


a c s s c a s a c,

C HAPT ER VI .

T H E O R I ES OF VE N I FO R M AT I ON .

Eru ptive Pro e e T h eoryc ss s of L ateral S e retio


c n A en io o f S ol
sc s n u

tion S mm y
s u ar ,
C O N T EN T S . ix

C HAPT ER VI I .

O RES A N D M I N E R A L S C ON S I D ERE D E C ON O M I CA L L Y .

PA G E
Al um A l um in i u m A ntim ony A r eni
s c A bes t
s os A ph altum
s

C opper Cry ol iteDiam on d F irec lay Fl o rite G old G raph ite u

G p sum Iro n Lead Magn e ite Man gane e s M i ca M l b s o


y y
de a m
h N i kel cO il S h al e Petroleum Ph o ph ate R oc k s

Platinum Qui k s ilver S ilver S late S ul ph nr T alc T i n


c

CHAPT ER VI I I .

M INE -
S AM P L I N G A N D O R E -V AL U AT I ON .

S am lp in g E q ipm ent S am pl i g Interval Rec ord o f S m ple


u n s a s

B reaki g th S m ple S m p l in g R ed tio n o f S m p le A ay o f


n e a a uc a ss

S am ple Cal l ating V l


s cu F t P o pec t S m ple Val e
a uem u u re r s s a u s

an d M i ll Val e S am p ling D um p
u s d He p s an a s,

C HA PT ER I" .

T H E E" AM I N AT I ON AN D VAL U AT I ON or MIN ES .

Valuatio n o f M etal M ines De vel oped M in es a n d G o ing Conc ern s


Class ica tion o f O re in a M ine V al ua tio n o f Coa l A reas Va l ua

I N D E"
MI N I N G G EOL OG Y .

C H A P T ER I .

I N T R O D U CT O R Y .

CO N T E N T s z T ope n d P rp o e o f G eology G ologi l S tr t r o f


he S c a u s e ca uc u e
th e Earth Begi n i g o f Geo l ogi l T i me T h
n n A tion o f Wat r i
ca e c e n
D e troyi g d Re f mi n h Ea rth C r t m o tly S ed i ment ry
s n an -
or n e
'
s us s a

Th e A l teratio n o f S e d i m e tarie F o il Co nte n t G eo logi al T i me


n s ss s c
marked b y D i ti cti ve L i fe O rigi o f I g neou R o k U
s n w Ro k
n s c s ver o c s
D y ke R o k P l to i B o e A l t r tio n o f I gneo
c s u n c ss sR k M etal e a us 01 s s
an d Mi eral n I gneo
n s i R o k T h I us o f Dy k Cl i ti
c s e n ue n c e es as s ca on
o f I gneo R k I m po rta e o f Petrogr phy
us oc s nc a .

T he S cope a nd P Th e s t udy of
u rp o s e of G e o lo g y .
-

geology i s unde rta ken by two classes of student Th e r e is the .

pa t ient investigator who in th e intere sts of p ure sc ien c e wi t hout


, ,

hope of material gain is conten t not only to know t ha t a roc k i s


,

compos e d of min e ral mat ter but extends h i s researches to th e ,

investigation of t h e origin compos i tion and structure of th e rock


, , .

Then th e re is the ut i l itarian who v i ews a mineral from a com ,

m e r c ia l sta ndpoint and i s w illing to undergo a spec i al cours e of


,

tra i n i ng i n orde r to be able to d i stinguish the valuabl e from the


bas e a n d worthl ess .

Th e sci e nce may therefore b e divided into Theoretical G eology ,

which i nves t igate s the or i gin a n d s t ructur e of the rocky crus t of


t h e e art h ; and E conom i c or Mi ning G eo logy which b e ars mor e ,

direc t ly on m i ning and th e dev e lopment of t h e min e ral i ndus t ry


, .

A knowl e dg e of th e fun dam e ntal pr i nc i pl e s of th e rs t is n e cessary


to unde rs tan d t h e s e con d and for th i s reason e v e ry m i ning s tu den t
,

sho u l d prepare himself for his prof e ssion by going thr ough a
s s t e r a t ic cou rs e i n G e neral G eology
y n
.

It i s sa t isfactory to obs e rv e that many of t h e mos t e minen t


mining engine e rs in E urope Am e rica a n d Aus t ralia ar e d i stin, ,

ui s h e d g e ologists Wha t a n atomy is to the modern surgeon so


g .
,

i s g e ology to t he mining profession .


2 MI N I N G G EOLO GY .

G e o lo g ic a l S t r u c tu re of th e
The cr u st of the E a rth .

earth is th e great r e posi t ory of m i nerals and metals and there ,

for e a brief consideration of its orig i n and structur e will afford


a bett e r understanding of the ma n ner i n which ore bodies and -

mineral deposits occur


-
.

B e g in n ing O f G e o l og ic a l T im e G eological ti me date s .


-

back to the rs t beg i nning of th e phys i cal co nd i tions w hich now


pr e vail upon the earth To make th i s clear i t will be ne c essary
.
,

to trace the evolut i on of the earth to its pres e nt form .

Accord i ng to astronomers and physic i sts the earth l i k e many , ,

c e l e st i al bodies at the pr e sent tim e once e xisted as a nebular ,

mass of glowing in c andescent gases s winging through space B y .

the rad i ation of its b e at this globe in t he cours e of countl e ss


, ,

ag e s became s u f c ie n tly cool for a t hin skin or crust to form on


,

the ou t er surfac e B y th e cont i nu e d radia t ion of the h e at the


.
,

crust became thicker a n d th i ck e r and in a tt e mp t ing to adap t


, ,

i tself to the smaller dimensions of the molt e n mass below b e came ,

crumpled and rucked up into ridges and valleys lik e the sk i n of ,

a drie d u p appl e
-
.

I n the course of time the scarred and gnarled ign e ous crust
b e came cool enough to p e rmit the condensation of the watery
vapours which e nvelop e d th e e arth Th e wat e rs settl e d in t he .

hollows and formed the rs t seas that ever existed on th e fac e of


,

th e globe .

Th e restl e ss wa t ers of the n e w born s e as at onc e b e gan to wear


-

away the dry lan d and the streams draining th e valleys t o de e p e n


,

and w i d e n their channels Th e denu ded material was spr e ad out


.

in lay e rs a n d b e ds on the rocky oo r of the seas t hus marking the ,

b e ginn i ng of the conditions of sedim e ntat i on that have e xisted


w it hout int e rrup ti on up to the present day Th e se ancient fresh .

water sedim e nts wer e the rs t r e cords of geological time .

T he A c t io n o f W a te r in D e s tr o y ing a nd R e -fo rm ing .

F rom t hat date up till n o w water has cont i nued to be t h e most


,

pow e rful agency i n sculptur i ng and modifying the surface of the


e arth I n wast i ng a n d e roding t h e dry land in transporting th e
.
,

e rode d mat e rial i n sorting and spr e ading it ou t the action of


, ,

water has b e en unceasing throughout all t i m e .

N o portion of t he original igneous crus t or ev e n of th e rs t ,

form e d sed i men t s has ever b ee n found 5 but shr e ds and patches
,

may still ex i st buri e d beneath t he deposits of lat e r t i m e s


, .

Th e amount of matter forming th e e ar t h is prac ti cally a xe d


quanti ty ; h e nc e it is e vid e n t that all the d e pos i ts and b e ds now
forming t he surfa c e of the e arth must hav e been derived from t h e
d e s t ruc ti on of the r s t igneous cr u s t or of sedime n tary rocks of ,

later date .
INT R OD U CT O R Y . 3

E v e r sinc e t he b e gi n ning of g e ological time the dry land h as


be e n d e nud e d by wa te r yieldi ng the ma t erial to form ne w depos its
,

in seas and lak e s Through the contin u al crumpling of th e cr ust


.

of th e e a rth th e se d e posi t s in course of t ime beca m e dry land


, ,

and in t he i r turn were subj ected to the ag e nts of erosion aga i n


, , ,

yi e ld in g ma te rial to form s t i ll n e wer de pos i t s or s tra ta This .

a c t ion i s still going oh t h e older formations pro viding th e material


,

for th e youn g e r .

Th e sa m e mat e rial has app eare d r e sorted in di fferen t fo rms i n -


,

diff erent geolog i cal ag e s It is now ea sy to und e rsta nd how some


.

of th e older forma t ions have been entirely remove d by t his ever


last i ng denudation or are represented only by isolated remnants
,

of small extent .

T h e E a rt h C ru s t m o s t ly S e dim e n ta ry A
exa m ina

s . n

t ion of the crust of t h e ea rt h shows that it is c omposed p rincipally


of s tra ti e d rocks t hat is rocks occurring in parall e l bed s or

,

layers A stu dy of the materials forming th e s e roc ks and of the i r


.
,

fossil cont e n t s shows u s t hat t h e y hav e be e n formed by t h e


,

gradual depos it of s e dimen ts on the oo r of some sea or lake in ,

some cases by precipitation f rom solutions or by the growth and ,

a ccumulat i on of animal or v e ge table organi sms .

Th e physical s t ruc t ure of sedimentary or clas t ic rocks as t h e y


are some ti m e s called i s depend e nt on three main fac tors nam e ly , ,

the textur e of th e mater i al the charac t er of th e cemen t ing ,

medium and the amount of i ndura t ion alte ration or m e ta


, , ,

morph i sm to wh i ch th e mat e rial h as b e e n subj e cted .

Wa t er has possess e d through all t im e t h e sam e eroding trans ,

por ti ng and so rting power and what w e now s e e go i ng on in our


, ,

vall e ys a n d on our shores i s a fair exampl e of what took pl ac e in


earliest g e olog i cal ti m e .

Th e grav e ls on the shores formed conglom e rates t he water


born e sands formed sandston e s t h e mor e d i stan t muds beca me
shales wh i le the l itt oral shell beds and coral reefs b e ca me lime -

ston e s.

T h e A l t e ra t io n O f S e dim e n ta rie s The ol der sedimen ta ries .

hav e be e n subj e ct to all th e la t er mov e ments wh i ch have affe cted


t he crus t of t he ear th Th e y hav e b ee n indurat e d by t he gr e at
.

we i gh t of sup e rincumben t s t ra ta plica ted a n d con to rt e d by ,

e n tangl e m e n t i n grea t ear th folds and alt e red by the s i multa neous
-
,

act i on of pr e ssur e h e a t and c i rculating th e rmal wa t ers Thus


, , .

l i mes ton e s hav e b ee n changed to marbl e s sandstones to quar t zi te , ,

muds tones and shales to slat e s or schis t .

F o s s il C o nte n ts E xamina ti on h a s shown that th e earl ie r


.

e xis ti ng stra ta con ta in a f e w ind i stinct and badly p res e rved


rema i ns of plants and an i mals of a very primi t ive and lowly type .
4 MININ G G EOLOGY .

Beds highe r in the su c cession are found to contain a large and


varied assemblage of plant and animal remains many of a highly ,

compl e x stru c tur e such as molluscs sh e s huge bird like lizards


, , ,
-
,

saurians palms and tree ferns Th e higher or younger depos i ts


, ,
-
.

contai n besides molluscs and s h e s the remains of many


, ,

mammals wh i ch have r e presentatives living at the present tim e .

I n other words th e re has been a gradual succ e ssion of life in t i m e


,

from the lowly to the more highly organised forms .

G e o lo g ic a l T im e m a rk e d b y D is tin c tiv e L ife Ex .

h a u s tiv e i nvestigation has shown tha t c ertain o r ganic forms occur


only in certain beds S uch fossils are termed characterist i c or
.

d i stin c tiv e fo rms G eologists have taken advan t age of these to


.

divide g e ological time into periods j ust as histori c t ime is divided ,

into periods by succeed i ng dynasties or empires These periods .

are pur e ly e m pirical and are used for c onvenie n c e of des c ription
,

and study .

G eological time embraces three great periods which are further ,

subdivided as shown below


Recent .

T E RT I AR Y or Cainozoic , Pliocene .

M iocene .

E ocene .

Cr e taceous .

SE C O N D A R Y, or M esozoic J u ra ss ic .

Triassic .

Permian / .

Carboniferous .

D e v om a n
P R I M A RY , or Pal aeozoic .

Silurian .

Cambrian .

L aurentian
.

Su c h terms as Permian D evonian etc ar e time names , ,


.
, ,

cover vast eeon s When a ro c k is said to be of Mi ocene age a


.
,

reference to the table will sho w that it is comparatively young


whereas a rock of S i lurian age is one of extreme antiquity F or .

purposes of clos e inv e stigation these time periods ar e sometimes


,

st i ll further subdiv i ded by geologists .

O gr i in of I g ne o u s R o c ks Throughout all time the outer


.

shell or crust of the earth has been subj ect to the in t ru s ion a n d '

o v e r o w of molten magmas from below ; and there is abundant

evid e nce tha t these igneous intrusions or outbursts were more


frequent more v i olent and more widespread in earlier than in
, ,
6 MININ G G EOLOGY .

of s u perheat e d steam has often caus e d a rearrang e ment of th e


cons t ituents 5 while th e circula t ion of th e rmal waters has led to th e
elimination of some and the substitution of other constituents
, ,

of secondary origin M oreov e r it is found that intense meta


.
,

morphism may cause alter e d lavas and tu ffs to assume a sch i stos e
structure not unlike that induced in altered sedimentaries .

M e ta l s a n d M in e ra l s in I g n e o u s R o c k s N o volcanic .

ro c k of recent date is known to contain m etall i f e rous deposits of


commercial valu e Traces of gol d silver and most of the base
.
, ,

me tals have been found in modern lavas ; but the only minerals
of economic importance associated with these rocks ar e sulphur
and gypsum both of se c ondary origin
, .

The M iocene andesitic lavas and tu s of the Sie r ra N evada and


'

Cripple Creek districts in America 5 Transylvania and Banat in


Hungary 5 of Borneo and Sumatra in M alaysia 5 and of Hauraki
Peninsula in N ew Zealand contain gold and silver bearing veins
,
-

of great value in which ores of c opper lead and zinc a r e some


, , ,

times pr e sent .

A ow of andesite near the M anukau Heads in N e w Zealand


contains large grains of native copper an o c currence which is ,

rare and ther e fo re of great s c ie n ti c inter e st .

V olcani c tu s and lavas are also the m atrix of diamonds opals


, ,

and other precious stones .

T h e I n u e n c e o f D y ke S D yke rocks are not often them


.

selves metalliferous 5 but they have exerc is e d a potent in u e n c e


on the distribution of metallif e rous deposi t s M any valuabl e .

v eins of gold and copper occur in t h e vicinity of dyk e s 5 and

although t h e re is little de n ite knowl e dge concerning the origin


of v e in matter it s e ems fair to assume tha t the intrusion of the
-
,

dyke material originated fractures and s su r e s in the adj acent


-

c ountry which then became channels or tracks for the c irculation


,

of mineral laden wate rs .

I ntrusive bosses suc h as those of granite are oft e n impregnated


, ,

with tin ston e near the contact wi t h sedim e n t ary s t rata ; and in
-

other cases the sedimentary rocks in the n e ighbourhood of th e ,

granite are traversed by valuable veins of tin and copper


, .

The association of tin veins and granite bosses is too frequent


to be a mere coinciden c e 5 and we ar e comp e lled t o conclud e that ,

in some way which is not very clear to u s t he vein and its ,

contents are connected with th e presence of th e boss .

Th e int rusion of the boss may possibly have til t e d and fractured
the surrounding rocks 5 or th e boss may hav e been the anvil
against which the softer and more yielding sedimentaries were
crushed and fractured by the lateral stresses initiated by the
se c ular folding of the c rust of the earth I gneous magmas are .
IN T R OD U CT O RY . 7

cha rged wi t h water and gas e s D ur ing the process of cooling .


,

mos t of t he wate r and gas e s ar e e xpe ll e d as highly hea t ed s te am


and , as will b e shown la te r on t h e r e i s much e vi de nc e to ,

s uppo r t t h e b e l ie f tha t t h e s t eam a nd gas e s w e r e laden w it h


d issolv e d me tals which wer e af te rwa rds d e posi t ed in t h e zon e of
,

C las s i c a t io n o f I g n e o u s R o c k s F or ou r pre s e n t pu rpos e s


.
,

igneous rocks may b e c lass ie d i n three principal and e as i ly dis


tin g u is h a b le gr ou ps as foll ows :

C la
ss . Vo lca ni c T y pe .

A . Basic ,
Ba sa lt .

B I nte rmedia t e Andes ite



. .
,

c Ac i dic ( Tra m m
.
,
( )
b Rhyoli t e .

The types wh i ch have proved th e mos t productive ar e diabase ,

diori te and e si t e and granite


, ,
.

I m p o rt an c e Of P P et rography was form e rly a


e t ro g ra p h y .

narrow branch of gen e ral geology Oi late years i t has de .

v e l o ed into a d istinct sci e nc e wh i ch conc e rn s it s e lf c h ie w i t h


p , y
t h e minu te structur e compos it ion a n d nom e ncla t ure of i gn e ous
, ,

and crys ta llin e rocks a n d al t hough th e general i sa t ions of p et ro


,

graphy hav e l ittle bear i ng upo n t he ph e nomena of s t ruc t ural


g e ology i t is ne e dful t ha t e v e ry geolog i s t should have an
,

i ntima te knowl e dge of its l e ading f e a t ur e s .

Val u able m i nerals a r e so frequ e n tly ass ociated wi t h i gn eous


rocks that it seems imposs i ble to avoi d the c onclusion t ha t a clos e
g e n et ic r e la t ionship exists b e tw e e n t h e m What th i s r e la t ion s h i p .

r e ally is has y e t to be de t e rmin e d in th e maj or ity of or e


deposits .

Ro ck forming constituen ts are now known to s e pa rate in t h e


-

coolin g magm a i n a de n ite order and t h e inv e s ti ga t ion of t h e ,

laws gov e rn i ng magmat i c d i ff er e n t ia t ion prom i ses t o throw much



l i ght on the gen e s i s of ore d e pos i ts .
C H A P T ER I I .

C LA S S I F I C A T I O N O F MI NE RA L D E P OSI T S .

C ON T E N S T B i o f Cl sic ti

T he M ph l g i l C l i ti
as s as a on w
or o o ca a ss ca on

S p u i lerD epo its


c aG o l d P l er R i v ersP l er L tri e Pl r ac s ac s ac u s n ac e s
B l k S nd Bea h e D eep L e d o f Vi t n Ce me t P l er D y

ac a c s a s c o a n ac s r

b l o wi g P l er F orm o f All vial G old A o i te o f A ll vi l G o l d


n ac s s u ss c a s u a

O igi o f A ll vi l G o ld S t e m T i O rigi n o f S tr am T m P l ti
r n u a r a n- e a n u in

P l er Pl ti m i R ia d A meri Iro S nd P l er G m
ac s a nu n uss an ca n a ac s e

Pl er D i m o d R by S pph ire Ma i ve D epo it Bog Iro


ac s, a n , u , a ss s s n
A tio f De e ding Water S l t Bor x G y p um S lph r
c n o sc n s a a s u u

St t i
ra d D epo it e S trike n d D ip sf B e d I c l i ti n o f B ds ?
s a o s n na o

e

T hi k e c o f B ed Ex m ple f B edded D epo it Coal Origi n d


n ss s a s o s s n a

F or matio M o de o f O n r ence A g In l i ed Po itio F lti g


cc u r e c n s n au n

Exte t f F l t Intr i e D y ke
n o au d th ei r E t Irreg l riti
s us v s an ec s u a es

B e din g o f S e m Varietie o f Co l R d B k t R ee f M
n a s feld s a an an e s ans

Coppe S h le S i lver S nd to e o f U t h L d S d tone o f Pr i


r a s a s n s a ea an s u ss a
C opper Co gl o m r te o f L ke S perior Copro l ite B d G p m
n e a s a u e s sn
B ed U st t i d D epo it D epo it
n s ra e f V o l n i O rigi S to w o rk
s s s s o ca c n c

D epo it Co t t d Rep la m t D epo it F h l b n d I m preg n


s s n ac an ce en s s a a s a

tio S egreg ted Vein G a h V i T r e F i re Vei


ns a s s e ns u ss u ns .

T he B as is o f C las s i ca tio n M inera l


d e posits are found . .

in so many di ffe rent forms and und e r so many varying con ditions , ,

that t he attempts of different writers to formulate a c la s s ic a tion ,

found e d upon a natural basis have not b e en attended with much ,

success I n any case it must be r e memb e red that a c la s s i c a tion


.
,

i s only an e mpiri c al arrangement intended to facil i tate the study


and investigation of min e ral d e posits .

The maj ority of the c lass ica tion s hitherto proposed are based
upon either (a ) morp h ologica l or ( b) g en etic consi de rations or ( c) , ,

a comb i nation of the two .

The rs t principles of ore d e positio n are st i ll imperf e ctly -

understoo d The most diverse th e ori e s ar e still advanced by


.

em i n e nt authori t ies ; and it is doubtful if a theory has y e t been


for rn u la t e d that will sat i sfy all the cond i tions and explain all the
r
iacts .

The basis for a natural c la ss ic a tion has still to b e discovered .

U n ti l then outward form and mod e of o c currence seem t o


,

8
C LA S S IFI C A T I O N OF M I NE R A L D EP O S I T S . 9

o ff e r the mos t conveni e nt sta rting poin t for th e el e mentary -

Th e more advan c e d s t udy that is the philosophical inquiry as, , ,

to t he origin p e rs i stenc e a n d probabl e valu e of or e d e pos its can


, ,
-

only be pursued wh e n some knowledge h as b e en acquir e d of th e


fun damen tal laws of or e forma t ion I n t h i s case t he inv e s ti ga t ion
-
.

mus t b e pu rsued from the g e n et ic standpo i n t .

I Ve w i ll rs t deal with mineral d e pos i ts from t h e mo rphological


and aft e rwa rds from the genetic standpoint .

M O RPH O L O G I CA L C L AS S IFI CAT I O N .

A simpl e c las s ic a tion of v e ins and mineral de posits bas e d ,

upon out wa rd form and mod e of oc curr e nce but e ntir e ly in de p e n ,

dent of ag e or mineral charac t er is as follows ,

Cl a ss l S u pe r c ia l
. .

Class II S tra ti ed
. .

Class III U n s t ra ti e d . .

F or descriptive purposes thes e clas ses may be subdivided into


,

groups or sub cl a sses


-
, as u nder

I . S U P ER F I C I AL D EP O S IT S .

( )
a F r a g me n ta ry F orming all uvial drif ts .

( )
b M a ssi ve F orming laye rs and sheets .

I I S S T RA T I F I ED D E P O S I T S .

( )
a Con stitu ting bed s F o rming m e mbe rs of a s t ra t i e d

formation .

( )
b D is s em in a ted th ro u g h a bed .

I II .
U N S T R AT I F I ED D EP O S I T S .

( )
a D ep os i ts of v ol c a n ic or ig in .

b
( ) S to c k w o r k d ep os its .

( 0 ) Con ta c t a n d r ep la ce ment dep os its .

( d ) F a h l ba n d s .

( ) 8

(f
(g ) G as h v ein s .

( )
h T r ue
ss ure v e ins .
10 MINI N G G EOLOG Y .

CL ASS I
SU P E R FI C I A L D E P OSI T S .

( ) a F rag me n ta r y .

D enitio n f o These embrace alluvial deposi t s


P la ce r D ep os ita
of all kinds whether beach sands river gravels lake deposi ts or
, , , ,

glaci e r drifts containing loose particles of gold tin ore pla t inum ,
-
, ,

iron ores or precious stones They also includ e the alluvial deep
, .

leads or deep placers of California V ictoria and N ew S outh


, , , ,

Wales which are often cov e r e d with a sheet or sheets of basalt


, ,
.

G o ld P la c e rs .

That po r tion of the drift in whi c h the gold is c o n centrated is


termed p a y wa sh p a y dzr t or p a y s trea k When the pay wash is

- - - -
, ,
.

covered by a considerable d e pth of gravel drift or other cover it is ,

termed a deep lead -


.

M e th ods of working P la cera Alluvial drifts a cc o rding to thei r ,

situation are worked as follows


,

( 1 ) B y ground or gravitation sluicing with water not under


pressure .

tha t is ground sluicing with water under


( ) y
2 B hydraulicking ,

pressur e .

( )
3 B y hydraulicking and elevating wi t h water under pressur e .

This method is only resor te d to wh e n the con g u ra tion of the


ground renders it impossibl e or too costly to construct a tail race , ,
-

for gravitation sluicing I t is worked wit h much success at the


.

Blue Spur and o t her claims in Ne w Zealand .

( ) y bucket and suction d redges when the mate rial is mainly


4 B ,

or partly b e lo w wat e r level as for example on sea beaches mari


-
, , ,
-
,

time lagoons lakes rive r beds and river a ts


, ,
-
,
-
.

E xa mp les of G old P la ce rs F amilia r examples of gold bearing .


-

gravels are the alluvial drifts of V ictoria W e st Aus t ralia Klon , ,

dyke California Ne w Zealand and Altai M ountains in C e ntral


, , , ,

Sib e r i a .

G old b earing beach sands containing iron sa n d mostly magnetite


-
, ,

occur along th e shor e s of Westlan d and Southland in N ew Z e aland , ,

and the G old Coast of West Afr i ca .

Among later alluvial gold discoveries that at Cape N ome in , ,

Alaska is th e mos t important A sloping plane or tundra extend s


, .

from the s e a back to th e foot of t he mountains I t cons i sts of .

a succession of b e ds of sand gravel and clay res t ing on the , ,

upturned edges of the Pal aeozoic basem e nt roc k The su rfa c e is .


C LA S S IFI C AT I O N or MIN ER AL D EP O S I T S . 11

covered with a layer of tundra moss and decaying vege ta ble peaty
matter to a depth of 18 inches or 2 4 inches Th e gold b e a ring .
-

matter is foun d along the beach being appar en tly a rewash or ,

concentra t e of the tundra gravels and sand .

T h e tundra gr avels bear no e vid e nc e of glacier o r igin bu t ,

appear from th e ir bedd e d and wate rworn ch ara cter to have b ee n


de posited in a lakeb a sin or in a shallow sea n e ar th e estuary of a
'

large r iver .

G lacier D r ifte Count ry that was once overrun by glacie rs is


to contain two classes of tra n spo r ted matter on e trans

FI G . l .
S ectio n o f G lac ier abo ve Termi al F e n ac .

( a ) M orai nes .
(c) G lacier tu n l n e .

( b) B ement ro k
as c .
(d ) Gl i r i
ac e ce .

porte d by ice the other by water The rs t forms tumbled


,
.

morainic m a sses the latter water worn gravels and sands deposited
,
-

FIG . 2 .
S ectio n o f G lac ier Valley .

( at ) G lac ier m o rai nes .


(c ) B as e ment roc k .

( b) G lac ier grave ls .


( d ) G lac ier ri ver .

by the river which dra ined the botto m of the gla c ier Both .

class e s are o ften mixed a t c e rta i n points When th e co un try i s .

gold bearing the glacier gravels and morainic matt e r conta i n gold
-
,
.

The mo ra i nes are formed by ic e which cannot s e para te th e gol d


from the rock debris ; hen c e the gold is scatt ered thr ough i t j us t
as the glacier happ e ned to drop it The gl a cier gravels on t he .
,
12 M I NIN G G EOLO GY .

other hand being larg e ly a rewash of the moraines c ontain the


, ,

gold in a more conc e ntra t ed form .

M any of the gold bearing t erraces in N ew Zealand a nd in the


-

h i gh e r valleys of the Rocky M ountains bear e vi dence of glacier


r i ver orig i n while som e are compos e d of a rewash of glacier
,

grav e ls and morainic matter .

P os ition of P a y Wa sh E xperien c e has shown that alluvial gold


-
.
-

i s deposit e d along the inner side of the curves in the course of the
river Any stratum of good grav e l in the opposite bank was
.

e vidently laid down at so m e pr e vious time under similar conditions ,


.

The accompanying diagram (g 3) shows the distribution of th e .

pay wash Th e gold is coars e st at the h e ad of the bar gradually


-
.
,

b e coming n e r and s c arcer and spreading ou t below until th e , ,

dirt is too poor to pay 8 0 long as the river r e tains its course
.
,

FIG . 3 . P lan o f R i er cour


v -
se , s h o wm g po ition o f gravel
s s .

th e pay streak will continue to form as the bar is ext e nded


-

y e ar to year .

Th e average uniform size of the gravel seems to show that th e


gold i s only deposit e d where the current has a cer tain medium
velo c ity A t the points wher e th e bends in th e river ar e mad e
.

more permanent by rocky banks th e pay gravel is generally deep e r ,


-

and of greater ext e nt than elsewh e re .

The richest gold does not collect in the de e p pot holes in th e -

river as might naturally be expected but on t h e bars or rocky


, ,

l e dg e s below The reason for t his may be that pot holes g e ner
.
-

ally occur in narrow rock bound parts where the v e locity a nd


,
-

scour of the water are t oo great to p e rmit the p e rmanent


lodgment of the gold particles .

P os ition of G old in D r if te I n alluvial deposits the gold is


foun d in a layer of pay wash resting either on t h e s la te or s ch ist
-

bottom or on a fa lse bottom


,
I n r iver and creek workings th e
-
.
,
14 MI N l N G G EOLOGY .

been tilted almost on edge thereby greatly in c reas i ng the difc u l


,

ties of work i ng th e pay wash with success -


.

B l a c k S a n d B e a c h e s The washing of b e a c h sa nds is a .

for m of alluvial m i n i ng pu rsued on the sea b e aches of Westland -

and Sou thland in Ne w Z e aland The black sa nd is princ i pally mag .

n e tit e d e rived from the disint e gration of the neighbouring rocks .

The gold occurs in excessively n e particles and is found con ,

c e n tr a t e d wi t h the black sand in layers along the sea beach the ,

laving act i on of the r e tr e ating waves removing the lighter par


t ic l e s of quartz sand .

D e e p -L e a ds o f Vic t o ria The buried placers of this sta te .

are of great ext e nt and value They may be ta ken as typi cal of .

a c lass of d e posi t also found in California They consist of gold .

FIG . 6 .
S e ctio n
h o wi ng L acu strine G old bearing Wash ( A fter Park )
s -
. .

( a ) Rece n t g ravel s ( d ) Carbo n aceou s san ds


. .

( b) Gray q u rtz s a n ds
a
( e ) G o ld b eari n g wa s h
.
-
.

( c) Ferrugi n o us qu artz sa n ds ( f ) S ti ff c lay ( g ) S ch i s t. . .

bearing gravels c overed by a single o w of basalt or by a succession ,

of thin ows separat e d by b e ds of gravel .

The gold bearing pay wash lies on the oor of an c ient river valleys
- - -

i nto which the lava streams poured from crater vents and ss u re s -

situat e d in the higher lands T h e ancient valleys when c ompara .

t iv e ly narrow were g e nerally ll e d w i th the ign e ous magma to


such a d e pth as to cause the dive rsion of the str e ams in t o n e w
channels I n some cas e s the area was invad ed by oods of
.

lava which ov e r owe d the d i str i ct for hundreds of squar e miles


a n d bu i lt up great basaltic plateaux on the sites of the river

valleys and watercourses .

Wh e r e t h e r i ver valley down which the lava pou red was wide
-
,

the magma g e n e rally spread itself over t h e gravels in a thi n


stream Th i s caused only a temporary or partial dive rsion of the
.

river in s u f c ie n t i t would seem to compel the river to n d a new


, , , .

outlet in another river system - .


C LA S S IFI C A T I ON or MINER AL D EP O S I T S . 15

Where a success ion of g ravel beds and basalt ow s occurs ,

may b e inferred t hat t he t hin o ws only t empora rily div e rted


w h i ch ma intained i ts o riginal wat e rshed un ti l the
ion of material had re a ch ed such a h e ight as to com
CA M P HI L L

s rn c r J DI A R D
'

F I G 7 C ro ss
. e tion o f B
-s c a lla rat G olde ld s h o wi ng deep le
,
-

un derly i n g b lt a sa .
( A fter R B rou g h S my th )
. .

p l e t echok e u p the old valley wher e by the wate rs were enabl e d


ly ,

to command a n e w ou t let t hrough some low saddl e or pass i nto a


neighbouri ng wat e rs hed .

S i nce th e em i ssion of the ba sa l t s the coun t ry has b e en di ssec t e d


WIN ?" FL A 1
a n' u ll c n u n u m S rk t

t r

FI G . 8 S. e tio o f Deep le d B ll rat G ld l d h o wi g


c n -
a a aa e io n o f o e ,
s n s u cc ss

lav w
a d ri er g ravel
o s an ( A fter R B ro g h S m y th )
v -
s . . u .

by streams a n d sc u lptur e d into the e xist i ng ri dges plate aux and , ,

valleys I t is no t ic eable t ha t t h e new r i v e r cours e s are s e ldom


.
-

coinc i d e nt w i th th e old wh i ch s ti ll l i e bur i ed und e r their load of


,

gravel and basalt exc e p t at th e po i n t s wher e t he i r cours e has been


c rossed by th e ne wer t ransve rse streams .
16 MININ G G EOLOGY .

This process of denudation h a s in some c ases removed th e


barriers which bounded the ancient riv e r valley Thus the oor -
.

of the old valley with its cap of hard basalt now forms a t
topped
, ,

ridges wh i le the hills wh i ch formed the barriers have b een worn


,

down into valleys and water c ourses .

a b

FIG . 9 . ection o f M o nt Gree o k h wi g protective effe t


S
-
u n c ,
s o n c s

o f ba lt p ( A fter R Bro gh S my th )
sa ca . . u .

( a ) W a h d i rt
s -
.
( ) W a h di r t de rl y i g b a sal t c s -
un n .

E xi ti g w t r o
s n e (d ) Ex i ti g waterco r e
a e c u rs . s n u s .

The pay wash in the deepleads of V i c toria generally lies at th e


-

base of t h e buried gravels resting in a rocky gutter or channel c u t


i n the bas e ment rock .

FIG . 10 S
. e tion o f Deep Le d i D y le ford D i tri t h o wing po itio n
c -
a n a s s c ,
s s

o f gold beari g w h ( A fter R B S my th )


-
n as . . . .

The d ee p leads accord i ng to the contour of the ground are


-
, ,

worke d by shafts or from adit levels ,


-
.

m
C e e nt P la c e rS G old bear i ng grav e ls have sometimes
.
-

become consol i dated into hard cements or even conglomerates , ,

by th e cementing a c t i on of iron peroxide carbona t e of l i m e or , ,

s l i ca deposited from waters whi c h at one t i me circulated through


i
t em .

Ce m ented placers are found in all g e ological formations from

the S i lurian up to the pres e nt day The most important a r e of .

recen t a n d young e r T e rt iary age .

T h e quartz grits and conglom e rates which form t h e coal


measures of the M ioc e ne brown coals of N ew Zeala n d are gol d
bearing throughout O tago Westland and Ne lson ; but only in a , ,

f e w places ar e t h e y rich enough to be wo rked for thei r gold con te n ts .


C LA S S IFI C AT I O N OF MIN ER AL D E POS IT S . 17

Th e i mpo rtance of t h e se old pl a ce rs lies ma i n ly in the c i rc ums tanc e


tha t many of the richest pl ace rs of a rec e n t or Pleistoc en e da t e
"

deriv e d their gold from them by a proc ess of na t ur al c oncentrat i on .

C e m e nted gold bearing gravels mostly s u p e r c ia l are comm on


-
, ,

e nough in all alluvial e lds and many notabl e examples ar e found ,

in Californ i a and Central Sibe ria more es pecially in old river ,

chann e ls .

G old b e ari ng cements of a unique kind oc cur a t K i ntor e


-
,

Kanowna Kalgoo rli e a n d e lsewhere i n We s tern Aus t ral i a Th e y


, ,
.

d i ffer fr om th e u v ia tile wa te r worn gr avels wh i ch form th e -

c e ments in N ew Zea land and Californ i a Ac c o rding to R ic ka rd l


.
,

th ey consis t variously of in te rmingled clays sands gr i t s kaolin , , , ,

P H} . 11 S .e tion a ro S late Ri ver Co ili g wood N w Z e l d h o wi g


c c ss , n , e a an ,
s n
go ld be ri g ement belo w e m o f c oa l ( A fter P rk
a n c s s a . a .

1 .
Quartzites .

2 . B ro w c o l ly i g go ld be ring ceme t
n a n on -
a n .

3 . G o ld be i ng egregated q rtz vei th e so rce o f gold in cement


-
ar s ua -
n, u s .

4 .
Qua i tzite s .

broken rock iron s tone and qua rtz in most cases r esting in
,
-
,
2
shallow depre ssions .

Th e ir o ri gin i s due to pe c uliar geologi cal and c l i matic conditions .

T h e cl ima te is s e mi trop i cal Th e surfac e h as been expos e d to -


.

sub a e rial in u e n c e s sinc e probably th e e arly pa rt of t he S e condary , ,

p e rio d and i s des


,
t itute of running s t r e ams The ma te r i als a r e .

t he prod ucts of long cont i nued a t mospheric d isintegration a n d -

erosion ; They wer e transpo rt ed to th ei r present plac e s by the


a ct i on of wind rain and ood waters I n no case has th e ma te r i al
, ,
-
.
,

or con ta i ned gold travell e d far from the parent sourc e The , .

w ork i ng of the c e men t s a t Kalgoorli e l e d to th e dis c overy of t he , ,

more valuable lode formations -


.

1
T . A .T he Rll u v i k rd
c a ,

A ial D epo it o f We ter A tr l ia s s s n us a , T r a ms .

A m I n st M i n E ng , v ol xx v iii
. . . . . .

2
T B 1a tc h ford, B u ll etm N 0
. . 3, G eol . S u r vey f
o Wester n A u s tr a l za .

P t
er h , 1 8 99 .
18 MININ G G E OLOGY .

l-
o
D ry b w ing P la c e rs A s a r esult of the long continued .
-

sub aerial disint e gration the surface of the a t country around


-
,

Kalgoorlie has b e com e covere d by a d e posit of red sandy loam ,

ben e a t h wh i ch there is oft e n blu e clay This material which occurs .


,

most fr e quently at the h e ad of shallow gulli e s i s mix e d wi t h ,

frag m ents of iron ston e and a l i t tl e quartz d e rived from the gol d
-

bearing lodes l n th e vicinity .

The gold i n th i s loos e sur face material 18 obtained in the absenc e ,

of water by th e method peculiar t o Australia known as d r y


, ,

blowm g wh i ch consists of screen i ng shaking and dry blowing


.

-
, , , ,

( Plate L ) .

F o rm s o f A l lu v ia l G o l d E xcepting the large r nugg e ts


. ,

which have been found of all shap e s and sizes up to thousands ,

of ounc e s t h e coarse gold g e n e rally assumes a beanshaped


,

form .

The n e r gold occurs as small heavy shots but more often as ,

thin ake s ranging from the smallest particl e which almost oa ts


, ,

in wa t er to pieces l i ke bran
, .


I n riv e r claims where the gold has been deriv e d from the denu
,

dation of gold bearing lodes fragments of quartz with a dhering


-
,

pi e ces of th e precious metal are often met with .

A s s o c ia te s O f A l l u v ia l G ol d The constant asso c iate of .

alluvial gold i n all countri e s is magnetit e sand the agenci e s whi c h ,

led to th e c on c e nti a tion of the gold having also collect e d th e mor e


abundant magn e tite I t is found t hat whatever h e avy or e s or
.

m i nerals ar e associated w i th the gold 1n the original country rock -

are also found wi t h it in the r e sul t ing alluvial drift s .

I n Collingwood in Ne w Zealand considerable quantiti e s of


, ,

na ti ve lead i n the form of round sho t have b ee n found for many


, ,

years in the slui c e boxes with the gol d I n places it i s so


, .

abundant as to choke up the rippl e s Samples collected by th e .

author and submitt e d to ch e mical e xaminat i on disclose d the fac t


, ,

that t h e l e ad is almost chem i c ally pure and somet i m e s e ncloses a ,

skeleton of gold .

I n Takaka near Collingwood the alluv i al gold besides magn etite


, , , ,

is as sociated with gray Coloured grains of osm i um ir i dium a n d


-
, ,

platinum ; in O repuk i with one ounce of platinum for e very,

hundred ounces of gold 5 on the West Coast and in the or ds wi t h


garn e ts locally known as rubi e s 5 and in Central O tago with large
,

mass e s of sch e el i te and m agnetit e .

Throughout Austral i a the alluvial gold is oft en associated


with gem sands containing t opaz zircon spinel rubies and , , , ,

garnets .

O rig in o f A ll u v ia l G o ld Alluvia1 gold originat e d from th e .


-

we a thering and denudation of country containing gold bearing veins -


20 MININ G G EO LO GY .

S T RE A T I N
M -
.

O rig in Of S tre a m T in from the - .


S t ream tin or i g i nated
-

surface disin t egration and denudation of tin bearing lod es or of -


,

granitic mass e s containing tin impregnations -


.

T h e T in P l a cer s of M a la y s ia The tin e lds of M alaysia are .


-


of great extent and value the tin beari n g belt extending south ,

w ard from Burmah and S i am through t he M alay P e n i nsula to , ,

t he outlying islands of Banca and Billiton o ff th e sout h e ast coast ,

of Sumatra .

The tin bearing gravels are deposit e d on the o or of th e valleys


-

which in t ersect th i s rich zone of metall i ferous country .

The geolo g ical f e atures throughout are almost the same The .

basement rock is granite which i s variously overlain by gneiss , ,

schis t sla ty shales sandstone and limeston e


,
1
,
Tin stone has been .
-

found in situ in veins traversing both the granite and slates and ,

disseminated as impregnations in the granite near the contact


2
with the sedimentaries and also in the limestone The stream
, .

t i n was manifestly d e rived from the t in bearing veins and rock -


,

and con c entrated in the gravels by the rive rs and their lateral
streams .

I n many places th e gravels r e st on a fa ls ebottom of s t i ff kaolin ,

derived from the disint e gra t ion of t he granite out c rops Th e y .

vary from 1 t o 1 5 feet thick and are overla i n by an ov e rburden ,

ranging from 5 to 80 feet d ee p Th e richness of the grav e ls .

varies from 5 1b to 4 0 lb p e r cub i c yard . . .

The tinstone of this reg i on is very pure generally containing ,

from 7 0 to 7 5 per c e nt of the metal The colour is oft e n . .

black a n d sometimes pale brown or white The ore is found in


, ,
.

pi e ces of all sizes from n e sand to bould e rs half a ton in w ei ght


, .

Th e associated m i nerals are magnetite and ilmen ite .

The States of Perak Selangor N egri Sembilan Pahang and the , ,


-
, ,

D utch E ast I n die s yi e ld two t hirds of th e world s produ c ti on of



-

ti n O i these the Sta t e of Perak produces about one th i rd and


.
,
-
,

the Sta t e of Selangor on e th i rd of the total output 3 -


.

The tin plac e rs in the Kinta V alley in the S tate of Perak , ,

cov e r an ar e a 4 0 miles long and about 2 5 miles wid e and yi e ld , ,

about three fourths of the tinston e raised in Perak I n 190 4


-
.

Perak produced tons of t in .

Oth er T in P l a cer s There ar e stream tin mines in Burmah


.
-
,

S i am and China and in the Commonw e alth of Australia in th e


, , ,

States of N ew South Wales Queensland V ictoria and Tasman i a , , ,


.

1
R A
. . F . P ro e
en s , Jr
. J ou r n a l f
o G eol ogy , Fe b 1 903 . .

2
Pe ro e
n s , Z oe . ci t .

F O we i i g i Perak vi

3
. n, M n n n ,
T r a ns I . ns t . M in . a nd M et .
,
v ol . .
p 5 1
. .
C LA S S IFI C AT I ON or MIN ERAL D EP O S I T S . 21

The stream tin deposits of Co rn wall and Saxony have long b e en


-

P l a tin u m P l a c e rs .

P la tinu m in R u s s ia N early
p e r cen t of th e platinum of 90 .

commerc e i s found as loose grains in th e grav e ls of t h e r i vers


draining th e e astern slop e s of t h e Ural M oun tains The grav e ls .

g e nerally con ta i n some a lluv i al gol d .

A li tt l e plat i num has b e en found in situ in p e r i dot i te a n d


olivine gabbro bu t not i n pa yable quantity Ultra basic e rup t iv e s
-
,
.
-
,

and somet i me s chloritic a n d ta lcos e sch i sts pr e vail in th e ne i gh ,

b o u rh ood of t he pla t in u m plac e rs 5 and fragm e n t s of th e se rocks


pr e dominat e in the sands and gr av e ls t hereby i ndicat i ng pr e t ty ,

conclusiv e ly that t he noble me tal was derived from th e adj acen t


a r ea by the o rdina ry proc e sses of wea th e r ing and e rosion .

P l a tinu m in A m e ric a The domestic supply of pla t inum


.
-
,

in th e U nited S tates is obta ined from the gold place rs i n T rini ty


,

and Shasta counties California The gold drif ts in Colomb i a in


, .
-
,

Sou t h Am e ri c a B raz i l Bri t ish Columbia and N ew Zealand also


, , ,

yield a small quanti ty of the metal .

Platinum is always alloyed with a small propo rtion of iridium ,

and oft e n with a smaller amount of osmium .

I ro n s a n d P la c e rs .

E normous depos its of black iron sa n d mostly t i ta nif e rous exis t , ,

on t he c oas t of Chili ; on th e nor t h shore of the S t Lawr e nce i n ,

Canada 5 on th e coa st of California 5 and in Ne w Zealand 0 11 t h e ,

coast between Taranaki and Wanganui .

Th e s e ir ons a n d d e pos its wer e d e rived in mos t cas e s from , ,

weath e red and denud e d later eruptive roc ks n e ar t he coas t l i n e ,


.

I n some parts of th e coasts of Cal iforn i a and Ne w Zea land t h e ,

black san ds con ta in payable gold .

G em P la c e rs .

D ia m o nd P l a c e rs River d e posits yield diamonds ,


. ubies r ,

sapphires and other pre c ious stones The diamon ds of Braz i l


,
.

and N ew South Wal e s are obtained from gravels The diamond .

place rs of the V aal River in Sou th Africa y ie ld gems of grea t


, ,

size and purity .

R u b y P a c e rs
l The princ i pal ruby produ c ing region in
.
-
,

Burma is situated near M ogok about 90 miles d u e north of


, ,

M andalay Th e r ubies are usually found in a somewhat tenacious


.
22 MINI N G G EOLOGY .

clay or in material passing from n e gravel to r iver sa nd T h e


,
.

country rock is a v e ry hard gneiss passing in pla c es into gra n ite 5 ,


l
or a soft friable mi c aceous s c h is t .

The district of Chantabun in S iam has long be e n famous for , ,

its ruby and sapphire min e s .

S a p p h ire P l a c e rs I a the sapphire e lds of A n akie in .


,

Queensland the wash is often c layey and sometim e s friable and


, ,

free from clay I n these deposits are also found oth e r pre c ious
.


stones notably ruby diamond topaz peridot moonstone cat s
, , , , , ,

eye and cairngorm


,
.

( )
b M a s siv e .

D epositsof this class o cc ur as layers or sheets and irregular , ,

masses lying on the surfa c e or cov e red with soils surfac e clays
, , , ,

e tc of rec e nt accumulation They include deposits of bog iron


.
,
.
-

ore and in some places those of manganese and rock phosphate


, ,
-
.

B og iro n D e p o s its -
Bog iron generally occu rs as i rr egular .
-

layers or l e nti c ular masses which were deposited in shallow lak e s ,

or swamps .

The iron in the maj ority of c ases was d e rived from lodes or
, ,

deposits of iron in the adj a c ent country The decomposition of .

iron bearing minerals has doubtless contributed its po rt ion of


-
, ,

iron E xtensive beds of bog iron are oft e n found near the o u t
.
-

crops of pyritic lodes and of beds of th e carbonate ore , . .

When iron pyrites is oxidised a large portion of it passes into ,

salts soluble in water 5 while carbonate of iron is read i ly solubl e


,

i n wat e r containing dissolved carbonic acid Atmospheric .

w eath ering must therefore daily liberate a large amount of iron


, ,

in a soluble fo r m .

I t is well known that wh e n chalybeate waters are e xposed in


shallow sheets as in ponds lagoo n s and swamps to the actio n of
, , , ,

the air the i ron is deposited as the carbonate Fr e sh ly pre


, .

c i ita t e d iron may be fr e quently seen in s t agnant pools in swamps


p .

The precipitation is caus e d by the action of atmospheric ca rbon


dioxide I n some cases the iron is thrown down as the hydrated
.

oxide by decomposing vegeta ble products .

Bog iron ores are porous and cindery in structure They


-
, .

contain in many cases too h i gh a propo rtion of phospho r us to be


, ,

useful for smelting pu rpos e s .

A c tio n o f D e s c e n din g W a te rs Whe r e su pe r c ial ore .

bodies have been fo rmed by the a c tion of descending wate rs i t ,

will be found as a ge n eral ru le that the waters have merely acted


, ,


1
T . T . W y nn e ,

T h e Ru y M b i nes o f Bur a m h , T r a ns . I ns t . M in . a nd
Jll et v ol . v. 1 897, p 1 6 1 . .
C LAS S IFI C AT I O N OF MIN ERAL D EP O S I T S . 23

upon and concentrate d or e s d i ss e minat e d in th e adj a cent coun t ry


rock Such seconda ry c oncentra t ion i s often s ee n i n th e case of
.

i ron mangan e s e a n d phosphate d e pos i ts


, , .

A t ypical exampl e of t h i s class of or e body is the gr e a t deposi t -

of limon ite at Parapara i n Ne w Z e alan d wh i ch occurs as an ,

irr egular shee t of or e ly i ng on t he surfac e in a d e pression form e d


in Pal aeozoic schis t The or i gi nal sourc e of the iron is t h e sch i st
.

and associated l i m e ston e .

E xampl e s of th e same k i nd ar e foun d in P e nnsylvania 1


Th e .

ores are larg e ly limoni t e Th e y occur as rounded or elonga t e d .

fragments w i th r e sidual clay i n irr e gular d e pos i ts i n ca viti es ,


.

Th e source of th e iron is th e Pal aeozoic shales and lim e s tone in


which the primary iron is dis s e mina t ed in t he form of carbonate ,

sulph i de and silicate , .

FIG . l 2 S e c tio n
. at
Pe yl nia F rn c O b k h o wi g depo ition
th e nns va u a e re - an ,
s n s
o f li m o ite b y de e di g water i th b ddi g n d j oi t plane
n sc d n n s n e e n a n s , an

n od lar iro n o r i h o llo w i l i me tone ( A fter T C Hopki )


u es n s n s . . . ns .

Th e mangan e se d e pos its of Cartersvill e in t he Sou t hern


Appal a chians of the Sta t e of G eorgia are among t h e most impo r t ,

ant in America They occur e mbedd e d i n a thick d e pos it of


.

res i dual clays ma i nly d e rived from t he d e cay of t h e Beav e r l i me


s ton e a n d Weis n e r quartz i tes of Cambrian age .

Acco rd i ng t o T L Watson the ore is distribu te d irr e gularly


2
. .
,

throughout t he clays in the form of pockets l e n t ic ul ar masses , ,

veins and string e rs single nodules and concr et iona ry mas s e s 5 and
,

as small diss e min ate d grai n s I n extreme cases the la rges t .

poc k e ts may yi e ld as much as s e veral hundr e d to ns of or e Th e y .

are rarely composed of so l i d ore t he usual form being t ha t of ,

nodules thickly studded through the clay .

O i the mangan e se oxid e s wh i ch occur pyrolus it e and milom e la n e ,

1
T C . . Hopki ns, B u l letin G e ol .S oc A m .
, v ol . xi .
p 4 75
. .

2
T L . . W t on a s , T h e M an g eean s Ore Depos its o f Georgia ,
T r a ns A m . .

I ns t M E.
,
v ol . xxxi v . 1 90 4 , p . 2 22 .
24 MINI N G GEOLOGY .

greatly predominate Beds of limonite oc c ur separately or in


.

c lose asso c iation with the ma n ganes e ox i des forming mangan i f e rous ,

iron ores of varying grades of purity .

The imme di at e sourc e of th e mangan e se is held by Watson and


others to b e rocks from which th e r e si dual clays enclos i ng th e or e s
w e re derived The dissolution and concentrat i on of the manganes e
.

was effe cted by desc e nding waters charged with oxygen carbon i c ,

and organic acids .

I n th e Cav e Sprin g district in th e adj oining co u n ty th e , ,

mangan e se ores are c on n e d to r e sidual clays deriv e d from th e


Knox dolomit e stratigraphically h i gh e r than the quartzites a n d
limestones of Cartersville district M assiv e cherty beds occur in .

FI G . 13 S c
. e tio
n in o n e o f t h e O pe n in gs at th e D obbi n M i ne near Carte s ,
rs

i e eo gi
v ll , G r a , s h w n th e o i g o c c urrence f m n g ne e e in th re si du l
o a a s or e a

c lay s ( M odie d fr m nr
. o Pe o se by Wat on ) s .

A fragme nts
,
a nd m asse s o f parti lly decaye d ro ck ; B ma ng nes e o e
a ,
a r

C, resi dual cl ay .

Horizo nt al a n d verti cal scale ,


1 in = 1 0 ft
. .

the limestone in pla c es a n d the decay of the rocks in these pla c es


,

has formed manganiferous c hert breccias which howev e r are not -


, ,

of much economic importance Th e following figure shows the .

form of d e c ay assum e d by th e Knox limestone w h i ch is ascribed to


th e Silurian period .

The important mangan e se or e s of Roman eche ( S a one e t L oire ) - -

o c cur according to D e L aunay 1 bo th as ve i ns wh i ch traverse the


, ,

granite and as irregu lar shee t s in red clays intercalated in l i m e


stone Th e latter abut against a nearly v e rt i cal wall of grani t e
. .

The verti c al boundary between the granit e and th e Secondary


1
Pro fes s or L de Lau nay Comp tes R endus v iii S ession Congr es G ol I n ter
.
, ,
. e

n a tion Paris 1 90 1 p 96 8
, , . .
C LAS S IFI C A T I O N or MIN ERAL D EP O S I T S . 25

rocks is occup ie d by a v e in of mangane s e Th es e d e pos it s app e ar .

to b e pa rtly contac t or e s a n d pa rtly r e placem e nts of t h e lim e s ton e .

Th e valuabl e i ron deposits on th e M e s ab i rang e n e ar the nort h ,

shor e of L ak e S up e r i or are b e l ie ve d to b e du e to s e condary con


,

c e ntra ti on by t h e ac t ion of d e sc e nd i ng wa te r G reat bod i e s of .

or e l ie on the su rfac e and pass und e r h e avy d e pos it s of glac i al

S u p e r c ia l S a l t D e p o s it sThis subclass also i nclud e s t h e .


surfac e depos i ts of sal t i n Asia Am e rica a n d Aus t ral i a as w e ll as , , ,

t he valuable d e pos i ts at L ak e A l b e rt N yanza i n Af r i ca .

B o ra x D e p o s its A larg e proport ion of t h e borax of com


.

m e l e e i s obtained from muds a n d marsh s e dimen t s Th e muds of .

D agg e t t P a con ta i n valuabl e d epos i ts of sodium bora te as also


,
.
, ,

do t hos e of Turk e y Th e marsh e s of California and Ne vada also


.

y ie l d a small outpu t .

FI G . 14 S
. e tion i K o x D o lo mite 2 m i le ea t o f Ki ng ton G eorgia
c n n , s s s , ,

i ll tr ting de ay o f th m g e i n l im e tone by w o f undergro nd


us a c e a n s a s o u

water ( M d i d fro m S pen er by Wat o


s . o e c s n .

A re i d l l y B , g si lim tua c a ,
n1a ne s a n e s on e .

S u p e r c ia l y p s u m
G D o
e p s it s Gypsum is fo u nd forming .

thick b e ds on th e oor of crat e r lak e s i n volcan i c r e gions A -


.

notable e xampl e of th i s i s seen at Whi t e I sland in N e w Z ealand ,

w h e r e th e banks a n d oor of t h e c r at e r lak e are cover e d with an -

incrusta t i on of gypsum and sulphur many f ee t t h i ck .

G ypsum al s o occu rs as b e ds associated with calcareous and


arg i llac e ous rocks ; a n d i n d i sseminate d crystals i n clays and

S u l p h u r D e p o s its N ativ e sulphur occu rs most frequ e ntly


.

in volcan i c r e gions ofte n a s soc i ated with sulphur and c e lest i n e .


26 MININ G GEOLOGY .

I t occurs beds in the valleys of N ot e and M a z za ro in S icily 5 at


in
Solfata ra near N a ple s 5 also in J ava J apan and Ne w Z e aland
, , ,
.

C L ASS II .
S T R AT I F I ED D EP O S I T S .

( )
a Cons titu ting beds or s tra ta .

( )
b D issemin a te d th rou gh a be d .

( )
a Con stitu ting B e ds or S tr a ta .

S t rik e a nd D ip Of B e ds
bed or seam is a member of a A
s t ra ti e d formation the overly i ng layer forming the roof and the
, ,

und e rlying the oor .

The s tr ike of a bed or seam is the direction of a horizonta l line


drawn along the plane of the s tra ti c a tion .

The dip is the direction to wards which a bed inclines and is ,

always at right angles to the strike I f w e assume that we a re .

standing upon the outcrop of a vein running or s t riking no rth ,

and south and facing north it will be found t hat the dip may b e
, ,

either to the right or left that is to the east or west, ,


.

The dip or direction of th e in clin ation of a bed or v e in must not


be confounded with the inclination or a ng le of dip .

T h e I n c l in a tio n O f B e dS The a ng le of d ip is the do wn


~
.

wa r d inclination measured in degrees f rom the h or izon ta l .

Th e u nder lie is the downward inclination measured in degr ees


from the v er tic a l .

The dip and underlie a r e only the same when t he inc lination

F IG S . 15 an d 16 .
S h o w i n g I ncl ination o f V ei n s by Co o rdinates -
.

of the bed or vein is The te r m u nderlie is in common


use among miners and is apt to le ad to confusion if used care
,

lessly.

When des c ribing a bed or seam a geologist will gene rally say ,

The seam strikes north south and d i ps east at an angle of


-
,

This means that the dire c tion towards which the seam in c lines is
28 MININ G GEO L O G Y .

yea rs however have shown that coal oc c u rs in rock of all ages ;


, ,

and the invest i ga t ion of the newer coal measures has led to the -

belief that c oal vegetation established itself wherever and when


-

ever the conditions were favourable for its growth .

I n tra c ing th e success i on of pl an t a n d animal l i fe i n geological


time i t is found that the e arlier fo rms wer e of a v e ry prim i tiv e
,

type I n asc e nding the g e olog i cal scale t hese earl ie r forms wer e
.
,

su c ceed e d and to a large e xt e nt displaced by more highly


, ,

organis e d forms doubtless better adapted to th e prevailing con


,

dition s of th e time and pla c e .

I n resp e c t to plant life the Primary period was specially


-
,

distinguished by the great developm e nt of mosses ferns and , ,

o ther cryptogamic forms 5 the S econdary period by th e growth of


cycads and fe rns 5 and the Tertiary by deciduous trees and
o we r in g plants .

The coals of the di fferent geological periods are formed of th e


veg e tation prevailing at that time Henc e th e Carbonif e rous .

coals of E urop e are compos e d of the r e mains of f e rns mosses , ,

equisetums lycopodiums and l e pidodendrons many of which


, , ,

grew to a gigan ti c s i ze resembl i ng i n their habit the forest tr e es


,

of the pr e sent time .

The gr e at c oald e pos its of Carboniferous age would indicat e


that plant life in this period reached its maximum developm e nt
-
,

at taining a luxuriance unrivalled at any later geological period .

Ther e is good reason for the belief that the coal vegetation of
this and all later periods grew 0 11 wide tra c ts of low lying swampy -
,

1a n d a dj a c e n t to some sea or lake e nv e loped in a cloud of s te am


, .
,

ing vapour th rough which th e rays of the sun s e ldom p e n e trated


,
.

M any of these an c ient forests extended for hundreds of miles ,

occ u py i ng the estuaries and deltas of great slugg i sh riv e rs laden


with mud and n e sediments .

A study of the coal measures of eve ry count ry and of e v e ry


-

age reveals the fact that the accumulated coal vegeta t ion was -

preserved from des t ruction by the gradual submergence of th e


land whi c h t hus permitted the deposition of a great thickn e ss of
,

protecting sedimen t s .

The succession of seams met with in many c oa l e lds indicates


successive p e riods of minor subsidence and elevation of the land ,

e ach seam with its underclay marking the site of a n e w forest .

The thickn e ss of the beds or strata b e tween the diffe rent seams
a ff ords some evidence of the extent and duration of e ach sub
m e rgence 5 b u t th e clay partings met with in coal seams cannot -

always be taken as an eviden c e of submergen c e They may mark .

an encroachment of ood waters on to the forests dur i ng an


-

abnormal inundation whereby a layer of mud was d e posited


,
C LA S S IFI C AT I O N or MIN ERAL D EP O S IT S . 29

among t he v e getation whose growth would be reta rded but not


, ,

M o de Of O c c u rre n c e charac t er of t h e sed iments


.
T h e
su cc eeding th e coa l na t urally var i ed wi t h the position of t he
fores t s and t h ei r prox i mity t o th e s e a e ven for coal s of th e ,

sam e age .

Subsidence of t h e land was a fundamenta l requir e m e n t for the


pres e rvat i on of t he accumulate d coa l vegeta tion I n most coun t rie s -
.
,

t h e coal 18 follo wed by shales or indurated clays sandstones a n d , ,

l i mes t ones .

Th e shales are commo nl y forme d of u v ia t ile mu ds which ,

generally contain plantr e ma i ns 5 th e sands t on e s ar e u v io mar i n e -


,

and often conta in a rich mollusc an faun a ; wh i l e the l i m e s t on e s


ar e compo s e d of shells and co rals which ind i ca t e a t ru e mar i n e ,

l i t toral I n th e se cas es the c oal m arks th e beginning of a cycl e of


.

deposit i on .

Wher e the coal v e geta ti on gr e w on the marg i ns of lak e s or in


lake estua ries the coal measures cons i st principally of shal e s gr its
,
-
, ,

and sandston e s I n most plac e s th e gr i t s i m de rlie t h e coal


. .

A g e of C o al Carbon a ceo us ma t ter i s found in rocks of all


.

ag e s and in nearly all kinds of sedim e nta ry rocks


,
.

T h e graphite be d s of Canada oc cur in rocks of La uren ti an ag e .

Th e an th ra cite of Coun ty Cavan i n I reland i s S i lurian 5 the gr e a t


, ,

c oa l e l ds of G r e at Bri t a i n Con ti n e n ta l E urope a n d United S ta t es


, ,

ar e Carboniferous 5 the c oals of Ne w S out h Wales S ta t e of ,

Vi rgin i a I ndia and Ch i na Carboniferous and Fe rmoc arbon i f e rous 5


, , ,

the bi t um i no u s coals of N ew Z e aland Upp e r Cr eta c eous 5 th e ,

brown coals of Sou t h Hungary Pennsylvania and N or t h G ermany


, , ,

O oli t ic and L iassic ; of N e w Zealand and V ienna bas in M iocene 5 ,

a n d t h e l i gn i te beds of I r e land Pl i oc ene ,


.

I n c l i n e d P o s itio n o f Co a l S e a m s Th e coal measur es wi t h


.
- -
,

th ei r accompanying seams of coal w e r e ori ginally d e po s it ed in a ,

mor e or less horizontal posit i on I f the stra t a had r e mained .

horizon tal i t is ev i dent t hat the task of procur i ng coal would hav e
,

been v e ry labo rious and expensive 5 a n d in coun t r ie s where th e


overlying strata are t h i ck th e coal co u ld no t have b ee n reach ed .

The s e cular movem e n t s of th e cru s t of t h e e a rt h have t il ted the


s t ra ta a t different angles th e dip varying from a few degr e es to
,

a n gl e s wh i ch occasionally approach the vertical .

F a u l ting O f C o a l S e a m s Sudd e n dislocations or changes of


.

po s iti on ar e spoken of as th r ows tr ou bles slip s or fa u lts


, , ,
.

I n coal stra ta faults often occur in a ser i es of two or mor e


-
,

hav i ng a parall e l b e aring Th ey som e ti m e s all d i p one way bu t


.
,

fr e quen tly in oppo s ite d i r e ctions .

S tep f a u lts are of t en me t w it h i n coal m e asures


-
Wher e t h e -
.
30 MINI N G G EOLOGY .

dislo c ations do not exce e d the thi c kness of the c oal seam they are -

t erm e d h itch es .

E x te nt O f F a u lts F ault lin e s are ofte n so thin as to be


.
-

e asily mistaken for th e ordinary j ointing of th e beds which they


traverse M or e frequen t ly how e ver t he opposi t e faces pr e sent
.
, ,

smooth glassy slicken sided walls with a space partially or


, ,
-
,

entirely lle d with clay or debr is derived from the adj oining
rocks .

I n many c ases the faulting has been caused by lodes or c ross


courses which often con t ain threads or pock ets of iron pyr i tes
,
-
,

known to c oal miners as bra ss es 5 and where they interse c t a coal


-
,

seam quantities of sooty coal mix e d with clay


,
.


I n t ru s iv e D y k e s a n d th e ir E ffe c ts D ykes consist of
wall l i ke masses of igneous rock often basaltic
-
They are ,
.

vert i cal or incl i n e d at various angl e s and sometimes a c t the part


, ,

of faults by d i splacing the strata on the O pposite walls They .

sometimes run parallel to faults .

I n t he c oal e lds of Scotland sheets of basalt h a ve been forced


along the surfaces of coal seams and even along thei r centre so as -
, ,

t o form a bed or sheet in the middle of the seam .

I ntrusive dykes and sh e ets or sills sometimes c ause great loss of


coal and extra e xpense in the working of the seam
, .

The coal in the vi c in ity of an igneous mass is often coked and ,

rend e red c inde ry or sooty .

But t he e ff ects ar e not always destructive A t M alvern Hills in .


,

N ew Zealand a sea m of brown coal was dehydrat e d and conve rted


,

into anthracite of good quality by a sheet of basalt .

Coal may also be alter e d by the same agency into graphite .

Among the debris on the slopes of M ount E gmont in N ew Zealand ,

( a beaut i ful volcanic c on e which is piled up to a h e ight of 80 0 0


feet upon a oor of th e lower Tertiary brown coal measures ) -
,

masses of sandstone with adhering layers of graphite of n e


quality are of not un common occurr e nce .

I g n eous dyk e s oft en dam back water in coal mines 5 and i n -

some cases they ha v e e ff e ctually pr e vented the spread of r e .

I rre g u l a rit ie s o f Co a l S e a m s The troubles m e t with in .

coal min i ng are known as ba l/cs mp s g a ws s a ddle ba c hs s wellies


- -
, , , , ,

t b t m h and s h a ken coa l


p o -
o t o s orse s , , .

B a lhs are sudden thinnings in the coal occas i oned by a ,

depression of the roof of the seam accompanied by a correspond ,

ing rising of the oor .

Wh e n the stratum above the coal invades the thickness of the


seam so as to almost or entirely take the place of the coal it is
, ,

called a h ip or wa nt .

G a me and s a dd le ba c/cs appear to be the reverse of nips as th e


-
,
C LAS S I FI C AT I O N or MIN E RAL D E P O S I T S . 31

oo r is e ith e r irregu lar or ris e s into and inte rfer e s with th e


con t inuity of th e e oa l s e am
.

I n s wellies and p ot bu ttoms the ordinary th i ckness of th e c oal is


-

increased by a depress i on of th e oo r .

Coal sea ms which r e s t clos e to the b asement rock are always


-

the mos t subj e ct t o irregul ari ti e s i n th i ckness Th i s i s a v e ry .

no ti c e able f e a t ure of t h e Auckland coa l e lds of N ew Zealand ,

wher e the s e ams of brown coa l c onform to some e x ten t to the


conto ur of the bas e m e nt roc k T h e r e sult o f t h i s conform ity i s .

tha t t h e coal thins where the b as ement rock ris e s in ri dg e s and ,

t hick e ns in the b e llows I n t h e depressio ns t he s e am i s som e


.

ti m e s 60 feet thick and on the ridges only a few f eet T h e t hick


,
.

e n in
g and t hin n ing of the seam does not n e ces s ar i ly i mply t ha t
t he coal is de t r ital for i t is manifes t tha t t he w et spongy p e aty
, , ,

mass of vege tabl e matter from wh i ch th e coal was form e d would


slowly gravitate towa rds and ac cumu lat e in the hollows ex i sting in
,

th e land s u rface 0 11 which th e vegetat i on grew .

S h a ken coa l is coal wh i c h app ea rs to hav e b e en compl etely


cr ush e d by some pressure or movement of t h e stra ta It i s .

oft en a mere h e ap of shapeless coal dus t which i s so soft t ha t it -


,

may be du g ou t w i th a spa de .

B e n din g O f C o a l S e a m s T h e effec t of fa u l ts 1 o lc a n ic
.
,
'

in t rusions or late ral pr e ssur e due to the con t raction of the crus t
,

of th e ea rth has b e en some t imes to bend the coal strata and in ,

some c a s e s t hrow t hem into complica te d folds which i ncrease the ,

cos t of working and ca use a g reat was te of coal i n mining


,

E xamples of t he f olding of t h e s t rata i n th e anthrac i te c oa le lds


of Pen nsylvania are sho wn in the g s 1 8 and 19 . .

FIG . 18
. C ro
e tio o f N w Bo to n B in Penn y lva i a th racite
ss s c n e s as ,
s n a n
region ( Red ed b y B S Ly man fro m th cro ection h e t f th
. uc . . e ss -s s e o e
Pe ylv ia G eo l ogi l S rvey
nn s an ca u .

I n g 19 w e have an i nst r uctive exampl e of i nverte d folding on


.

th e sam e c oal e lds .

The compli c ated manner in which coa l me asur e s are fold e d i s -


32 MININ G GEOLOGY .

well illustrated in the c oalbas in of S aint E loy in F rance . A


typi cal section of this e ld drawn by D e L a u n ay i s sho wn in g
l
, ,
. 20 .

FI G . 19
. Cro ec tio S h d h B i n Pen y l n i an th r c ite regio
s s -s n e n an a as ,
ns va a a n,

o i g i verted foldi g f o l m ea re ( Red ed by B S Lym


sh w n n n o c a - su s. uc . . an

fro m cro ect ion h eet o f th Pe n y lvan i Geol ogi l S rvey )


s s -s s e n s a ca u .

FI G . 20 S
. e tion o f Co
c al B as i n ,
Sa i nt El o y .
( A fter D e L au n a y ) .

Va rie tie s of C oal a nd I n u e nc e o f E n c lo s ing R o c k .

Assuming c oal to b e a form of altered v e ge table mat te r th e pro ,

r e s s iv e stages in its for m a t ion a re indicat e d by th e following


g
kinds
( )
1 P e at .

( )
2 L i gnite .

( )
3 Brown coal .

( )
4 Cann e l coa l -

( )
5 B i tuminous or caking coal .


( )
6 Semi anthracite smokeless c
-
oal .

7
( ) Anthracit e .

The quality of a coal is not so much dependent upon the age of


the coal as upon the thi ckness an d li tholog i cal character of the coal
measures A gr e at thickness of close grained imp e rv i ous strata
.
-

e nabl e s the alteration of the vegetabl e matter to proceed without


1
Pro fe oss r L . de L au nay Comp tes R eh du s , m iz
,

. S essi on Congr eh G eol .

I n ter n a tio na l , P ri a s, 1 90 1 , p 959


. .
C LA S S IFI C A T I O N OF MIN ERAL D EP O S I T S . 33

a c cess of air or water thereby produ c ing c oals of high quali ty


,
-

w i thout regard to age .

Th e n e b i tuminous s t eam coals of the w e st coast of N ew Zea -

lan d of Upper Creta c eous age are en c losed in a gr e at th i ckness


, ,

of close gra i ne d sandstones and shales Th e coals of the sam e age


-
.

on t h e e as t coa st ar e enclosed in po rous qua rtz gri t s and are lit t le ,

be tte r than l i gn i t e .

Another example of th e in u e n c e e x e rcised by the enclos ing


rocks upon t h e character of the coal is seen in t h e c oa le lds of
e ast e r n T e xas I n the F aye t te Y e gua and T i mb e r Bel t d i vis i ons
1
.
, , ,

wh e r e th e e nclosing rocks are c h ie y soft sandy clays and shales , , ,

t h e coa l i s only a l i gnite w h il e in Webb County wh e r e th e m e asur e s


,

are san dstones and shales it i s so superior as to b e classed by ,

P e nros e i n the bituminous group of c oa ls .

( )
b D isse m in a ted th r ou g h a B ed .

Sed i men tary rocks conta i ning well de n e d horizons impregnated -

wi t h or e s and m i n e rals of greater or l e ss econom i c value ar e found


i n many parts of t he glob e The origin of the metall i c con te n t s .

of t hese b e ds i s a problem not yet sa tisfacto ri ly d eterm i ned Th e .

metals wer e e i ther introduced contemporaneously wi t h the d e pos i


t ion of the sedim e n ts in which th e y oc cur or after t h e consol i da ,

t ion an d elevat i on of th e sediments above water The subj ec t .

awaits furth e r investigation A fe w typ i cal examples of th i s class .

of d e posit are given below .

B k
T h e R a n d a n e t R e e fs I n this class may b e inclu d e d t h e .

c e l e brated so ca lled ba nket or almond re e fs of the W i twate rsran d


-
, , ,

in th e Transvaal .

Th e bas emen t rock is granite wh i ch is intruded by dyk e s of


2
,

felsit e syen i te granuli t e e tc The grani t e is ov e rla i n by th e


, , , .

Quartzite shal e group which consists of a gr e at th i ckness of


-
,

qua rt z ite and ferrug i nous shales dipp i ng south at angl e s varying , ,

f rom 2 0 to This gr oup wraps round th e no rt h s i d e


of J oh a n n e s b u r g I t conta i ns s e veral t h i n conglomerate or banke t


.

beds which are gol d bearing


,
-
.

The Quar t zi t e shale group is follow e d appar e ntly c om for m a b ly


-
, ,

by the W i t wate rsran d group th e gold bea ring series prop e r -

con sis ti ng principally of quart zites w i th which ar e associa te d beds ,

of conglome rate or bank e t sandstones and shales The d i p i s ,


.

south a t som e wha t lower angles t han th e und e rly i ng s e ri e s


,
.

Th e W it wa t ersrand group is overlain by an enormous pil e of


amygdaloidal diabase in its turn followe d by t h e Black Re e f
,

1 H i ri
n c h R ie s M in es a nd M i ne ra ls
e ,
S cran to n P O c t 1 905 p 1 0 4 , ,
a .
, .
,
. .

2
S J T ru sc ott T he Wztzoa te rs ra nd G old e lds 18 98 p 1 8

. .
.
, , ,
34 MININ G GEOLOGY .

formation The latte r consists of alternating quartzites and


.

shale 5 and at its bas e conta i ns conglomerates of the banket type


, ,

varying from a few inches to 14 feet thick I t is separated from .

the diabase by a few inch e s of ferruginous clay .

The bulk of the gold in the Ba nd is der i ved from the M ain
Reef series i n the Witwate rsrand group which comprises three
, ,

important banket reefs namely ,

( )
a The M ain Reef ( the lowest ) .

( )
6 The M ain Reef L eader .

( )
c The S outh Reef .

I n addition to these th e re a re the less important bankets k n o wn


, ,

as the N orth Reef the M iddl e R e ef and the Bastard South Reefs
, ,
.

f 6 7

FIG . 21 .
C ro ss
e tio a ro s R obi on Mine ( A fter G ib on )
-s
c n c s ns . s .

(1 an d 2 ) B tard S o th Ree f ; ( 3 ) D i b e D y ke ; ( 4 ) S o th R ee f ;
as u s a as u (5 )
M i ddle R e ef ; ( 6 ) Mai Ree f Leader ( 7 ) Mai Reef ; ( 8) N orth Ree f
n n .

The banket be ds consist of pyrit i c quartz conglomerates composed ,

of rounded or sub angular p e bbles of bluish gr ay quartz embedded


- -
,

in a quartzose matrix .

Th e M a i n Reef series comprises three more or less payable r ee fs


or bank e t beds namely the M ain Re e f which i s often 12 feet
, ,

thick and very low grad e 5 the M ain Reef L ead er about 1 5
, ,

in c hes thick and very rich ; and the South Reef varying fro m
, ,

a few inches to 6 feet thick and payable in mos t places This , .

series can b e traced for 4 6 miles and is the main sourc e of the ,

gold produc e d in th e Transvaal .

A charac te r i s t ic f e ature of th e bankets is their uniform value .

The e ven d is t r i bution of the gold has b e en a n i m portant factor


in th e d evelopm e nt of th e Rand g olde ld T h e gold does n ot .

occur in t h e enclos e d p e bbles but i n t he cem e nt i ng med i um a


circumstance wh i ch t e nds t o sho w that th e conglom e rates are
simply consol i da t ed lacustrin e or e stuar i ne d eposits in which the ,

gold was deposi t ed from circulating gol d b e aring solutions -


.

M a n s fe l d C o p p e r S h a l e s The copp e r bear i ng shales ( Kup .


-

f e r s c h ie fe r ) of M ansfel d in Prussian Saxony are of Perm i an age


, , .

They are 18 inches thick and extend for many m i les I n places , .
36 MININ G GEOLOGY .

E urope They consist of alternating shales and sa ndstones of


.

Triass i c age .

The White Reef and Bu c k eye Reef a re two sandstone beds -


,

from 30 0 0 fe e t to 4 0 00 feet apart Above water l e vel they are .


-

impr e gnated with ke ra rg y r ite or horn silv e r 5 and b e low water ,

l e vel the chloride is r e placed by sulphid e s The m e tal bear i n g .


-

rock vari e s from 30 t o 90 feet wid e and yi e lds an av e rage of 2 5 o z , .

of silve r per ton A small percentage of copper also occurs with


.

the s i lver .

Ne arly all geologists are agreed that the silver and c opper wer e
introduced subsequently to the tilting of the beds .

L e a d S a n ds t o n e o f P r u s s ia The lead sandstone of .

C om m e rn in Rhen i sh Prussia is bel i eved to b e lower Triassic in


, ,

age The rock is a white sandstone of great thickness The


.
, .

u pper part is charged w i th small concretions varying from a pin ,

h e ad to a pea i n size composed of quartzos e san d cemented with


.

, ,

galena .

The con c retions are called knots h e nce th e min e rs nam e ,



,

kn otten s a nds te in
- They contain a little chromium vanadium
.
, ,

and titanium 5 th e latter in t he greatest proportion Th e or e is .

mine d partly by open cast and par t ly by underground workings


-
.

L e ad bearin g sedimentary rocks belonging to this class o c cur in


-

s e veral parts of G ermany and in the counti e s of N ottin g h a m and


,

L e i c e stershire in E ngland
,
.


B e ds c o nt a in ing C o p ro lite s Coprolites are found d i s .

s e m i nat e d in greensands interbedded with strata of younger


Secondary ag e in t he south of E ngland The coprolite b e aring .

gr e ensands of t h e Cr e tac e ous Wa i para s e r ie s of N ew Z e al and are


of too low a grade to be of econom i c value .

G y p s u m B e dS Gypsum occurs in beds associated with


.

calcareous and clayey rocks I t is found in great quantity in the .

Paris basin at M ontmartre I ts occurrenc e in vol canic reg i ons has


.

already been noted .

C L ASS II I U N S T R AT I F I ED
. D EP O S IT S .

s of vol c a n ic or ig in
( )
a D e p os i t .

ockwor k d ep os its
( )
6 S t .

0 ) Con ta c t a nd r ep la c em en t dep osi ts


( .

( )
d F a h l ba nd s .

e ) I mp r eg n a tion s
( .

S eg r eg a te d veins .

G a sh v e ins .

( )
h T w e s su r e v eins .
C LA S S IFI C AT I O N or M IN ERAL D EP O S I T S . 37

( ) a D ep os its o f Vo l ca n ic O r ig i n .

These includ e the de posi t s of sul phur and borax which ,

accumulate in and ar ound fumarol e s i n th e form of sublima tes .

N ota ble exampl e s of sulphu r d e posits ar e found at M oun t Et na


-

and M ount V e suvius 5 Whi te I sland and Ro torua i n N e w ,

Zealand ; and m J apan


A t Whi te I sland t h e bulk of t h e sulphur is of ve ry low grad e ,

being m ix e d wi t h a v e ry larg e p ropo rt ion of gyp sum A t Roto rua .


,

t housands of tons of bo th y e llow a n d black sul phur of high grad e


ar e be ing mined by t he natives for export .

T h e steam fumarol e s of Pisa and G ros e t to in Italy yi e ld a , ,

large a n nual ou t put of bo ric a cid .

( )
b S tockwor k D e osits
p .

The term stoc kwork was rs t used in E urope to dis t in gu ish


the quarry method of min i ng cer tain min e ralis e d rock mass e s
- -

in terse c ted by small re t icul a ti ng v e inl e ts of or e I t no long e r .

refe rs to t h e m e thod of working bu t is appli e d to m e ta ll if e rous ,

orebodies possessing t he characteristi cs of t h e d e pos i ts rs t mined


as stoc kworks .

A stoc kwork may b e de n e d as a r ock mass t rav e rs e d by -

numerous small veins of or e t hat mu tually in te rs ec t e ach o t h e r ,

bu t ar e too small to be worked s e parately .

Th e v e ins seldom poss e ss cl ea rly de n e d walls b u t merg e ,

impercep t ibly into t he coun t ry rock wh i ch i t s e lf is often


impregna t ed w it h min e ral matt er to a gr ea ter or less e x t ent .

Stockworks are sometim e s of grea t wid t h and length They .

ar e mostly of low grad e 5 a n d from n e cessi ty ar e commonl y worked


by t h e quarry or open cut system of minin g which enabl e s a larg e
-
,

output of ore to be produced at a small cos t .

A l as k a T r e a dw e ll S t o c k w o rk s Th e c e l e bra t ed gold .
~

bearing ore bodi e s in t he Treadw e ll m i nes D ouglas I slan d in


-
, ,

Alaska acco rd i ng to Sp e nc e r c ons i s t of min e ral i s e d dyk e s of


,
1
,

alb i te dior i t e lyi ng b et w e en gr ee ns ton e on t h e hang i ng wall and


- -

sla t e 0 11 th e foo twall wi t h a few small e r dyk e s nea r by i n t h e


,

slate Th e y g e nerally conform to t h e s t r i ke and dip of t h e


.

The greenston e s ar e as a rul e gr eatly al te r e d and in plac e s


, , ,

possess a schistos e or slaty s t ruc t ure Th e y ar e suppos e d to be .

ancien t an desites and basal t s that w e r e e rupted a t t h e t i me the


slates wer e form ed .

1
A C S pe n c e 1
. . T h e G eo l ogy o f t h e T rea dwell O re D epos its D o u g l as
, ,

I sl and A laska T r a ns A m I nst M E Pam phl et 190 4


, , . . . . .
,
.
38 MININ G GEOLOGY .

The ore mainly consists of alt e r e d d iorit e impr e gnat e d with


sulphides c h ie y iron pyrites Th e rock is also partly shat t er e d
,
.

and lle d wi th a n e twork of thin calci t e and quar t z veins t hat


carry a fair proportion of sulphides 1
The dyk e s are considerably .

mineralised and often th e whol e mass can be min e d I n general


,
.

the best ore is that wh i ch conta ins the gr e atest numb e r of calci te
and quartz veinle t s .

T h e gangue is felspar calcite and qua rtz The gold is associ , ,


.

ated with about 2 per cent of pyr i tes and some magnetite . .

Pyrrho t ite often accompanies or replaces the pyrites , , .

The ore is of very low grad e av e raging about twelve shillings ,

per ton but t he larg e ou t put free milling character of the ore
, ,
-
,

and skilful managemen t hav e enabl e d th e min e s t o pay handsome


r o ts for many years The ore b odies are mined pa rtly by O pen -
p .

cuts and partly by underground workings .

O th e r S t o c k w o rk s A t Zinnwald in Bohemia in a dome .


, ,

shap e d mass of greisen (quartz and mica ) there ar e narrow hori , ,

z e n ta l v e ins of tin or e that form stockworks -


.

A t Altenberg ther e is a greisen like rock locally called Zwitter -


, ,

in which t in ore is disseminated to th e ext e n t of one third to on e


- -

half per cent thus forming a s tockwork S omewhat similar


.
, .

deposits occur in granite in the form of impregnations .

N ear S tanthorp e in Qu ee nsland grains of tin ar e d i ss e minated


, ,

through a gran i t i c rock as if forming on e of its original consti t uents , .

A t M ont e Catini in Tuscany t he Cr e tac e ous strata are broken


, ,

through by s e rpentine and gabbro containing large pockets of ,

coppe r or e mostly erub e scit e and copp e r pyrit e s


, .

I n Cuba and N e wfou n dlan d rich d e posi t s of copper oc c ur in


s e rpentine .

I n Cornwall granit e s and s laty shal e s locally call e d killas , ,

containing from 8 lbs to 9 lbs of t i n stu ff to the t e n of rock yield


. .
,

a good p ro t I n some cas e s 2 lbs of t i n stu ff have been s u f c ie n t


. .

to pay all exp e nses A man can br e ak from 15 to 2 tons of the.

hard rock per day and 7 to 8 tons of soft killas ,


.

I n the mineral belt n e ar Ne lson in Ne w Z e aland native copper , ,

d cuprit e occur in serp e ntin e and chromite of iron in massive ,

olivine .

A t Kimb e rl e y in South Africa diamonds are foun d diss e m i


, ,

mat e d in tu s and agglomera t es oc c upyi n g the necks of ancient


volcano e s .

( ) c Con ta c t a nd R ep la ce me n t D ep os its .

A contact deposit is on e which occurs a t or near


-
, ,
th e conta c t of
a sedimentary rock and an intrusive mass or dyke .

1
A 0 S pe n cer loo cit p 2 5 . .
, . .
, . .
C L A S S IFI C A T I O N OF MIN ERAL D EP O S I T S . 39

Valuabl e deposits of magn etite sp e cular iron and of copp e r , , ,

l e ad and zinc sulph ides are not uncommon along t h e j un ction


,

b e tw e en th e in t r usiv e and country rock frequ e n tly ne a r t h e -


,

bounda ry but ne ver ou tside t he meta morp h os ed zone


, .

I n most probably in all cas e s t he or e body i s a min e ralise d


, ,
-

replacement of the country rock followin g ce rta i n w e lld e n e d -

zones of fracture or c rush which are gene t ically conn e c te d wi t h


the igneous intrusive mass P e trolo g ica l m e thods of exam i na ti on.

{4 4

F1G . 22 S
. e tion ho wing Cont t D ep it
c s ac os .

( a ) Gran ite .
( b) S late ( ) C o tac t Depo its
. 0 n s .

have shown that progr e ssive stag e s of al t era t ion ca n be t raced


from th e unal ter e d roc k to th e m i n e ra l is ed or e body -
.

Th e al terat i on removal and r e plac e m e n t wer e du e t o as cend i ng


, ,

highl y h e ated wa te rs laden with min e ral ma tter d e riv e d from a


d e eper zone probably t h e cool i ng intrus i v e rock magma its e lf
,
-
.

Valuabl e de po si ts of m a gnetit e are found a t t h e con ta c t of im


pur e limesto n es and granite i n th e Chris t ian i a dis t rict, in N e rway
, .

N ear F ramont in th e V osges in F ranc e m ass e s of sp e cular


, , ,

iron a re fo u nd wrapping round a boss of qua rt z porphy ry -


.

P y r it c O
i re -B o
d ie s R io T in to Ca pp er C o n
. ta c t O i pyri ti c .

contac t deposi ts t h e most typical in E urope ar e t hos e of Rio


-

T into Tha rsis a n d San D om i ngo i n Spain and adjace n t pa rt of


, , , ,

Portugal which occur at t h e boun dary be tw e en al te red sla t e and


,

fe lspar po rphyry
-
.

Th e famous coppe r min e s of Rio Tinto ar e con ta in ed in a g r ea t


b e l t of mineralised coun t ry 1 4 0 mil e s long and 30 m il e s w i d e , ,

s t r e tchin g from Hu e lva i n Spa i n i nto Por tugal Th e co u nt ry is


, , .

slat e of Upp e r D e von i an ag e often loca lly al te r e d i n to jasp e r , ,

talc schis t a n d chias tol ite sch i s t and i n t ru de d by great mass e s of


, ,

quartz and f e lspar porphyry d i abas e quart z s yeni te and gran it e


-
,
-
,
.

Th e ore i s a n e grain e d and compac t i ron pyri t es con tain i ng


-
,

on an average less t han 3 p e r cen t of copp e r Small v ei ns of . .

copp e r pyri t es e r ub e sc i te and oc cas i onally copper glance mor e or


, , ,

l e ss mixed w it h iron py rit e s qua rtz blende and oth e r m i nerals , , , ,

trave rse t he m ass .


40 MININ G GEOLOG Y .

Conta c t Or es tn A mer ic a
The argentif e rous lead ores of L ead
ville in Colorado hav e be e n describ e d by E mmons as contact
,
1
,

deposits occurri n g along th e contact planes of eruptive po rp h yry


dykes which hav e brok e n into and ov e rlain a b e d of dolomiti c
,

limestone .

1 L
5
F I G 2 3 S ectio n o f Rio T into Pyritic Contact D epo s it
. . .

( )
a Altered s late ( b) F el par porph yry
. ( c) C u pri fero us py rites s - . .

The lead zine ores of S outh M ountain in the S tate of I daho


-
, ,

occur along the c ontact of limestone and diorite or granite Th e y .

have been described by L indg ren as true conta ct deposits


2 -
.

I n the S e v e n D evils distri c t in the same State there are coppe r , ,

d e posits whi c h o cc u r as (a ) s su r e veins ( 6) zones of impregnation -


, ,

and ( c ) c on tact deposits The country rocks consist of Triassic


-
.
-

slate and limestone intercalated with basic lavas I n s e veral ,


.

places this se ries is intruded by diorites ; and all the ore bea ring -

bodies appea r to be gen e ti c ally connected with these int r usiv e


masses .

The sedimentary se ries in di ff erent places has bee n ss u re d , ,

in the zone of metamorphism and also outside of it The s s u re s ,


.
,

in the zone of metamorphism when lle d with mineral matter , ,

formed contact deposits while those outside of it became ssu r e


-
,

veins M orphologically they di ff er but geneti c ally they are the


.
,

same .

The valuabl e copper deposi t s of Arizona occur associa t ed w i th


Carboniferous limestone gen e rally at the line of contact of gran i te , ,

or other erupt i ve rock .

G old and copper bearing contact vei ns a re common in M exico - -


,

occurring generally between Creta c eous limeston e and eruptiv e


3
ro c ks which are nearly always diorite
, .

S 1
F Emm ns ,
. .T he G n s o
e e i o f Certais n O re Depo s its , T r a ns A m I
. . n s t.
M E .
,
v ol
.
, p . xv
1 2 5 , 1 886 . . .

2
W L nd r n, T h e G n s s
. i ge e ei and Ch ra ter o f Cert i Conta t Depo it
a c a n c s s .

T ra n s A m I n s t M in E ng V ol
. . . . . , . xxx i p 2 2 6 5 d G ene i o f O Depo it
. . an s s re s s,

p 72 1
. .

3
L i n dgren , loc . c tt .
, p 7 2
. 4 .
C LA S S IFI CAT I O N 0 11 MIN ERAL D E P O S I T S . 41

i
R a n m els be rg D ep Pyri ti c or e bodie s ass oc ia te d
'
P y r itic os it -

with bu t not ac t ually in con tac t with e rup t iv e m ass e s ar e foun d


, , ,

in all part s of t h e world O f s u ch ore bodies tha t a t Ramm e l s

-
.

berg in th e Hart z sa id to have be e n worke d for 90 0 y e ars


, , ,

M ount L y e ll lod es in Tasman i a and th e Broken H i ll lod e i n


, , ,

N ew So ut h Wal e s may b e c ite d as typical e xampl e s ,


.

Vog t d e scribes th e Ramm e lsberg d e pos it as an irre g ular l e ns


1

of or e with a curious lateral b ranch l ik e th e Brok e n Hill lod e .

The d e pos it is 1 5 00 yards long and from 4 9 to 6 5 fee t wid e It .

S E

24 .
I deal S e c tion o f Ra m m l e s be r ; Py riti Depo it
c s .
( A fter V ogt .
)

I S enclosed in Upper D e vonian sla t es occupy ing t he cen tr e of a ,

s he a r zo ne It s gen e s i s is b e lieve d by V og t t o be closely


.

conn e c t ed w it h c e rta i n lin e s of erup ti on of grani te i n t h e


i mm e dia te n ei ghbourhood .

M o u n t L y e l Or e D ep
l os ita Prof e ssor J W G r e gory group s .

t he or e depos it s of t h i s di s t ric t i n to t wo class e s nam e ly ( a ) hug e


-
, , ,

l e ns shaped pyr iti c mass e s a n d ( b) min e ral i sed ban ds of sch i s t


-
, ,

1
Pro fes s o r J H L V ogt U eber die Kies l ag ers tatte n v om T y p u s Reros
. .
, ,

V ig s n as S u l itelm a in N orwege n u n d Ra mm el s berg in D eu ts chland Z e tt


'

, , .

P ra kt . G e ol .
,
1 8 94 .

2
Pro fe or J W G r
ss . egory ,
o t
T h e M u n Ly l l M e ini g F ieldT
n as m an ia .

T r a ns . A us t I ns t A L E. .
,
v ol . x .
,
1 90 5 , p 2 6
. .
42 MININ G GEOLO G Y .

forming fahlbands Th e form e r a r e t he sourc e of th e great bulk


.

of the valuable mineral m i ned in the e ld 5 t h e la t t e r ar e


economically of little importance .

The rocks consist of D evon i an conglomerates and quartzites


anked by Silurian and Cambrian sch i sts The structur e is not .

complicated by folding but the c ountry is traversed by a compl e x ,

of great faults .

The ore bodies occu r a s detached masses alo n g the line of


-

co n tact of th e quartzi t es and conglomerates on the east and ,

schists on the west side .

O f the two main pyritic m asses the la rg e s t a n d most impo r tant


is known as the B ig M ine or P a rent M ine Professo r G rego ry .

des c ribes it as irregula rly boat shaped in form be i n g an elliptical -


,

mass which tapers gradually downwards and is th e n cut 0 11 0

with a rounded base T h e extension in depth is limited by a .

great th r ust plane which brings the conglomerates under the ore
1
and schists .

The oxid i sed gossan consisted mainly of silica ba r ite a n d iron , ,

oxid e containing about 1 5 oz of silv e r and 1 5 dwt of gold p e r . .

t on .

The pyritic ore is c h ie y pyrites with coppe r gold and silv e r , ,


.

Small patches of very rich or e probably the result of secondary ,

e nrichment were m e t with at the bottom of the oxidised zo n e


, .

They contain e d redruthit e born ite fahlore and arg e n ti te , , , .

The main pyritic mass is of very low grade I t contains from .

0 5 to 2 per c e nt of copper from 1 5 to 3 o z of silve r and


.
, .
,

from 0 0 4 to 0 0 7 o z of gold per ton of ore . .

W T Bat c helor stat e s that a featur e of the or e bodies is their


. .
2 -

p e cul i arity of splitting into on e or more legs or branches as they


d escend a feature so characteristic of the Broken Hill lode in
,

Ne w South Wales .

The genesis of the M o u nt L yell ore bodies is still a question of -

doubt Prof e ssor G r e go ry thinks they may be classed as contact


.

d e posits although not dir e ctly connected with igneous masses


, .

Th e main or e body lies in a c r u s h zon e at the contact of the


- -

quartzites and schists and its formation may possibly be conn e ct e d


,

w it h th e granit e intrusions of M ount He e m skirk rang e A .

p e trolog i cal examination of t he wall rock and or e would probably -

show that the M ount L y e ll or e s lik e those of oth e r pyr iti c masses ,

e ls e where are m et asomatic repla c ements of the enclos i ng rock


, .

The grea t faults which traverse the lodes are thought by some
writ e rs to hav e a genetic association with the ore bodies but thi s -
,

co n nection has not y e t been proved The manner in which the .

lodes are faulted and displa c ed horizontally by thrust faults -

1 2
L oc . cit. , p 1 18
. . L oc . ci t. , p.1 4 1 .
44 MININ G G EOLOGY .

contents wer e principally cerussite native silver chlorides , , ,

bromides and iodi de s of silver associated with kaolin garn e t and


, , , ,

quartz .

Belo w the oxidised products c ame what are locally termed


sooty sulphides consisting of loose aggregates of galena and blend e
, ,

enclosed in a gangue of quartz and garn e t The friabl e sulphides .

JA M I ES ON S

N fi c r
rL

N 35 0

2"
S ca le Fe et
FI G . 26 . Cro s ection o f Broke Hi ll L o de B k n Hil l P
s s n io e 1o
p1 1e tary
Mi e n ( Copied f m t h Co m pa y p lan
. l e e n

3 .

passed downward into solid sulphide s (blend e and galena ) enclose d ,

in a gangu e of quar t z garnet and rhodonite containing also i ro n


, , ,

pyr i tes and a li t tle chalcopyrite The sooty sulphid e s w e r e


, .

frequently very rich and apparently r e pres e nted a zone of


,

secondary enrichment .

Bet ween the 2 0 0 and 300 feet levels th e lod e divides into two ,

spurs or branches which follow th e trend of the en c losing rocks


, .
C LA S S IFI C A T I O N OF MIN ERAL D E P O S I T S . 45

The wal ls of t he lodes are not slicken sided I n many places the -
.

roc k is i mpregnated or r e pl ac ed more or l e ss wi t h or e .

The gn eiss and schist ar e associated wi th numerous dyk e s of


dior i te to th e in t r u sion of wh i ch the fold i ng of t h e rocks and
1
,

subsequ e nt llin g of the cavi ti es along t he axial l i n e of ma i n


e xu r e may be ascr i bed .

The charac ter and g e n e s is of t his lod e is s t ill a ma t ter of d i s


agreement among Aus t ralian geologis ts P i t t man and Jaquet 2
.

conte nd t ha t th e lode is a large sa d dl ereef e nclos e d in al t ered


se dimen taries P rof e ssor G r e gory on t he o th e r hand mainta i ns
3
.
, ,

t hat th e po si t ion of the lode has be e n determined by a s e ries of


powerful faults al ong which m i n e ralisa ti on h as tak e n place H e .

con t en ds that the c onta ining rocks are no t sed im e n ta ry and n e v e r


w e r e Th e gn e iss e s and sch i sts beside th e lod e are h e a f r m s a
.
, ,

ser i es of altered igneous rocks Pi tt man and J aq u e t oppose t h i s .

vi e w with t he statement t ha t the sa m e or similar gne i sses and ,

schis t s in t he adjacent dis t r i ct con ta i n bands of l i mestone which


, ,

cl e arly prov e a sed i menta ry origi n for the seri e s .

B uc kton Or e D ep osi ts T e n ness ee The pyri ti c ore bodies in t his


, .
-

reg i on m ay b e tak e n as typical of t h i s class of ore depo s i t i n -

Am e r ica Th e rocks consis t of gn e iss and micaceous sch i s t s or


.

sla t es wh ich have been thrown into close folds .

FI G 27 I deal S ec tion , N . W . to S . E owing probab le tru ture o f


.
, sh s c

D uc kte n regio n ( A fter Henri c h )


. .

. .

The ore bod i es consis t of masses of pyrrho t i te with wh i ch occur


-

sulph i des of copper zinc and le ad Th e port i ons near t h e surfac e


, , .

have been oxi dis ed into gossan Carl Henrich sta tes t hat b e low 4
.

J aq u et G eo l ogy o f t h e B roken Hil l L ode a n d B arrier Ra n ges


1
J B
M in eral F iel d N e w S o uth Wale s M emoi r G eo] S u r vey N S W N o 5 1 8 94
. .
,
. .
,
. . .
,

E F Pittm an a n d J B Jaq u et T h e G enes is o f B roken 11111 L od e


,
2
. . . .
, ,

A u str a l ia n M in in g S ta nd a r d Oc tober 1 90 4 ,
.

3 Pro fe
s s or J W G rego ry .
T h e G en es 1s o f B roken H ill L ode
.
, ,

A l elbou r n c A r gu s S epte m ber 1 90 4 .

C arl Henri ch D u c kto wn Ore D epo s its a n d T rea tment o f Copper Ores
,
1

,
,

T ra ns A m I ns t A L E v ol xx v 1 896 p 2 0 6
. . .
, . .
, ,
. .
46 MININ G GEOLOGY .

the gossan and above the unaltered sulph i des there is a zone of
secondary enrich m ent consisting of partly oxidised c opp e r ore or

black copper F requ e ntly a oor of whit e quartz o c curs b elow
.

the enrich e d zone frequently containing dispe rsed grains or


bunch e s of marcasite .

The or e deposits do not occur in d i r e ct association with igneous


-

intrusions bu t are found along the planes of fa u lt s su r e s th e


, ,

fault plan e in all cases according to Henrich form i ng the east or


-
, ,

hanging wall of th e d e posit which is always sharply de n e d


-
, .

That wr i t e r is of the Opin i on t ha t the B uckton ore depos i ts ar e -

replac e ments of igneous dykes which at one tim e occupied th e


pr e s e nt places of the ore bodies -
.

( )
d F a h l ba nds .

Thes e are beds or strata of crystalline metamorphic rock so ,

highly i mpregnated with or e as to be of commercial value Th e .

silver b e aring fahlbands (or gray beds ) of N e rway are among th e


-

bestknown exampl e s They follow more or less clos e ly th e


.
, ,

strike and d i p of the gneissoid and schistose strata by which they


are bound e d They e xtend for several mil e s and in cases atta i n
.
,

a width of s e veral hundred feet .

I n th e Kongsberg district t hese bands are crossed nearly a t


right angles by narro w s s u r e veins varying in width from a few ,

inches up t o 2 feet and are product i v e of silver only wher e


,

th e y in te rsect the fahlbands The fahlbands are important in th i s .

distr i ct sol e ly from the fact that t he small ss u r e veins ar e e n -

riched i n passing t hrough them more esp e cially when two such ,

veins i nters e ct within the mineralised belt .

FI G . 28 .
S ec tio n of F ah l band at D k y S o nd N w Z us u ,
e eal and .
( A fter Park ) .

( a ) S h i t c( b) F
s s.h l ban d a .

A t D usky Sound in N ew Zealand there is a mineralised band


, ,

of mica and chlorite schists c ontain i ng pyrrhotite pyr ite with a , , ,

littl e chalcopyrite and nickel asso c iat e d with epidote and garne t ,

min e rals T h e band can be tra c ed southward across the moun


.
,

tains for several mile s but i t has not yet been shown to contain
, ,

p y Z
a a b l e or e of any kin d .
C LA S S IFI C A T I O N or MIN E RAL D EPO S I T S . 47

Fahlbands are r e lated to bed impregnat i ons wh i ch probably -


,

ow e t heir or i g i n t o a queous and gaseous emanations aris i ng from


a cooling intrus ive magma .

( ) e I mp reg n attons .

I t has sometimes happ e n e d t hat when a rock has been crack e d


or s s u r e d a porti on of t he roc k on on e or bo t h walls has becom e
i mpregnated wi th some metallic su bs tance d i ss e mina t ed as grains , ,

n e sts or bunches throughou t the mass in t h e vicini ty of th e


,

ss u r e .

Such an occurrenc e is ca lled an imp regn a tion implying t ha t ,

th e m i n e ral has been introduc e d as a secondary produc t by


m i neral waters or superheated s tea m .

The term impr e gnation i mpl ie s a ref e rence to th e genes i s


rath e r t han t he form of an ored e po sit and wh e n used i n a ,

morphologi ca l sens e i s somewha t va g ue and meaningless .

G e net i cal ly the maj ority of s t ockwork s con tact d e posits and ,
-

fahlban ds may b e properly regarded as impreg na ti ons as well ,

as th e S i lv e r San ds ton e s of U ta h the Copp e r Conglom e rates of


,

Lak e Sup e r i or th e Copper Shales of M ansf e l d and th e G old


, ,

Bank e ts of th e Rand a ll of wh i ch probably d e r i ved th e ir me tallic


,

con te n t s from aqueou s and gas e ou s emanations e xpelled from a


cooling magma .

T in I m p re g n a tio n s The or e mo s t frequently found as an


.

i mpr e gnat i on i s cass it er ite or t i n s tone and t h e rock i n which it


-
,

occurs i n th i s mann e r is commonly gran i t e M any exampl e s of .

t his class of t in d e pos it are me t w ith in Aust ral i a and i n


Tasman i a .

FI G . 2 9 T in
. I m pregn atio n .

(
a ) G ra n ite .
( b) T in i m pregn atio n .

At M ount W i lls in Vi ctor i a ti n or e is foun d in veins and in


, ,
-

d i ss e m i nated grains i n a gran ite forming a true s t ockwork


,
.

A t Ve getable Cr ee k i n Ne w South Wal e s it i s found llin g


, ,

contraction cracks and j oints i n a granite near the j unction w it h ,


48 MI N IN G GEOLOGY .

clay slat e s I n th e E mmaville division in the same S tate the


.
, ,

t i n b e aring ore occu rs in v e ins and i mpr e gnations in t he outer


-

crus t of a gran iti c boss .

I n th e H e rberton di str i ct which produc e s the bulk of the tin ,

rais e d in Queensland th e t i n stone occurs i n veins bunch e s a n d


,
-
, ,

i mpregnat i ons i n gran i t e .

A t t h e famous t i n m i n e at M ount Bischoff t h e ti n ston e occ u rs


- 1
, ,
-

i n str i ngs bunch e s v e ins and i mpregnations in quartz porphyry


, , ,
-
,

e ur ite a n d topaz porphyry which have intrude d slates sandstones


,
-
, , ,

and quar t zose rocks .

I mpregnat i ons l i k e fahlbands form a group of metall i f e rous


, ,

d e pos i ts not very clearly de n e d G enetically t hey are clos e ly .


,

related to contac t deposi t s -


.

(f ) S eg r eg a te d Ve in s .

D e posits of this kind gen e rally occur i n the shap e of lenticular


masses , a n d oft e n succee d one another in l e ngth and d e pth in such
a manner as to const i tut e a more or l e ss conti n uous ve i n Th e y .

are o n ly foun d i n s e d i m e ntary rocks that have b ee n sha rply folde d ,

wher e by cracks or s s u r e s have been form e d more or less parallel


w i th the bed di ng planes and d i pping at right angles to the axial
,

l i n e of e leva t ion .

C h a ra c te ris tic s o f S e g re g a t e d V e in s
The ch ie f char .

a c t e r is t ic s of s e gr e gat e d v e ins a r e as follows

( )
1 Unc e rta i n both in depth and lin e ar e xtens i on 5 that is they ,

ar e s e ldom cont i nuous e i ther in l e ngth or d e p t h but occur ,

as a success i on of d i sconnect e d l e ntil shap e d mass e s ,


-
,

which may contain a f e w tons or many thousands of tons , ,

of quartz .

( 2 ) I rr e gular i n w i d t h .

( )
3 S e ldom possess more t han one w e ll d e n e d wall -
.

( )
4 F requently re c eiv e small ve i ns in th ei r course .

( ) Conform more or less to bedding planes of country rock


5 -
.

( )
6 They ar e only foun d i n bed d e d s e d i mentaries which are ,

gen e rally slat e s clayston e s or san dstones


, .

O rig in o f S e g re g a te d Ve in s Th e orig i n of segregated .

d eposi t s of this class i s som e what obscure Th e y g e n e rally occur .

alo g the b e ddi ng plane of t he country rock Th e cav i t i es they


n -
.

ll hav e appar e ntly b ee n forme d by th e fold i ng of the enclosing


rock 5 and th i s fol ding may hav e b ee n caus e d by secular earth
movem e nts or the intrus i on of an igneous mass
,
.

N e w Z e a l a n d S e g re g a t io n s The pro ductiv e quar t z veins


.
-

1
H W F K ay ser
. . . M ou n t
, A n s t A s soc A dv t S ci en ce 1 892 . . .
,
.
C LA S S IFI C AT I O N or MIN ERAL D EPO S I T S . 49

in th e Reefto n I nangah u a and L yell g old e lds cons ist of a


, ,

suc c e ss i on of l e n t icular masses which generally conform to


the be dd i ng planes of the enclosing clays ton e s and sandston e s .

Some of t h e larg e r or e bodies sw e ll ou t to a w i dth of 2 0 fe et a t


-

t h e ir w ides t part but the maj ori ty are shaped l ike a t lenses w it h
,

a thickness varyin g from 3 to 6 f e et Th e re are no dykes or .

intru s ive boss e s i n t he v i cini ty of t he v e ins which oc cupy cav it i e s ,

formed along the bedd i ng planes of a monoc linal .

S a ddl e R e e fs These are se named from th e ir resemblance


.
-

in form to a stockman s saddle Th e y ar e mer e ly s e gregated v ei ns



.

formed in cavities along the bedding planes of sedimen ta ry rocks


wh i ch hav e been bent i n t o ant i clinal and syn clinal folds .

E J D unn who worked out th e morphology of t h e saddl e


.
1
,

reefs of Bend i go g old e ld in Vi c to ria de n e s a saddle reef as z


, ,
-


A lenticular qua rtz lode lying between bed ding plane s of roc k
-


be nt over i n an ti clinal or syncl i nal folds .

The chief chara c teristics of saddle reefs are as follows -

( )
1 They occur in bedde d banded or folia te d rocks , ,
.

( )
2 They ll cavities which conform to the planes of bedding or
fol i a ti on of th e rocks .

( )
3 The gr e ate s t mass of ore occurs along t he crown of the
ant i cl i nal arch forming the s a dd le from whi c h the leg s
d e scen d on e on e ac h s i de of th e arch
, .

( )
4 The legs diminish rapidly in size as they des c end and ,

n ally die out .

( )
5 Two or mor e saddlereefs may succ eed ea ch o ther in v e rtical
d e p t h under t he axis of the same anticl inal fold .

( )
6 Th e great e st thickness of ore in inv e r t ed saddle r e efs -
,

form ed in synclinal folds is found along the axis of th e ,

trough .

The saddle re e fs of Bend i go c onsis t of arch like mass es of gold


- -

b ea ring qua rtz conforming to the bedd i ng plan e s of the enclos i ng


slate a n d sands ton e of S i lur i an age D unn has shown t ha t i n .

most cas e s t he fol ding of the roc ks was caused by t he in t rusion of


i gneo us dyk e s .

I nv e rte d S a dd e R e e fs
l Th e gol d b e arin g veins at Cape -

T e ra w h it i near W e llingto n l n N ew Z ealan d are interes t ing ex


, , ,

amples of sad dl e r ee fs wh i ch e xh i b it bo th an anticlinal and


-

s yncl inal arrangem e n t as shown in g 3 1 ,


. .

Th e rocks ar e Triassic claysto n e s a n d sands tones which hav e


b ee n e rod e d i nto s tee p r i dges and de e p valleys wi t h th e resul t t h a t ,

th e veins have b ee n correspondingly denuded The or e bod ie s .


-

1
E J D u nn R ep or t on B end igo G ol d
.
, e ld D ept o f M ines V ictori a ,
.
, ,

M el bo urne 1 8 93
. .
50 MININ G GEOLOGY .

FI G . 30 . S
-
ectio ns s h o wi g Fo rmatio n o f S addle Ree f
n - s. ( A fter E J
. . D unn )
.
52 MININ G G EOLOGY .

The ores m ost commonly found in gash veins are galena and -

zinc blende V eins of t h i s class have no distinct walls and being


.
, ,

co n n e d to a singl e stratum of the formation in which they o c cur ,

are limited in exten t .

FI G . 33 G
. ash V ei ns Wan ga peka ealand
, , N ew Z .

(a) S il rian l i me to ne
u ( b) S i l rian late
s . u s s.

) G sh v ein o ntai ni ng galena nd b lende


(c a s c a .

( )
h T r u e F tssu r e Vein s .

V eins of this c lass are generally admitted to h a ve o rigin ated in


s s u r e s caused ei t h e r by se c ular folding or by ign eous int ru sio n s , ,

and are believed to possess great depth They pass through all .

kinds of ro c ks in their course independently of any bedding or ,

s tra ti c a t ion 5 but in some part they may chan c e to c oincide

the dip and strike of the c ontaining formation .

\
L
. L L ~

_ L

FI G 34 . . T ru
-
e Fi ssu re Vei n .

(a ) L i mes to ne .
( 0 ) G ra n ite .

( )
b S late s .
(d ) F i s su re vei n -
.

The mineral contents of th e s e veins w ere d e pos i ted


asc e nding aqu e ous solutions wh i ch were probably gen e ti cally
, , ,

connect e d with deep seated magmat i c intrusions


-
.

Th e ban ed arra gement of the v ei n matter of the ssu re vein s


d

n -

of Cornwal l i s very si m i lar t o t ha t of t he solfataric v ei ns of th e -

Hauraki g olde lds which would t e n d t o show th at t h e ll in g took


,

C LA S S IFI C A T I O N or MIN ERAL D EP O S I T S . 53

place in t h e la t er stages of the aft er actions following t h e ign e ous -

i ntrusion .

T h e two walls do not always c oincide tha t is the ss u re is , ,

ofte n a faul t and of va riabl e width A t ru e vein like a s e gr e gate d


, .
,

vein m a y throw out spurs or branches from on e or bo th walls


,
.

L o de s O f Co r nw a l l The lodes of Cornwall are famil i ar


.

e xampl e s of t r u e s sur e veins Th e y pass in d e p t h succ e ss iv e ly


-
.

through lim e ston e sla te and grani te I n t he limestone th e


, ,
.
,

princ i pal commercial produc t was l e ad 5 in the slate copp e r 5 a n d ,

i n th e granite t in , .

L o d e s O f B a v a ria n F o re s t The thr ee gigantic qua rt z .

lod e s on the slopes of t he Bavarian F ores t are r e garded by Suess 1

as the grea t es t monuments of lin e ar d i sloca t ion known in E urop e .

Th e y are true ss u r e veins and are bel ie ved by tha t d i s ti nguish e d


-
,

geologist to oc cupy great faul t frac t ures on t he existenc e of which -


,

he n ds suppor t for h i s cel e brated th e ory of moun ta in building


by h or sts a nd gr a ben .

O f these the Asch lod e begins in the most north wes t erly par t
,
-

of Boh e mia no rth w e st of Asch runs to th e south eas t t rans


,
-
,
-

v e rs e l
y across t h e m i ca schist gneiss a n d grani te of E rzg e birge
-
, ,

M oun ta i ns 5 th e n cuts across t he narrow ou tcrop of gn ei ss n e ar


Se e berg d i sa ppears ben e ath t h e Tert i ary cov e r i ng in the bas i n
,

of F ranzensbad and E ger and r eapp e a rs immed i a tely on the o t h e r


,

sid e of t h i s in t he granit e m a ss of Sandan n a lly extending ,

through th i s up to th e sou t h of K onigs wart The to tal l e ngt h of


'

outcrop is nearly 2 5 mil e s .

N ea r Hals where th e Asch l ode e nds th e re appea rs the begin


, ,

ning of th e gr e at v e in known as t h e Bohem i an Pfahl which strik e s


sou t h south e a s t th e n curves to t he eas t t h e n turns ba ck to th e
- -
, ,

s t raight course and crosses the Bavarian front i er near F u r th .

The l e ng t h of outcrop is abou t 3 4 m i les and t he av e rage wid th ,

about 10 0 fe e t F or a long d i s ta nce t h e lode runs bet w e e n t h e


.

gn e iss and hornbl e nd e rock but wh e re th e hornbl e nd e rocks ben d , ,

it pass e s completely in to t he lat te r .

Th e t hird and grea te s t of thes e lod e s i s the G r e at Pfahl It .

s t rikes N 5 8 W and for th e gr e a te r pa rt of i t s cou rse vari e s


.
,

from 2 2 5 to 37 0 fee t w i d e F or a di s tanc e of 2 7 m i l e s in a sou th


.

eas t c ours e it separates th e granite from th e Triassic and middl e


,

Jurassic strata and then t o t h e w e s t of the chain passes com


,

p l e t e ly into the Arch a ean region 5 thenc e it continues in a s t raight


lin e as far as the Aust rian frontier Th e total length of outcrop .

of this remarkable l ode i s 92 mil e s .

Ve in s o f C rip p le C re e k Th e gold bea ring v ei ns at Cripple .


-

Cr e ek in Colora do traverse and e s i t i c t uffs and phonolite of low e r


, ,

1
Edu aid S u ess T he Face of the E a r th Engl i sh ed ition v ol i p 2 0 7
, , , . . . .
54 MININ G GEOLOGY .

Tertia ry age They are . s s u re -


veins g roupe d around old volcanic
,

c e ntres of eruption .

T he Th e cel e brat e d Comstock lod e in


C o m s to c k L o de . ,

N evada t rav e rs e s propyl i tised andesite dacite d i abas e diorit e


, , , , ,

e tc of older Tertiary ag e I n the middle portion of i ts cours e i t


.
,
.

occupies the line of c ontac t between mass e s of diori te a n d


diabas e th e lat te r lying on th e hanging wall Th e bas e ment
,
-
.

rocks are grani t e schists slates and l imeston e s


,
1
, ,
.

The lod e has been traced for a distanc e of over feet in a


nearly du e north and south dir e ction I t dips t owards th e east .
,

and has a t hickness varying from 2 0 to 6 0 fe e t Th e v e in .

ss u r e is also a fa u lt The vein matter c onsists of crushed and


.

de c ompos e d rock clay and quartz The lode is r e markabl e for


, , .

th e high temp e rature of the mine water in the lower l e v e ls -


.

Th e m in e s on the Comstock lode have yielded a fabulous


amount of gold and silver since they wer e opened in 1 85 9 The .

gold exists as free gold associat e d with sulph i d e s of silv e r , .

M o th e r L o de O f C a l ifo rn ia Th e G r e at M oth e r lode of .

California is one of t he most remarkabl e s su r e veins in th e glob e -


.

I t is trac e abl e for a distance of 7 0 m i l e s e xt e nding through v e ,

count i es and in many plac e s is a min e ralis e d belt ra ther t han a


, ,

tru e vein .

Th i s immens e v e in or group of veins generally occurs in a b e lt


, ,

of black slate of Triass i c ag e and runs nearly parall e l with th e ,

plan e s of s tra t ic a tion dipping in th e sam e di rection at n e arly


,

t he same angl e of inclination A t d i ffer e nt par t s of its cours e it .


,

traverses sla te diori te d i abas e s e rpent i n e a n d granit e


, , , , .

The mines on the M other lode and the rich placers on its
course hav e yi e ld e d a large propo rtion of t h e gold produc e d in
Cal i fornia for many years 2
.

L o de F o rm a t io ns o f K a l g o o rl ie The famous lod e .

format i ons of Kalgoorlie in Western Au s t ral i a poss e ss many


featur e s of pecul i ar inter e s t to the mining geologist Th e y .

are group e d t ogeth e r in an area about a square m i l e in e xten t ,

locally named th e G olde n M ile The country rocks i n t his area .


-

have undergon e e xtreme alteration which ren ders the determina ,

t ion of th e ir original character very difc u lt .

I n th e oxidised ground there i s no sharp line of d e marcation ,

betw ee n the lode formations and the country rock which i s


- 3 -
,

1
G B c r,
. F
. e ke
G l y f th e ms c eo og o
L d and as h D s ri c , Co to k o e W oe i t t
M on ogr ap h tit of U S G eol S u rvey
. a sh n n , 1 8 8 2
. . . . W i gto .

2
DJ . W it e
h n y , T h e A n mf er on s C r a w ls of th e S ier r a N eva d a of

C b i ge
am r d , U S , 1880 , p 4 5 . . . .

3
H C .

. Hoo e
v r, T h e S u pe rcial l ra n f s rn u s ral an O re A te tio o We te A t i
epo it
D s s , T ra n s A mer I ns t M in Eng , v ol xxv p 785
. . . . . iii . . . .
CL A S S IFI C T I N A O or MIN ERAL D EP O S IT S .

ge n erally a dmitted to be of an e ru ptive chara c te r p robably of an ,

ac i d i c ho rn bl e nd e typ e .

Th e lod e format i ons ar e beli e ved by s ome t o b e b e l ts of co u n t ry


-

rock more al te re d and m in e ral i s e d t han th e r e ma i ning rocks 5 by


,

othe rs to be ign e ous dyk e s wh i ch i n trud ed t h e old e r e ruptiv e s ,

and subs e qu e ntly becam e m i n e ral i s e d by asc e nding t h e rmal


wa ters i n t h e wan i ng or solfa taric phas e of e rup t iv e afte r actions -
.

Th e schis tos e s t r uc t ur e obs e rve d i n t he lod e ma tter may hav e -

been induced by t ang e n t ial st r e ss du e to s e cular foldin g a n d


e levation subsequ e nt to th e form ation of t h e lod e s Th e pr e senc e
, .

of s e rici t e favours t h e V ie w tha t it was i nduced by pr e ss ur e .

The e videnc e ava i lable a t pr e s e n t s ee ms to sugg e s t t ha t


m e tasoma t ic r e plac e men t on a larg e sca l e op e ra t ing along l i n e s ,

of fracture probably con t rac ti on ss u r e s played an i mpo rtan t


, ,

pa rt in t h e genesis of th e Kalgoorli e lod e s .

The oxid i s e d po rt ion of t h e lodes exte nds from 5 0 t o 400 f e e t


below t he present surfac e the d e p th to which it e x te n ds b e ing ,

apparently i nd e p e nden t of e xis t ing wat e r l e v e l or surface con tours 1 -


.

Th e gol d in i t is fre e and extremely fine G enerally sp e ak i ng .


,

the rich e r and more heav i ly min e ral i sed pa r ts a r e foun d to b e


oxid i sed to t he gr eates t d e pth 2
.

I n the oxid i se d zon e the lod e mat te r cons i s t s c h ie y of hydra te d -

oxides of i ron hydrate d sil i cates of alumin a and magnesia


,
3
Calc i te ,
.
,

s e rici te chlorite and o ther alterat i on p roduc ts ar e also pres e n t


, ,
.

The lode formations ar e ofte n in te rs e c t e d by s mall v e in s of


-

decomposed qua rt z and Woodward states t hat i t is wher e t h e s e


4
,

are met wi t h that th e or e is rich e s t .

Th e or e bodies or courses of rich ore oc cur in irregular l e ns


-
, ,

sha ped mass e s varying from a mere thread to many feet in wid th
,
.

They ar e no t con t inuous but occur in ech e lon one l e ns over ,

lapping th e o t her .

Below th e ox i d i sed zone t h e lod e s are mor e cl e arly de n e d ,

pa rt ic u larly i n the rich e r min e s 5


The c ountry rock is mass i v e bu t .
-
,

e xtr e mely alt e red while t h e lode ma tte r i s sch i s to s e in places ,


-
,

show i ng al te ra ti on t o chlori te and s e ric i te and pl e n t ifully charged ,

wi t h d i ssem i nated iron pyrite


I n som e mines the vein ll in g consists c h ie y o f quart z 6
The - .

1
H C Hoo er l
. . v , oo. c it p 7 58
, . .

2
H P Woodwrd
. . a

, T h e s e -cal l d L d e o e F ormatio ns o f Hannan
s an d

T ell ri de D ep its
u T os ,
r a ns I n s t M in a nd M e t
. . .
, v ol . Vi .
p 17. .

3
L oc . cit .
, p 16. .

4
E F .Pittman .
,
ote
N s on th e Geol ogy an d M i er l D epo it
n a s s 0 1 Portio ns

o f We te rn A tral i
s us a ,
R

ecor d s f
o G eo l S u r v e y f
o M S TV v ol vi p 1
. . . . . . .

5
W Fre h eville
. c ,

N ote
s on a V s t h e G ld M n s ai it to al o i e t K goorlie ,

We tern A tralia
s

us . T ra ns I ns t M i n a nd M et , v ol
. . i , 1 8 98 , p 1 4 1
. . v . . .

6
L oc . c it , .
p 1 44
. .
56 MININ G GEOLOGY .

quartz however is in many cases replaced by calcite which is an


, , ,

important gangue material sometimes occurring in larg e mass es , ,

with calav e rite 1


.

The gold o c curs mainly in tellurides and sulphides only a minor ,

proport i on e xisti ng in t he free state The prin c ipal accessory .

min e rals ar e magneti t e siderite iron pyrites and ars e nical , , ,

pyrites .

The tellurides occur as veins splashes and disseminat e d minute , ,

crystals throughou t th e entir e m ass .

M o u n t M o rg a n L o de The great ore body in M ount M organ .


-

mine in Queensland is b e li e ved by some to b e a huge pyriti c lode .

I n the upper part of the deposit it c onsists of siliceous h aemat i t e ,

or g os s a n often with a porous c avernous structure ; and in th e


, ,

lower part of massiv e pyritic gold b e aring or e A zone of


,
-
.

FI G . 35 . C ro e tio n o f M o nt M organ L o de ( A fter E J D nn )


s s -s c u . . u .

(a an d b) S a d to ne t n ( ) Cell lar i li ceo


s s, e c . e u s us o re .

(c) D yke s. ( f ) S i li eou ul ph i de c s s s.

(d) I gneou ro ck s ( 9) O x i di e d e ri h e d zon e


. s n c .

secondary enrichment of g re a t value was met with in the oxidised


zon e .


The a c tion of s e a water is held by E J D unn to s u f c ie n tly
2
.

account for the secondary oxidised or e s without calling in th e a i d ,

of thermal spri n gs as contended by D r J ack , .

The country rocks are highly metamo rphosed strata of P e rm o


-

G W Card N ote s on th e Co u n try R o c k s o f th e K algoorl ie G ol deld


1
.
.
, ,

Western A u stralia Res of th e C ool S u r v ey of N S IV


, v ol vi . . . .
, . .

Part I .

2
E J D u nn
. M o u nt M organ G ol d M i n e
.
,

P r oc R oy a l S ociety of ,
.

Vzctor ta , 1 90 5
'

.
CLA S S IFI C A T I O N OF MIN ERAL D E P O S I T S . 57

Carboniferous age trave rsed by in t rusions of hornblende g ranite,


-

a n d dol e r ite
1
.

Th e or e body i t s e lf i s nearly su rrounded by dykes of dol e rit e


-
,

oft en al te red and s e rp e nt i nised .

Th e e vidence suppli e d by D r J ac k W i lk i nson and o t h e rs se e m s ,

to ind i cat e t ha t t h i s un i qu e lod e 18 a t ru e ss u r e v e in g e n eti cally ,

conn e c te d w it h t he in t rus i on of t he dol e ri te s It bears many .

po i n t s of r e s e mblanc e to t h e famous copp e r contac t d e pos i ts a t -

Rio T i n to m Spa i n .

Th e d i s ti nct i on b et w ee n contac t d e pos it s and ss u r e veins i s one -

of geologic occurr e nc e ra t h e r t han genetic origin As will b e .

shown la t er t he afte r ac ti ons of a magma t ic int rusion may b e th e


,
-

g e ne ti c cause i n th e forma ti on of s su r e veins con tac t d e pos it s -


, ,

or e v e n b e d i mpregnation -
.

T in L o d e s O f M a l a ys ia Th e t in lod e s of t h e M alay .

Penins ul a t h e e rosion of wh i ch has produc e d th e valuabl e alluvial


,

plac e rs of the S t ra i ts S ettl e m e n ts ar e ss u r e v e ins pass i ng from ,


-

clay sla te s downward i n to t he bas e m e n t rock gran it e 2


.

G o l d Ve in s o f C h a rte rs T o w e rs I n t his ri ch g o ld e ld a .
-

large nu mber of t h e v ei ns ar e enclosed in gran it e but som e occur ,

in porphyry Th e v e in gangu e is pr i nc i pally quart z con ta i ning


.
-
,

i ron pyr ite s and oft en pyrr ho t ite bo th of wh i ch con ta i n gold ,


.

C o p p e r L o de s o f B u tte C ity Th e copp e r d e posi ts n ea r .


-

But t e C ity i n the S tate of M ontana are among t h e rich e st 1n t he


, ,

glob e T h e co u n t ry rock l s grani t e t rav e rsed by dykes of rhyoli te


.
-
,

t r e nding nort h and sou t h 3


.

A numb e r of minin g companies are opera t ing on a lod e or


min e ralised belt w hich can b e t raced for ov e r 3 miles i n a
, ,

c o u rs e r u nn i ng nearly e ast and w e s t .

Th e dir e c t ion of t h e min e ral b e l t follows the g e n e ral trend of


t h e ss u re plan e s which ar e approxi ma t ely pa rallel to e ac h oth e r
, ,

i m itin
g in plac e s runn i ng ou t a n d uni ti,
ng again .

E mmons conclude s that t h e grani te was s s u r e d by t h e rhyoli te


i nt r us i ons wh i ch w e r e followed by t h e usual sequ e nc e of erup t iv e
,

after a c ti ons includi ng a t one s t ag e t he c i rc ul a ti on of hot asc e nd



,

ing solu t ions Through th e ag e ncy of t h e se solutions t h e g ran ite


.
,

be ca m e decompos e d along t h e l i n e s of fractur e and t h e orebodies ,

form e d by metas omatic i nt e rchang e .

M uch of t he ore occurs i n t h i n interlacing v e i n s s om e of it ,

impregnating th e grani t e a n d some as hug e or e m a sses ,


-
.

1
C S Wilkins o n N otes o n a C o llec tio n o f R oc k s a n d M i n eral s fro m
. .

M o u nt M organ Rea irds of G eol S u r vey of N S W1 1 891 v ol ii 86


,

. . .
, . . .

W H D e 1 r ick N ote s o n Lo de T i n M inin g iii th e M alay e n in sul a


.
, ,
2 '
. .
, ,

T ra ns I ns t M i n a nd M et v ol v ii 1 898 1 899 p 1 2
. . . . .
, , . .

E mm on s T h e Copper Res o urc es o f t h e U nited S tate s


,

T r a ns , .

A me r I
. ns t. M in E ng . v ol . x i x .
p 6 78
. .
58 MININ G GEOLOGY .

The oxidised portion carried silve r mainly the chloride a nd no , ,

copp e r of any moment down to a depth of about 400 fe e t wh e r e


, ,
.

a zone of secondary e nrichment was met with c on ta in l n g r i ch ,

oxysulphides and other secondary ores of copper B e low this zo n e .

app e ared the n ormal sulphide ore which consists principally of ,

chalcopyrite bornite and copper glance con taining


, , ,

10 per cent of c opper and a li t tle silver


.
1
, .

The width of the lod e s varies considerably but on a n average ,

may b e t aken at about 10 f ee t .

1
D o ugla s , T he Copper Re o r e o f s u c s th e U nited S t tea s, T r a ns . A m .

I nst . M i n En g
. .
,
l xi x p 6 79
vo . . . .
60 MININ G GEOLOGY .

( b) A decrease of pressure .

( ) 0 E lectro chemical act i on


-
.

( )
d Ch e mical pre c ip ita t ion .

( )
8 B y oth e r contact with oth e r min e ralised solutions .

(f B y gas e ous emanations .

(9) By absorption of metals by gelatinous sili c a etc ,


.

O rig in of The solutions eith e r found th e


Ve in C a v itie s .

caviti e s awaiti ng them or they formed t h e ir own channels by a ,

process of slow progr e ssiv e replac e ment of th e wall rock parallel to -

pr i mary fractures .

I f the cavit ie s wer e pre existing they wer e formed mechanically -


,

by forc es either ( 1) in ter na l or ( b) e txer na l to the rock a e c te d


'

4 .
,

I n the case of e ruptive magmas unequal cooling of the igneous


mass would tend to cr e ate unequal internal tens i ons with the ,

r e sult that s su r e s of contra c tion would be formed M agmas like .


,

t h e mol t en charge in a blast furnace will cor r ode the walls of ,

t h e ir cavern and th e plucking ac t ion of the rising pasty mass



,
1
will tend to detach fragments from the roof and sides D aly .

conclud e s tha t the diges t ion of solid ro c k by a magma causes an


i ncrease of volume of the magmas ther e by furnishing su f c ie n t ,

e nergy to fracture t he overlying rocks and force the magma itself


along planes of weakness .

Sedimentary and older erup t ive rocks may be fractured by an


igneous intrusion or by the lat e ral and tangential s t r e sses created
,

by the secular folding of t he cr u st of the earth Such forces ar e .

ext e rnal to th e rock mass affected 5 and if w e consider the manner


-

i n which they act we shall n d that igneous intrusions play a


,

more important part in the genesis of vein cavities than the more -

pond e rous s e cular earth movements -


.

Secular movement i s extrem e ly slow s e ldom ex c eeding a f e w ,

inches in a c e ntury T h e folding wh i ch i t causes being for th e


.

most part of wide stru c tural or t e ctonic importance is contin e ntal ,

rather than local When the stress exce e ds the e lastic limit
.

of th e mat e rial the resultant e ffects are faulting and shearing ,

plication and sharp infolding .

Th e fractur i ng which produces open ss u r e s and caviti e s is


c h ie y the work of igneous intru sions a n d volcanic forc e s Th e s e .

agencies having mad e the cavities also provide the mineralised ,

gases and solut ions that corrode and r e place the shattered r ock
and ll the ss u r e s with mineral matter .

O r e bodies a re often formed along j oint and faul t planes and


-
,

at the interse c tion of j oints simple fractures and faults A , , .

1
Dal y R A ,
. .
,
M e ha i
c n cs o f I g eo n us Intrusio n ,
A mer . J ou r n . S et .

v ol . xvi p 1 0 7
. .
,
1 90 4 .
O R E y a ms . 61

typical example of this class of depos it in Bend i go g ol d e l d ,

V ictoria has been shown by T A Rickard


,
1
. . .

FI G . 36 .
-
Ty pi ca l S e tion o f O
ody at Inter ec tion o f Fract r
c re B s u es .

( A fter T
A R i kard ) . . c .

(a ) S an d to n e
s ( b) S late
.
(cc ) Fr cture . a s .

(d ) Go ld b ari g q rtz i th form o f a f l


- e n ua dd l
n d e a se -sa e re .

The sulphid e ores of M onte Cristo in the S ta te of Washing ton , ,

ar e stated by Spurr to be replacem e nts of t he coun t ry rock


2 -

t onalite The ores which are c h ie y gal e na blende chalcopyr i te


.
, , , ,

pyri t e and a rsen opyrit e are concentra ted along j oin t plan e s and
, ,

i nt e rsections in t h e mann e r shown i n the nex t g u re .

A g e O f Ve in F il lin g I t som e times happens t hat the lod e s


.

in a dist ric t a r e of different ages and that t he m e mbe rs of on e ,

syste m make an an gle with t h os e of anoth e r system W Vh e n .

d i splacement ta k e s place i t i s e vid e n t that t h e vein which ,

d i splac e s another vein is younger t han the displaced v e in .

I n the case of large ss u r e s now lle d wi t h min e ral mat t er i t ,

is highly imp robabl e tha t they remained as op e n chas m s w i thou t


suppor t unt il th e y were lled It is g e nerally beli e ved that i n .

th e beginning t h e ss ur e s w e re of small s i z e and gradually ,

1
. . ik
T A R c ard T r a ns A m I n st M E , v ol . . . . xx p 469
. . .

2
J E S u rr . p
O re D s
,
s fM n epo it o
rs o te C i to W ,
as h n n , i gto 2 2 nd A n nu a l
R ep or t U n ited S ta te s G eol S u rv ey , 1 90 01 90 1 ,
'
. P art I I p 8 49 . . .
62 MININ G GEOLOGY .

in c re a sed in length depth and width as th e min e ral matter , ,

a cc umulated in them to a fford the necessary support I n other .

words the e n largement of the lode was the work of m e ta somatic


,

replacement operating upon the rock forming the walls of the


orig i nal s su r e .

I t might be expected that it later movement took place it ,

would t end to follow an old line of ss u r e rather than initiate a


new one and in support of th i s view there is internal ev i dence i n
,

many lodes that they have been reopened at different periods .

Port i ons of the M artha lode at Waihi have been brecciated by

S C A L E O F FE E T
5

FI G . 3 7 S ketch
. e tio o f T nnel d Vei Expo re in V ertical C liff
-
s c n u an n su
,
G la ier C re k c h o wi g m i nerali tio n al o g j oi t
e ,
s by probab ly
n sa n n s , ,
de en di g w ter
sc S h ade d are
n repre ent i m pregn tio o f to alite
a s . as s a n n
w it h l p h i de al o n g j oi nt
su ometi me be o ming o li d ore
s
( A fte rs, s s c s s.
S p rr u .

wall movements and r e cemented 5 and evidences of a similar


- -

character are not uncommon elsewhere .

Weed who mad e a special examination of th e copper v e ins of


1
,
-

Butte in M ontana states that the veins there are of s e veral ag e s


, ,

and syst e ms and that the older primary quartz pyrite veins were
,
-

reop e ned by later movem e nts which he corr e lates with a period ,

of volcanic activity This reopen i ng he says result e d in the .


, ,

d e pos i tion of the copper sulpharsen i de e n argi t e which i s n o w , ,

found to b e the chief ore of some of the veins .

As a rule the formation of vein matter took place after the -

formation of t he enclos i ng rock .

1
W H Weed O re D epo s itio n a n d Vei n E nri c h m en t by A scending Hot
. .
,

Waters T r a ns A m I nst M E v ol xxxiii 190 3


,
. . .
,
. .
, .
0 111: VE IN S . 63

I n many lod e s ther e is evidence that t here w e re sev e ral p e riods


of ore formation Recent inves t igat i on has shown tha t t he ag e
-
.

of a l ode may be of compara ti vely late date even in v e ry old


,

rocks .

The m e talliferous andesitic rocks in South Amer i ca Ne va da , ,

T ransylvania and Ne w Z e aland were erup t ed i n middle Tert i ary


,

times ; hence t he con tained ve i ns must b e of later da t e probably ,

of ol der Pl i oc ene age The major i ty of v ei ns occurring i n clastic


.

roc ks ar e supposed to have be e n formed in later geological t ime s .

W idth O f L o de s L odes vary considerably i n wid t h bo th


.

along their cou rse and in depth Th e Comstoc k lode i s i n par t s .

2 00 fe e t to 30 0 feet wide and in oth e rs no t more t han 2 0 fee t


,
.

The Premier lode at T e A roha va r ies from 2 0 feet to 60 feet wide ,

and s tands up like th e wall of a hous e along t he anks of the


mountain for m i l e s The M artha lode a t Wa i hi var i es from 10
.
, ,

FI G 38 S h o wingLE ffec ts o f Faulting


. . .

(a ) Be fore faulting ( b) A fter f ulting


. a .

to 90 feet wide The Bohemian Pfahl in a leng t h of 34 m i l e s


.

main tains an average width of 1 0 0 f e et but in places widens out ,

to 3 7 5 f e et wh il e t h e G reat Pfahl in its c ourse of 92 miles varies


,

from 2 2 5 to 3 7 0 feet in width .

The varia t ions i n w i dth may b e du e to sev e ral caus e s Th e .

rock may hav e yi e lded more a t on e po i n t than a t another dur i ng


the formation of th e ss u r e .

A fractur e t hat pass e s t hrough al t erna ti ng bands of hard and


soft rock generally follows a sinuous cou rs e ; for wh i l e th e
frac tur e t e nds to pass t hrough the soft er rock in a d i r e c t ion
normal to its course the res i stance offered by t he har d rock
,
.

caus e s i t to tak e the sho r test d i stance t hrough the resis ti ng


med i um wh i ch w ill be a cou rs e a t r i ght angles to the bed ding or
,

When faul ti ng tak e s place on t he walls of such a sinuous


ss u r e th e result is a succ e ss i on of w i de and narrow cav itie s as
, ,

shown i n g 38 . .
64 MININ G GEOLOGY .

The Temperance lode in th e Ne rr e na or L ittl e Bend i go g old e ld


in Vi ctoria is a typical e xample of an ore body compos e d of a -

string of loz e nge shaped mass e s Accord i n g to W Bradford the


-
1
. .
,

lod e traverses a seri e s of alterna t ing sla t es and sandston e s of


Silurian ag e I n vertical d i stance it cons i sts of a succ e ssion of
.
,

w ide and narrow parts the wide pa rts forming in th e slates and ,

th e narrow in the harde r sa n dstones as drawn i n the accompany ,

ing g u re which however does not show any appearanc e of


, , ,

faulting .

Again i t is poss i bl e that erosion either chem i cal or mechanical


, , ,

hav e act e d in one portion of a s s u r e mor e than in another .

FI G . 39 . S e c tio n
o f T em pera e L o de h o wi g m k nc f q rtz in ,
s n a es o ua
sl ates . S le 1 i
ca to 40 ft ( A fter W Bradford )
,
n . . . .

L odes are generally widest in soft or moderately soft ground ,

and narrowes t in hard rocks such as unalt e red granit e and e site , ,

and d i orit e I n hard rock a lode will frequ e ntly d windle down to
.
,

a m e r e crack or clay parting and expand to i t s normal siz e on ,

enter i ng softer c ountry .

L e ng t h o f L o d e s The longest lod e s ar e g e nerally th ose .


-

which are broadest O f the thr e e gr e at lod e s trav e rsing th e slopes


.

of the Bavarian F or e st the Asch lod e is traceabl e for a dis tance


of 2 5 mil e s th e Bohem i an Pfahl for 34 mil e s and th e G rea t
, ,

Pfahl for a leng th of 92 miles .

I n Cornwall the average length of a loa d is about a m i l e in ,

Saxony 3 to 4 mil e s and i n t he Harz M ounta i ns 8 t o 10 ,

1
W . B ra dford ,
B u l l etin N o . 15 , C eol . S u r ve y o
f Victor ia , M l e bo r eu n ,

1 90 5 , p 6 . .
O RE V E IN S . 65

m il e s I n California the G reat M other lod e has be en t raced for


.

ov e r 7 0 m i l e s .

I n t h e Hauraki g old e lds in N ew Z e aland t he T oka te a lod e can , ,

b e trace d for 3 m i l e s 5 the Wa i ota hi lode 2 mil e s 5 t he Pr e m ie r ,

lode T e Aroha 4 miles


, ,
.

S trik e o r B e a rin g O f L o de s I n many mini ng d i str i c t s t h e .


-

main lod e s possess a gen e ral bearin g Thus in C ornwall t h e .

g e n e ral s t rik e i s E N E and i n th e no rth of E nglan d E


. . .
.

and W I n Prussia many of th e iron lodes s t r i k e N a n d S I n


. .

t h e Hauraki g old e lds th e trend of th e mos t produc t ive lod e s i s


NN E . . . O n the o t h e r hand t he lod e s i n t he F re i b e rg ,

dis tric t run i n var i ous direc t ions A chang e of s t rike has som e .

t i m e s an in u e n c e in the enrichm ent of a lod e .

I n som e mining regions th e r e is a gr e at sim i lari ty in the con te n t s


of th e lod e s runn i ng i n the sam e dire c ti on Thus in Cor nwall t h e .

E N E lodes yie l d ti n copper and a l it tle l e ad while t h e N S lod e s


. .
, , , . .

yi e l d clay and l e ad Bu t the e xcep t ions are too many to allow a


.

sa fe g e n e ralisa t ion to be made .

o
I n c lin a ti n o f L 0 de s The d i p of a lode may vary as i t
.

d e scends i n depth or may vary a t diffe re nt points along i ts cours e


,
.

The dip is spoken of as a t or st e ep I t is always at right angles .

to the str i ke .

The Samson lode at Andr e asb e rg the Tal i sman lod e at ,

Karangahak e and th e E mpire lod e i n t he Wa i hi m i n e i n N ew


,

Z e aland dip in opposite direct i ons i n d i ffe r e nt par ts of th ei r


,

cours e .

M oiss e n e t i n h i s classi cal work on th e L od es of Corn wa ll


, ,

fully endo rses t h e g e neral i sat i ons of Henwood r e la ti ng t o t h e


in u e nc e of inclination str i ke and charac te r of cou nt ry upon t h e
, ,

cont e n t s of th e lod es of that country With r e spec t to th e se h e .

formulat e d the following laws


e se parts of t h e lod e w hos e i nclina ti on is most n e a r l v
( )
1 Th
v e rtical ar e always t h e most productiv e .

( )
2 I n th e r i ch par t s t h e lod e is enclos e d in coun t ry of mode
ra te hardn e ss .

( )
3 The courses
? or shoots g e n e rally d i
p i n t h e same
dir e ction as the country and very oft e n also th e gro u ps ,

of bunches con t ained i n th e sa me lode .

( )
4 Th e bearing of the rich par t s i s g e n e rally t hat of t he
stratigraphica l sys te m w it h wh i ch t h e in iti al fracture of
the lod e i n t h e r e g i on und e r obs e rva ti on is conn e ct e d .

Thes e laws hold good for th e lod e s of Cornwall It is doubtful .

i f t h e y can b e saf e ly applied in o ther min i ng r e gions and e ach of ,

th e m has b e en d i sprov e d in d i ffe rent pl a c e s .

Take th e rs t law The richest bonanzas in the Tham e s gold


.

0
66 MININ G GEOLOGY .

e ld were found in t he Caledonia and Cambria reefs in places


where the angle of dip was und e r Both above and below t he
bonanzas th e d i p was abou t
D e p th O f L o de s With the exception of gash v ei ns which
.
-
,

ar e wedg e shaped openings from t he surface t he d e pth whic h


-

ve i ns may attain has not yet foun d a l i mit .

Th e greatest dep t h to w hich a lod e has be e n followed down


wards i s at P rz ib ra m in Boh e m i a wher e on e of the min e s has
, ,

reached a depth of n e arly 4 00 0 f e et and is still being de e p e ned , .

Th e gold min e s of V ictor i a and the copper mines a t L ake Superior


- -

have reach e d depths ranging from 2 00 0 feet to 5 0 00 feet .

It s e ems l i kely that s s u r e v e ins will des c end to a greater dep t h


-

than min i ng operations can follow them .

A rra ng e m e n t o f L o de M a tt e r The gangue or matrix of.


-

mos t veins is quartz Th e most notable exception is lead which


.
,

ofte n occurs i n v e ins of calcit e or u or spar -


.

The quartz may b e in ty or chalce donic n e ly or coars e ly ,

crystallin e I t may b e ba nded r ibbon like co n centric brecciat e d


.
,
-
, ,

FI G . 40 .
S h o wi ng R ibbon S tru t re o f V i
c u e n Matter .

compact vuggy granular d i sseminated or in loose sugary grains


, , , , .

The arrang e m e nt of the lod e ma tt er should always be obs e rved


-
,

s i n c e the structure and arrang e men t will almost al ways tell u s


someth i ng about it s history .

I n lodes of the base m etals the contents are somet i mes arranged
in bands or layers parallel to the walls the minerals a nd ore s ,
68 MIN IN G GEOLOGY .

I n Cornwall and elsewhere experi e n c e has shown that the occur


rence of a horse is often attended wi t h an enrichm e nt of the
con t ents of the lode a c i rcumstance whi c h doubtless originate d
,

the Corn i sh aphorism A h or e p a ys f or itself m e aning that


,
s
,

the incr e ased richness of the l od e more than comp e nsa te s the
extra labour and expense of working caused by th e app e arance of
th e hors e .

I n the steeply incl i n e d gold bearing v e ins of the Thames horses -

of rock were oft e n m e t with and in a lmost every i nstan c e they ,

caused local enrichm e nt the increased val u es being generally ,

c o n n e d to one split or branch of the lod e .

I nvest i gation showed t hat this enr i chm e nt was not due t o a
concentration of the valu e s into on e branch but to an ac t ual ,

increase i n the mean valu e s previously rul i ng in the main lod e .

O u tc r o p s O f Ve in s Professor Van His e dist i nguish e s th e


1
.

diffe rent zon e s of ro c k alteration by a nomenclature suggested by


-

th e biologi c al terms used to d e s i gnat e the som e what parallel


changes i n animal life His subdivisio n s ar e as follows .

1 . Z on e o f Ka ta morp hism .

a . B e lt of weathering .

b . Bel t of cementat i on .

A n a mmp h zs m

2 . Z on e o f .

Th e Katamorphi c zone is that in which co mplex c ompounds ar e


brok e n down and altered into S i mple compounds I n othe r words .

it is th e zon e of oxidation .

I n t h e Anamorphic zon e th e alt e rat i on of rock masses results in


th e production or build i ng up of compl e x compounds from simpl e
compounds .

The belt of weath e ring extends down from the surface to


groun d water level th e belt of c ementation from ground water

,

lev e l to th e zone of Anamorphism .

Ch e m i cal action is very active in the zone of Katamorph i sm ,

and is in most cases accomplished by descending solutions Th e .

changes effected in this zone are : ( a ) oxida tion (b ) h y dr a tion , ,

and (c ) c a r bona tion .

B y long c ontinued e xposure to atmospheric ag e nci e s and t he


-

action of desc e nding met e oric waters th e o u tcrops of iron copp e r , , ,

and silver sulphide lod e s are often oxidised and so altered by


removal a n d replacem e nt as to bear lit tl e res e mblance t o the
unaltered vein matter which will generally be found at a greater
-

depth .

1
C h as R i ch ard Va n Hi se A T reati se on M etam orph i sm U S C eol
.

, ,
. .

S ur vey Wash i ngton 1904


.
, .
O R E VE IN S . 69

The iron sulph i d e s ar e ox i di s ed rs t to sul pha tes a n d t h e n t o


ox i de s while t h e copper is r e move d by wa te r i n t h e form of
,

solubl e s ul phates or i s o xid i s e d to carb ona tes wh i ch s ta i n th e


, ,

rocks gre e n and blu e S i lv e r sulph i des a r e al tere d to th e chlor i d e


.

n ea r t h e surfac e or the d i s solved m e tall i c con te n ts are found


,

conc e ntrated at or b e low wat e r l e v e l -


.

I n many sulp h ide lod e s i ron is th e predomina t ing cons t i t u e n t ,

and i t s oxida ti on g e n e rally r e sults in t h e ou t crop assu ming a


porous hon e y combed appearance t h e removal of t he sul ph i de s
,
-
,

leaving cavit ie s which ar e only pa rt i ally lle d wi t h ox i d e T h e .

ferruginous solution o win g from the ou tc rop s ta ins and d iscolours


th e s u rrounding rocks and so i l .

Such ironstone outcrops ar e kn own as g ossa n in Cornwall tr o n ,

h a t i n G ermany and ir on s t n e blows in Aus tralia


,
o .

Th e na t ure of th e gossa n va ri e s wi t h the cha ra cter of th e


orig in al sulph i d e or e body I f much qua rt z is pr e s e n t the ou t
-
.
,

c rop is cav e rn ous and cind e ry red or brown colour ed 5 but if th e,


-

or e body is compos e d mainly of iron pyri te s t h e gossan w i ll cons i s t ,

of ochr e a n d bro w n h aema tite of te n in bo t ryoidal and s ta l ac titi c


,

forms .

The oxidation and l e ach i ng of lod e mat te r has often proc ee d e d -

to a dep th of 5 00 f ee t be low the surfac e outcrop i n some cas e s ,

far b e low th e pr e s e n t wa te r l e vel Som et ime s t her e is a sharp


-
.

line of de marcation betwe e n the o x idised and unaltered po rt ion s


of a lod e but mor e ofte n t h e passa g e i s gra dual the s u ph ide s a t
, ,

rs t making t h e ir appearanc e in d eta ched nodul e s bunch e s or , ,

small lenticular masses which gradually beco me mor e pl e n t iful


,

wi t h increasing d e p th .

A gos sa n is always an indi c ation of a lod e b e lo w a n d for t hi s , ,

r eason forms a valuabl e guid e to t he pros pec tor


, .

G ossan outc rops shoul d be ca r e ful ly sa mpl e d and assay e d as ,

th e y may contain valuabl e min e rals t h e pres e nce of which co ul d


not be d e te cted by pan n ing .

Th e valuabl e gold a n d s i lv e r lodes of th e Ha u raki g olde lds


give little or no indica ti on of the i r valu e by crush i ng and panning .

The gold exists in such a n e ly div i d e d s ta te tha t a c olo ur is rar e ly


s ee n i n t h e or e and t h e valu e can only b e asc e r ta i ned by car e ful
,

sampl i ng and r e as say -


.

Th e r i ch unox i dis e d sulpho tellurid e or e s of W e s te rn Aus t ral i a


,
-

possess no phys i cal fe atur e of a s t r i king charac t er to in di ca te


t h e ir gr e at valu e and wh e n tested by t he pros p e ctor s ready
,

method of rough crushing and panning app e ar valu e l e ss .

E ach min e ral poss e ss e s cer ta in charac te rist i c indica t ions pecul iar
to its e lf and must be co n sid e red separat e ly Thus an i ri de sc e n t
, .

lm or layer of oil on a poo l of water or an emanation of car ,


70 MININ G G EOLOG Y .

b u r e tte d hydrog e n may dir e c t att e nt i on to the existence of


,

petrol e um in the vicin i ty .

Brine springs point t o d e posits of salt and chalybea te S pr i ngs ,

to iron though not n e c e ssarily of commercial value P u ffs of


, .

steam or the smell of sulphur e tt e d hydrogen in a volcanic r e gion


may point to th e exist e nce of sulphur F or instanc e at Rotorua .
,

and White I sland in Ne w Z e aland extensive deposits of sulphur


, ,

ar e found around the num e rous fuma roles both activ e and ,

extinct and at both places the odour of sulphuretted hydrog e n is


,

plainly p e rc e ptible long b e fore t he deposits ar e reached .

Co n dit io n o f M e ta l lic Co n t e nts o f V e in s G old occurs .

in t h e native or uncombined form but at Cripple Cre e k and Kal ,

g o or l ie much of it e xists combined wi t h te llurium .

I n the port i ons of the veins that hav e been subj e c t to the
oxid i sing in u e n c e s of surfac e wat e rs gold occu rs in a fr ee milling,
-

c o 11dit ion tha t is to say it unit e s r e adily wi th m e rcury t o form


-
,

amalgam being fr e e from t ellurium and bas e sulphid e s


,
1
.

Below th e r e ach of oxidising in u e n c e s th e gold is oft e n ,

associated with m e tall i c sulphid e s g e nerally i ron pyrites in which


, ,

it oft e n e xists entangled in an excessiv e ly n e condi ti on so n e ,

that wh e n the recov e ry of the gold is att e mpted by ch e mical


dissolution with a qu e ous sol u tions of potassium cyanide s u fc ie n t ,

e xtrac t ions can only b e obtained wh e n th e sulphides hav e b e en


groun d e xtrem e ly n e so as to e nabl e e ach particl e of gold to co m e
,

in contact with the solvent .

The Waih i bullion extract e d by th e cyanid e proc e ss from th e


M artha Hill lodes contains from on e quart er t o on e third per cent - -
.

o f selenium and on som e occasions as much as 1 p e r c e n t


, bu t .
,

no trace of this rare m e tal can be det e cted i n th e or e itself by


chemical te sts .

S ilv e r or e is generally convert e d in the upp e r part of lodes into


the freem i lling chloride which below water lev e l is displaced by
, ,
-
,

sulphides N ative silver bromid e s a n d iodide often accompany


.
, ,

the chloride .

The sulphides of copp e r lodes ar e conv e rted in th e upp e r portion


of the vein into sooty secondary sulphid e s ox i d e s a n d carbona tes , ,

often of great richn e ss A t th e outcrop t h e copper cont e nts have


.
,

been oxidised and remove d leav i ng rus ty brown caps of ironstone


,

mor e or l e ss quartzose and porous .

P o s itio n o f Va lu a b l e C o nt e nts Som et imes th e m e tallic .

contents of a vein are evenly d i str i buted throughou t the gangue .

1
t e e be e t t go
I t m u s al way s b e r m m r d h a ld m ay b e fr a n d y e t ee ex i t i s n
parti e cl s s o n e t tt e e o i be e i
h a h r is c n s de ra l m c h an c a l dif c u l ty in r n b i ging th e

p rti e
a o t t it e
cl s in c n a c w h th e m rc ury s o a s to obt i
a n a n ad ua rc eq te e overy o f
t h e p e io et o o
r c u s m al in th e f rm f am al am g .
OR E VEI NS . 71

G e nerally ho w ever t h e y occur mor e a t on e po i n t t han anoth e r


, , ,

ex i s ti ng i n m a sses known as bu n ch es n es ts c h im ney sh oots p ip e s , ,


-
, ,

cour se s , p a tcor bon a nzas


h es , p o c ke ts .

O nly i n rare cases do v e ins carry payabl e valu e s for t h e ir whol e


lengt h or i n th e ir full w i dth from wall to wall Henc e a pay
, , ,
.

shoot may be de n e d as t ha t por ti on of an or e body wh i ch is -

comm e rc i ally valuabl e .

Th e majo rity of pay shoo t s dip in t h e sam e dir e ction as t h e -

lod e s bu t g e n e rally at a a tt e f or s tee p e r angl e mor e often th e


, ,

la t ter H e nc e t he pay shoo t is no t always co e x te n s ive wi t h th e


.
- -

lod e a n d often pas s e s ou t in d e pth


,
.

N arrow v e rt i cal or n e arly ver ti cal payabl e po rtions of a v e in


, , ,

ar e te rmed c h imne ys or p ip es 5 and a t n e arly horizonta l por ti ons


, , ,

c ou r ses or ben ch e s .

The caus e s which hav e brought abou t th e unequal dis t rib u t ion
of t h e valuabl e con tents of a lod e i n shoo ts pock ets or cours e s , , ,

ar e eith e r no t known or bu t imp e rfec tly unde rstoo d It has , .

how e v e r b e e n no te d tha t gol d beari ng v ei ns b e com e e n riched a t


,
-

th e int e rs e c t ion of i nd i ca to r beds a n d in ty cro s s cours e s 5 and -

tha t veins traversing propyl it ised andes i te becom e e nrich ed or


impo verished wi t h a s l i gh t chang e in th e charac t er of the ande site .

Th e conn e ct i on of c i rcumstanc e s in thes e cas e s i s manifest but ,

t he exp lanation is dif c u lt .

P a y S h oo t s Th e s e may b e of any s hap e a nd size Th e y


. .

may d i p in th e sa m e dir e c ti on as the lod e and ye t b e inclin e d i n ,

lin e ar e xtension .

FI G . 4 2 L on gitu di n al S ec t io n
. o f Vei n , sh owi g n e io n o f p
suc c ss a y -s h oot s .

( )
a P a y -s h oot s .
( b) Poor gro n d u .

Pay shoots vary from a f e w yards to t housands of feet i n


-

leng th and som eti m e s t wo or mor e shoo t s occur i n th e cours e of


,

a v ei n s e parated by long e r or sho rte r str et ch e s of poor or e as


, ,

shown in g 4 2 . .

The d i p and p i tch of a pay sh oot sho ul d always be carefully -

noted so as to ob ta in a clu e as t o the probabl e pos i ti on of th e


valuable or e a t d i ff e rent l e v e ls .

I n many v e ins t h e payabl e mat e rial do e s not always extend


,
72 MIN I N G G E OL OG Y .

from wall t o wall The valu e s s om e tim e s li e on th e foot wall and


.
-
,

sometim e s on t h e hanging wall or i n a band of o r e situate d n e ar


-
,

th e c e ntre of th e vein or i n a th i n s t r e ak which crosses th e v ei n


,

obl i quely passing from wall to wall


,
.

The ext e nt of the payable ore can always b e a s certained by


syst e matic sampling provi ded a ca r eful r e cord is mad e of th e
,

values on th e m i ne assay plan -


.

G o l d B o na nz a s The rich bonanzas for which th e Tham e s


.

and Coromandel g olde lds are c e l e brated o c cur in th e richer z on e s .

T h ey are places where the quartz contains coars e daubs or mass e s


of gold forming wha t is lo ca lly call e d p icke d or sp e c im e n ston e
, ,

wh i ch i s frequ e ntly found to yield as much as six ounc e s of gol d


to t he pound of ston e .

Th e Hauraki bonanza vari e d from 1 00 to 1 2 0 f e et wide and ,

ext e nd e d to th e 300 f eet level from a poin t about 60 fe e t from


the surface It pitched sl i ghtly to the nort h e ast and was cut
.
,

o ff by a fault abou t 30 f ee t from Bunk e r s boundary



.

I n t h e se g olde lds t he pay shoots commonly occur along t h e lin e


-

of int e rsect i on of a cross v e in or inty wh i ch is a thin indicator


-
,

v ei n consist i ng of dense in ty quartz g e nerally pyrit i c , .

Wa l l M o v e m e n ts O i Ve in s F aulting has tak e n place along


.

the course of most larg e veins I n som e cases the faul t ing took .

place before the llin g of th e ss u r e and i n o ther cas e s when th e , , ,

veins were partially formed but not consoli dat e d .

When th e faulting t ook pla c e after the consoli dation of the lode
matter th e r e sult was the pro duction by attriti on of a lay e r of
,

pug or clay 0 11 th e wall 0 11 which th e movement took place O n .

the sid e on which th e pug occurs all th e small v e ins and dropp e rs
are thus cut o ff or displac e d 5 and it is for this reason that branch
ing veins are only fo und on t he sid e on which no movem e nt has
tak e n place .

I n some classes of country faul t ing along the cours e of a vein


has caused the formation of friction breccias on one or bo t h walls -
.

S uch breccias seldom e xce e d a f e w feet in t h i ckn e ss a n d mos tly ,

form le n ticular shaped mass e s of varying l e ng t h and de pth


-
.

I n hard country movem e n t on th e walls has oft e n produced


,

sl i ck e n sides 5 and in som e cases th e u ca n or clay partings b e tw ee n


-

t h e vein matter and walls has assum e d a a ky or platy charact e r


-

t hrough the str e ss of lat e ral pr e ssure .

I n u e n c e O f C o u nt ry -R 0 c k O bs e rva ti on in many countries


.
-

h as shown that t h e valuable cont e nts of a ve i n are oft e n in u e n ce d


by th e character of the country rock trav e rs e d by th e vein I t i s -
.

also recognis e d that ce rtain rocks favour the occurr e nc e of


par t icular or e s a n d min e rals Thus tin has a pr e f e r e nc e for
.

gran it e rocks 5 whil e copp e r is usually associated w i th serpentines ,


O RE VEIN S . 73

diori te s chlori t ic schists and slates L i meston e mor e especiall y


, ,
.
,

wh e n dolom iti c y ie ld s lead i n many coun t ri e s I n Ch i li a n d


,
.

A us t r ia lia i t y ie l ds lead a n d s i lv e r ; i n Belgi u m z i nc 5 and i n ,

E nglan d iron a n d l e ad ,
.

A chang e i n t h e roc k of t en causes a chang e in th e richn e ss of


a vein .

I n th e Hauraki g olde lds and in Tra n sylvania the veins are ,

produc t ive in al ter e d and es i t e bu t barren in the br e cc i as a n d ,

A t Cr i ppl e Cre e k t he v ei ns a r e m os t productiv e in and e s i t i c


'

tu s .
,

breccias .

I n Y orksh i r e t he l e ad vei n s are good in limestone not so good in


,
-
,

grit and lim e stone wo rse in shale and l i m e ston e and wo rst in shal e
, ,
.

S a n db e rg e r strongly urged th e in u e n c e of coun t ry rock upon -

th e con ten ts of v e ins 5 and his rese arches have be e n su pplemen t ed


and v e ri ed in la te r y e a rs by those of many accomplish ed Am e rican
g e ologists whos e oppo rtuni t i e s for obs e rva ti on in th e e ld hav e
,

been w i de a n d varied .

I n t h e H au rak i g olde lds th e au thor found that th e productiv e ,

cha ra cter of th e v e ins was s trongly in u e n c ed by the containing


rocks The r e sults of h is res ea rch e s in this r e gion du ring a period
.

of tw e lv e yea rs may b e s ummaris e d as foll ows z


( )
a Th e rock which has y ie lded t h e largest quan t i t y of gold is

a m od e ra tely ha rd y e llow i sh gray alte red an de si te t h e -


,

k i n dly san dston e of t h e min e rs .

( )
b Th e m o s t favourabl e country is not too sof t nor y e t too ha id , ,

be i ng s hoo ti ng ground requi ring two or thre e shots to th e ,

shif t .

( )
0 I n v e ry hard country rock t h e v e ins ar e g e n e rally small e
-
r ,

than i n soft roc k 5 and wh e n a v e in passes in to hard


and e si te it invariably becomes smaller a n d of t en th i ns
, ,

out to a m e r e clay pa rting or clay h ea d - -
.

( d ) Th e v e ins in the ha rd rock hav e not prov e d so remunera ~


tiv e as those i n the miner s kindly sa ndston e and this

,

i s du e not so much to t heir leann e ss as to th e ir small e r


siz e and the grea te r cost of working t h e m .

( ) When a v e in pass e s from alte red and e s it e in to a tu or


br e cc i a i t in variably becomes barr e n or too low grad e


, ,

to b e payable This i s true in a ll pa r ts of the Hauraki .

P e n i n s ula 5 and e xp e r ience has shown tha t the v e ins


which e xis t in t u s or br e ccias ar e of te n s u pe r c ia l i n
'

charac ter and s e ldom reliable as gold produc e r s al though


,
-
,

som e have been found to conta i n small shoo t s of a pa y


able natur e 1
.

1
J Park T h e G eol ogy a nd Vei n s o f Hau raki G old e lds N Z
, T r a ns ,
. .
,
.

N Z I lf im n g E n g i n e e r s , v ol i 1 8 97 , p 4 6,
'

. n s t. i . . .
74 MI N IN G G EOLOG Y .

P ro du c t iv e Th e m i ning op e rations of t h e past


Z one s .
-

th i r ty v e years in th e Hauraki ar e a have shown t hat in the


d i ff e rent belts of alt e r e d an de s i te th e r e ar e certa i n zon e s wh i ch


ar e mor e productiv e than o t h e rs E v e n in th e cas e of several .

parall e l v ei ns i t has be e n found that all becom e e nrich e d on


,

e nt e ring the favourable zone t her e by a ff ording a graphic i llustra ,

t ion of t h e min e r s aphorism ore a g a inst ore



,
- -
.

Th e re ar e several such zones in the M oa n a ta ia ri end of th e


Thames e ld th e best known being those at Ku ra n u i Hill and
,
-

Po i nt Russell T h e latt e r a ffords p e rhaps th e most graph i c


.
, ,

ill u stra t ion of th e in u e n c e of favourabl e country A t that .

plac e the M oa n a ta ia r i mine is traversed by four large parall e l


lod e s nam e ly th e D aun tl e ss R e ub e n Parr G ol de n Ag e and
, , , ,

Waiotah i all pursuing a N N E


,
cours e . . . .

O n en te ring t h e productive zone th e ore chang e s from e x ,

c e s s iv e l
y low grade t o h i gh grad e t hi s character b e ing maintained ,

ti l l t h e zone i s pass e d through This zon e crosses t h e course of .

th e lod e s n e arly at right angl e s 1


.

The following d i agram shows the general d i stribution of the


productive zones on this e ld

FI G . 43 .
-
Pl
o f N o th ern Po rtion f T hame G ld ld N Z
an r o s o e , . .

(a h ) G r at M
e t i i f lt
oa n a a a r au ( ) N 9v i e o . e n .

( bb) Poi t R ell pro d ti e zo e


n u ss uc ( f ) C ledo i vei
v n . a n a n.

( cc ) K ur a n ui pro d ti ve zo e o f l tered a de ite


uc ( g ) W io t h i vei
n a n s . a a n .

( cl ) S h oto v r vei
e n .

M ining opera t ions disclosed th e circumstanc e that th e rich


zones w e re not only limited in wid th but also in d e pth F urth e r .
,

th e y w e re found to dip to the southward t hat is in t he opposi te , ,

dir e ction to th e dip of t he veins .

The cross s e ct i on along the l i n e j oining c c shows th e r e lation


-

of th e parall e l v ei ns to t h e K u r a n u i pro duc ti ve zon e .

The shade d portion repr e s e nts t he Ku ra n u i productiv e zon e of


alt e r e d andesite .

J P rk Z it p 5 0 1
. a ,
oo. c , . .
76 MININ G GEOLOGY .

bl e nd e gal e na r e algar st i bn ite and calcit e show a marked


r h ot it e , , , , ,

t e ndency t o aggr e gat e t h e ms e lv e s in horizontal zones in th e


orde r named 1
.

R i ckard m e ntions th e ord e rly distribution of ores in Colorado 2


.

W ee d stat e s that i n th e Castl e M ountain district in M ontana th e , ,

ord e r appears to be gal e na on top passing i nto h i ghly zinc i f e rous ,

ores b e low and th e s e i nto low grad e pyr it e


,
3 -
.

A t Brok e n Hill l e ad and silv e r min e s in N ew South Wal e s , ,

th e gen e ral distribution of ores in v e rt i cal depth has b ee n as


follows :
( )
a O xidised or e s of l e ad and silv e r .

G alena with bl e nd e ,
.

( )
c Blende with galena , .

W ee d in a pap e r on O r e D e pos it ion and V ein E nr i chm e nt


,
1

by Ascend i ng Hot Waters app e ars to support the hypoth e s i s ,

which assumes t hat t h e d i s tribu ti on of ores in hori z ontal zon e s is


th e r e sult of primary conc e ntra t ion by ascend i ng hot solutions .

This vi e w has much to commend it .

Th e e rupt i on of ign e ous magmas is of te n succ e ed e d by int e ns e


solfataric act i on of wh i ch notable e xamples are found in t h e
,

Y e llowston e Park in t h e Unit e d Stat e s a n d in the volcanic r e g i on


, ,

of th e N or t h I sland of Ne w Zealan d .

Th e asc e nd i ng waters slowly circulating in contact with h e ated


rocks b e low b e com e sup e rh e at e d and in their upward cours e d i s ,

solv e vari ous substanc e s wh i ch th e y carry with th e m along th e ,

line o f leas t resis tanc e that is t owards th e hot spring pipe or , ,

vent
.

M any substances insolubl e in normal con di tions are r e nd e r e d


, ,

e asily soluble in the pr e s e nc e of h e at and pressur e Th e un de r .

ground wat e rs will therefore possess their gr e at e st solvent pow e r


, ,

wh e r e the gr e atest h e at and pr e ssur e preva i l wh i ch w i ll naturally ,

be at th e great e st de pth .

W i th loss of hea t and pressur e the l e as t soluble substanc e s ,

will be pr e cip it at e d tha t i s those substanc e s whos e dissolu t ion ,

was eff e ct e d un de r e x t r e m e h e a t a n d pr e ssure .

As the wat e rs asc e nd t h e y w i ll con ti nu e to los e h e at a n d b e


r e liev e d of pressur e wi t h th e resul t tha t th e d i ssolv e d m i n e rals
,

w i ll b e pr e c i pita te d i n th e inv e rs e order of th ei r solub i l ity


When th e hot wat e rs r e ach th e surface the only subs tanc e s i n ,

solution in most cas e s will b e the extr e m e ly solubl e alkal i n e


1
. . p
J H S u rr, loc c it , p 8 4 1 . . . .

2
J . ik
A R c ard, T r a n s I ns t M in a n d M e t , L n d n , v ol Vi
. . . . o o . .
,
1 8 99, p 1 96
. .

3
Weed a nd P irs s on , B u l le ti n 1 39, U S C eol S u r ve y , 1 896 . . . .

1
"

W H . . We
e d, T r a ns A me r I n s t M E , v ol xxx .
,
1 90 3 . . . . . iii . .
O RE V E IN S .
77

sulphat e s carbonates and silicates I n support of this i t may be


, , .

ment ioned that hot spr i ngs commonly deposit silica and rarely
m etallic s ul phides a t th e surface .

I n many lod e s it is a common f e atur e to nd sulphi des or t h e ir ,

ox i dised produc t s a t the surface but in such cases it i s always


, ,

well to bear i n min d that veins wh i ch ou tc rop a t t h e surfac e may


hav e been t runca te d t o a gr ea te r or l e ss d e gr ee by d e nuda t ion .

Th e obvious i nferenc e to b e d rawn from th i s proc e ss of ve in


llin g is that impov e rishm e n t hi t h e or e mus t ta k e plac e i n all
v e ins at grea t d e p t hs du e to th e migra t ion of th e valuable
,

minerals from t he zo ne of dis so lu tion b e low to t h e zone of p r ec ip ita


tion abov e .

S e c o n da ry E n ric h m e n t O f V e in s I t h as be e n not e d in all .

parts of the globe that r i ch masses of or e ofte n oc cur in t h e


ox i dise d por ti on of the or e b ody or in t ha t po rti on ly i ng n ear
-
,

water l e vel
-
.

M icroscopic invest i ga t ion has shown tha t t h e s e r i ch mass e s are


not of primary but of s e condary origin Th e ir g e nes i s is supposed .

to be due t o the m i gra t ion of t h e valuable me tallic con t en t s from


t he higher pa rt of t he ve i n t o the lower pa rt of t h e oxidised zone
by the agency of meteoric wa t ers .

I n some cas e s the process e s of d i ss olut i on mig ra ti on and


, , ,

red epos i tion may have taken pl ace over and ov e r again each cycle ,

resulting i n an i ncr e as i ng d e gr e e of concentra ti on .

The veins in which secondary enr i chm e n t ar e mos t ofte n s e en


are thos e of gold s ilver copp e r lea d and zinc
, , , ,
.

G old ores in t he zone of wea ther in g are ofte n augm e nted in


, ,

value by the long con ti nued disintegr a t ion of the v e in and the e n
-

closing rock thus perm i tting the gold s e t free from its matrix t o
,

conc e ntrate at the outcrop .

E xtensive areas of th e Aus t ralian contin e nt have be e n subj ect


to sub ae r i al d enuda ti on sinc e the close of t he Pal aeo zoic p e r i od
-
,

and it is doub tl e ss du e to this caus e that so many no tabl e exampl e s


of mech a nica l enrich m en t of gol d bearing veins have b e en found i n
-

V ictoria and West e rn Austral i a .

Th e m i gr ation of gold copp e r s i lver lead and zinc from t h e


, , , ,

upper to t he lower par ts of t he ve i ns i s affe ct e d by d e sc e nd i ng


surf ace wat e rs in t h e zone of vadose circula t ion The processes .

involv e d i n t h e m i gra t ion are ( a ) chemi c al dissolut i on and ( b) ,

e lec t ro ch e mical deposi t ion


-
.

Ch e mical proc e ss e s may op e rate in various ways t o ca us e


secondary e nr i chmen t as follows ,

( ) y
1 B t he r e moval of wor thl e ss me ta l s t h e r e b y l eaving t h e ,

valuable cont e n t s i n a pur e r form .


78 MININ G GEOLOGY .

( ) y
2 B r e moval of worthless metals and their replacements by
valuable m e tals remov e d from a high e r par t of the vein .

( ) y
3 B d e position of valuable m e tals on primary sulph i d e s in ,

thos e por t i ons of the ve i n subj e c t to the in u e n c e of


circulating surface waters I n t h i s case th e primary .
,

sulphides may form th e nuclei for the d e posit of th e


s e condary sulph i des .

M anife s tly the rs t op e ration in the proc e ss of s e condary e n


r ic h m e n t is the ch e mical w ea t h e r i ng and oxidat i on of th e m etall i c

cont e n t s of the v e in i n the Katamorphic zon e .

Th e ox i dation of bas e sulphid e s can b e s ee n in op e ration e v e ry


day I n a mass of mixed sulphides of iron copp e r z i nc and
.
, , ,

galena th e iron will be the rs t to be a ffecte d from i t s a f n ity for


,

oxygen .

I ron pyrit e s is decompose d and forms ferrous sulphat e which is ,

changed into Fe ( O H) 3 Fe 2 ( S O4 )2 and H2 S O4 The


,
attack s , .

mor e iro n sulph i de and forms ferrous sulphate liberating 112 8 , ,

wh i ch at onc e comb i n e s with free oxyg e n to form H2 8 0 4 .

The ferrous sulphate changes to the ferri c sulphate which attack s ,

gold and sulphid e s of copp e r lead zinc and silver The process , , , .

of dissolution must n e c e ssarily be slo w on accoun t of the extreme ,

dilution of t h e solutions .

F or many y e ars i t was beli e v e d that th e only secondary enrich


ment that could take place was th e formation of rich bonanzas of
carbonate or e s and chloride of silver in th e zone above water level ,
-
.

But careful inv e s t igation in later years has shown that primary
sulphides have b e en e nriched by th e d e posit i on of secondary
sulph i d e s even in places below pr e sent water l e vel -
.

I t was prov e d e xp e rimentally by Sk e y in 18 70 and c on r m e d


1
,

by L iversidg e in 1893 t hat gold is mor e read i ly prec i p i tat e d


2
,

from its solut i ons by metallic sulphides than by organ i c matt e r .

F ur t h e rmore Skey show e d that sulphides of the base m e tals w e re


,

readily pr e c i pitated from alkaline sulphide solutions in a solid


coh e rent form in t he presen c e of iron pyri t es galena blend e , , ,

stibnite etc , .

Th e descend i ng acid solutions form e d in th e zone of oxida t ion


will attack th e constitu e nts of th e rocks through which they per
colat e with the production of alkaline silicat e s and sulphid e s .

G ol d dissolved by ferric sulphate would b e also carried down


and d e posi t ed as l e af scale or wire gold in cracks i n sulphide ore
, , ,

th e r e by caus i ng local e nrichm e nt .

It is main t a i ned by some writers that secondary sulphides have


1
W .ke S y ,
T r a ns N. ew Z ea l a n d I ns t .
,
v ol . iii
1 8 70 , p 22 6
.
, . .

2
Pro e o f s s r L v rs di e i ge ,
P r oc . R oy . S oc . N e w S ou th Wa les , v ol xx v 11 . .
,
1 893,
p.2 8 7 .
O R E VE N s I . 79

b e en formed below water l e v e l The ev i d e nce on th i s qu e stion is -


.

not qu it e conclusive I n some cas e s chang e s of wa te r l e v e l may


.
-

have ta k e n place sinc e the secondary s u lph i d e s w e r e de pos ite d .

Th e researches of E mmons W e e d a n d o th e rs have thrown


1 2
, ,

much l i gh t on th e s e condary enr i chm e nt o f v e in d e po s its bu t much ,

s t ill r ema i ns to be don e before safe g e n e ral i sa ti ons can b e form e d .

Som e ve i ns through mov e ment of th e wall s hav e b e en sha tte red


, ,

to som e e xt e n t a n d r e c e men ted by m i n e ralis e d w a ters Such .

wa t ers asc e nding through t h e crush e d 1 ei n ma t te r woul d d e pos i t -

th ei r m e tall i c con te nts as sulphide s t hrough t h e re ac ti on of


pr i mary sulph i des conta in e d 1n t h e or e .

I n t his way a s e condary concentra t ion of primary sul ph i des


,

may be eff ected by ascending wate rs .

T h e A bsorp tion of M e tal s by C l a y s in R e l a tion to S e c ond a r y


E n mch men t 1t of ten happ e ns tha t t he or e in t he zon e of
'

s e condary e nrichm e nt is associa te d wi th , or con t a i n e d in , a ma t rix


cons i s ti ng of clay or oth e r n e ly di v i de d m i neral ma tte r Of .

th i s th e r e ar e no mor e cha ract e r i stic examples than th e Kaol i n


silv e r ores of Brok e n Hill and the talcose gold or e s of Kalgoorl ie .

Clay a n d clay e y ma t ter ar e t h e natural produc t s of t h e a lte ra


t ion of rocks and ores i n t h e zon e of Katamorphism Th e i r .

pres e nce calls for no comm e n t ; bu t th e fr e qu e nt occurr e nc e of


rich or e s i n a clay e y ma t rix in certain lodes has led t o much
spe cula t ion as to t h e r e la t ion existing betwe e n th e clay and its
m e tallic con t ents .

I t has b ee n sugg e st e d by som e wri te rs t hat the a s socia t ion is


not acc i d e n tal nor t h e resul t of parag e n e s i s bu t du e to som e ,

absorp ti v e quali ty of the clay Tha t clay and n e ly d i v i de d .

ma t ter poss e ss t he prop e r ty of abs o rb i ng or e x t rac ti ng m eta l s


from th e ir a qu e ous solutions has long b e en known a nd wi t h t h i s ,

knowledg e i n mind i t has been contend e d t hat th e clay e y mat te r


ac t ing as a porous lt e r in th e lower part of the zone of ox i da ti on ,

t hat i s i n th e b e lt of cem e n ta t ion has absorbed t h e m etals from ,

t h e d e sc e nding solu t ions t h e r e by e ff e c t ing a concen t ra t ion of ,

the valuable conten t s .

Ther e is much t o b e sa id in favour of this vi e w b u t it has st i ll ,

t o b e d e termin e d wh e th e r clay e y mat t er and c e r ta i n porous


substances ar e primary or m e rely con t ribu ti ng causes i n t h e ,

forma t ion of zon e s of s e condary e nr i chm e n t .

Walt e r Harvey W ee d e arly i n 190 5 d e scr i bed some e xp e r i


3
, ,

1
S . F E mm
. o ns , T r a ns A m I ns t M E
. . . . .
,
1 0 1 .xxx 1 90 0 .
, .

2
W . H . Weed , B u ll G e l S oc A na ,
. o . . v ol . xi 1 900 p
.
,
. 1 79 ; a nd T ra n s .

A m I . n st .

3 W . H . Weed ,
Ab orption i

s n O re Depo s ition ,
T h e E n g i neer in g a nd

M in ing J ou r . N e w Y ork 2 3 d F b , r e . 1 90 5 .
80 MININ G GEOLOGY .

ments on the absorptive property of clays e tc made by himself , .


,

and others in the laboratory of the U nited S tates G eological


Survey in Washington The results c on r m e d the researches of .

W S k e y made in 186 9 and of E Kohler in 1 90 3 Wh o found


.
1
, .
,

that clays and porous substances such as gelatinous silica , ,

carbonaceous and colloidal matter possess th e power of extrac t ing ,

metals from their dilute aqueou s solutions .

I n 1 8 6 9 Skey prove d experimen tally that n e ly pulveris e d


2
,

massive quartz rock crystal a n d s i lica possess the power of, ,

e xtract i ng the ox i de of iron from its acetate solution He also .

found that prepar e d silica especially manifests th i s prop e rty i f


ignited at a low temperature and besides takes oxides of copp e r ,

and chromium fro m their acetate solutio n s T h e mor e n e ly .

divid e d the silica the more apparent is the abso rption .

I n 18 7 1 he found that wh e n a w e ak ammon i acal solution of


,

copper containing a little c aus t ic potash is pour e d upon a lte r


of S wedish paper (cell u los e ) the li quid which pass e s through th e ,

paper is quit e or n e arly colourless and the lt e r is found to have ,

r e tained all or nearly all of the copper of such solution


,
3
, .

I n 1874 the same chemist showed that clay possesses the


,

property of absorbing and xin g natural petroleum i n su ch a way


as to form a subs tance resembling natural oil shale the oil being -
,
4
chemically combined with the clay .

S ke y s discovery that g e lati n ous silica and porous substances


possess the prope rty of absorbing metals from their solutions has
an impo rtant bearing upon th e ch e mistry of ore deposition in -

veins and in se c ondary enrich m e nt .

I m p ov e ris h m e nt o f Ve in s in D e p th T A Rickard when . . .


,

discussing Professor P os e p n y s classic paper 0 11 The G enesis of



O r e D eposits states that the general non pe rsist e nce of ore in
,
-

depth is a fact capable of proof 5


He contends that sinc e h e at .

and pressure are the two great factors which incr e as e the solubility
of mineral substan c es the de e p region will favour solut i on the ,

most wh i le the shallow zone will favour precipitation owing t o


, ,

t he decrease of heat a nd pressure .

There i s much in favour of this c ontention Progressive poverty .

1
Koh ler Z it ch if t f p kti h G l gi 1 903 p 4 9
E .
,
e s r ur ra sc e eo o c, , . .

W S key O th Ab orpti ve Propertie o f S i li a d it dire t Hy d


2
.
,
n e s s c an s c
i c o ta t with Water
n n

T ncN w Z l n d I n t Wel l ingt o n N Z 1 86 9
, ra s. e ea a s .
, , . .
, ,

vo l ii p 15 1
. . . .

W S key
3
Ab orption o f Copper from its A mm oni l S ol tion b y
.
,

s aca u

C ell l o e in pre e e o f C u ti Pot h T


u s N w Z
s nc l nd I n t l iv a s c as ,
r a ns . e ea a s . vo . .
,

p 332 1 87 1
.
, .

4
W S y, N
. ke
s on th e F rm a n an d ns u oten fT r o tio Co tit tio o o b nite a an d

i i
s m lar M n ra l s ,

i e
T r a ns N ew Z ea la n d I ns t v ol v p 3 8 7 ,
1 874
. . ii . . . .

5
T A R c ard, . G n s is f O re D
. ik s s, D tsm ss ion , p 1 90 e e o epo it . .
O R E VE IN S . 81

in depth below a c e rtain depth must be the natu ral corollary of


th e g e neral law governin g the o rderly d i s t r i bution of ores in
horizontal zones through t he agency of as cending wate rs
,
.

I n some cas e s impoverishment i n d e pth i s dete rmi n e d by t he


,

prevail i ng geolog i cal conditions O re v e in s which ar e con n e d .


~

to a s i ngl e ov e rly i ng form ation often die out or becom e exhausted


on reach i ng the un de rlying rock .

A notabl e e xample of th i s is affo rd ed by t he hydro t hermal -

ve i ns of th e Tham e s Tapu Co romandel and Kuao t un u m in i ng, , ,

d i str i ct s in th e Hauraki m i n ing reg i on of N ew Zealand wh e re


, ,

the gol d bearing v ei ns are contain ed in al te red an des it es which


-
,

r e st on a h i ghly e rod ed surfa ce of L ower Me sozoic shales gr e y ,

wacke a n d ad i nole
, .

M ining op e rations have in all cas e s shown that when the veins
wh i ch occur n ear the bo rde r s of the and e si te o ws r ea c h the
bas emen t rock th e y d i e out completely or end in small strings
, , ,

which soon disapp e ar in depth .

Th e pr i nciple of secondary en richmen t preclude s the c ont i nuance


of th e enri ched po rt i on of t he v e in downward in ve rt ical dis tance .

When the valu e s of secondary enrichm ent are added t o ore


already of a payabl e quali ty t h e r e sul t is a rich shoot or bonanza 5 ,

but when as often happens th e secondary values a re added to lean


, ,

or e then th e n e t r e s ul t is to rend e r the l e an ore j us t payable


, .

Below th e zone of enrichment th e lean ore will be u n p ro ta b le , .

Thus secondary en richmen t is a concen tration o f values in


th e oxidised or Kata mo rphi c zone due to t h e tra n fe re n c e of th e
valuabl e con tents from a high e r to a lower l e v e l by the o w of
mete oric waters O nly in rare c ases w ill prima ry s u lphid e s b e
.

enriched by t his ag e ncy .

Th e Mi ning Comm i ssioners of V i c tori a includ i ng the late


1
,

Profe ssor M Coy and M r Alfred S e lwyn t h e S tate g e ologist



, ,

r e ported in 1 85 7 t hat e xper ie nc e in e v e ry country h ad p roved


t hat th e yield of gold decreased wi th the depth afte r a ce rta in
small lim i t was reached .

Th e conclusion of the Commi s s i on e rs was in unison wi t h the


1

O pinion alr e ady expressed by S ir Ro derick M ur ch i s on i n th e rs t


ed it ion of his S itu ma This distingu i shed g e olog i s t a s th e
2

.
,

resul t of f urt her knowledge was induc e d to ma te r i ally mod i fy h i s ,

v ie w par t icularly h e tells u s as r e spec t s t he colony of V ic tor i a 5


, , ,

bu t he still adher e d to t he belief t hat in g e neral gold ve i ns


d i m i nish in value as they d e scend 2
.

1
R e po r t to S u r v eyor C e ne ra l -
a nd Ch ief S ec re ta ry o n the M in in g R es o ur ce s of
th e Co l on y of Victor i a , 1 85 6 -5 7 .

2
o eri k
S ir R d c I m p e y M u c h r i s on ,
S i ln r ta , th i nd editio n, 1 85 9, p . 4 94 .

3
L oc c it , p 4 96
. . . .
82 MINI N G GEOLOGY .

The discovery of payable gold in a saddle reef in the N ew -

Ch u m Rail way M ine at B e ndigo at a d e pth of 4 15 6 feet in , ,

M arch 1 90 5 proves that the limit in depth assumed by M urc hiso n


,

must be exten de d t o a dept h probably not under 5 0 0 0 feet .

I n dic a t o r B e ds I t i s now generally r e c ognised that a.


-

vein may become e n riched or impov e r i shed in passing from


one kind of rock to another Thus lead veins which are .
,

productiv e in limeston e are often poor in sandstone or shale 5 ,

and gold v e ins payable in andesite are often barren in tufts or


, ,

breccias :
There are som e w e ll known cases wher e this in u e n ce is -

e xhibited in a sp e cial an d notable man ner I n Kongsberg in .


,

N orway the prevailing rocks are gneiss and c rystallin e sch i sts
,
.

C e rtain bands or zones of the latter are impregnated w i th n e ly


divid e d sulphides of iron copper zinc and oc c asionally o r es of , , ,

l e ad ni ck e l cobalt and s i lver


, , , .

Thes e mineralised bands locally known as fa h lbands conform , ,

to the strike and d i p of the enclosing gneiss and schist .

The c ountry rock and fahlbands are inte rse c ted by silv e r bearing
- -

veins and it is notorious that these veins ar e only productive


,

where they t ravers e th e fahlbands .

T h e indicator beds of Ballarat in V ictoria have exercised a


-
, ,

remarkable in u e n ce upon the distribution of the gold in the


v e ins of that ar e a .

Th e countryrocks are Silurian slates and sa ndstones which ,

are generally tilt e d at high angl e s and often approa c h t he ,

vertical position They ar e interb e dded with ce r tain thin seams


.

of black carbonaceous shale or slat e to which th e nam e indica tor s ,

is locally applied from the circums tance that wher e ver a qua rtz
,

v e in cross e s one of these shale seams it uniformly be c omes rich e r -


,

a long th e plan e of inters e c tion .

The most p e rsistent of the shale seams known as T h e I ndica tor -


, ,

is describ e d by E L idg e y as a narrow bed of dark slat e


1
.
,

usually showing cleavage planes and con taining a large per ,



centage of pyrite distributed irregularly through it ,
I t varies .

from a mere sheet to an inch thick and c an be tra c ed for a ,

d istance of 7 or 8 miles I t is nearly vertical and is .


,

int e rs e cted by a s e ries of nearly hori z ontal quartz s e ams which -


,

ar e commonly enriched a t or in the vicinity of the indicator 2


, ,
.

D r Jack in his report on G ymp i e g olde ld in Qu e ensland


, , ,

stat e s that t h e v e ins are richest i n c e rta i n bands oi black shale 5 -

1
E L idg e y , R ep or t
. on th e B E a st C oldf te ld
a lla r a t .

2
T . A R c ard, . ik i to ei
T h e I n d ca r V n , B al lara t A tralia T ,
us ,
r a n s.

A m er ica n I n st . v ol.
,
xxx
1 90 1 , p 1 0 94
. i paper o t in
Th . . s c n a s an
i tere ti g
n s n s u mm a ry o f i b e t e ti g to
th e a va la l da a r la n i di ator
th e n c s
,
84 MININ G G EOLOGY .

P a ra g e n e s is .

I t has be e n shown by mining operations everywhere that


certa i n m i nerals and or e s are mor e frequently associated with
e ach other than with other minerals The g e netic processes .

wh i ch caus e d t he format i on or deposition of a certain mineral


oft e n Operated so as to cause the deposition of anoth e r mineral ,

or minerals at the sam e time and in the same pla c e


,
.

This parallel or synchrono u s genesis of ores and minerals


, , ,

which has brought about a common association in the matrix is ,

known as p a r ag en esis and is probably governed by the laws of ,

chemical solution and pre c ipitation Substances soluble at th e .

sam e t e mperature and pressure will pass out of solution together


i n the zone of decreas e d pressure or temp e rature The causes .

which led to the constant association of certa in minerals su c h for , ,

example as gold and quartz tin and wolfram are still very
, , ,

obscure .

The following table on the basis of that comp i led by V on Cotta , ,

affords a clear V iew of the ores and mineral commonly asso c iated
in metalliferou s deposits
A SS O C I AT ED O RE S AN D M I N ER A L .

T wo M m e ber s . T hr ee Member s . F o ur o r M ore Member s.

G alena , b l en de ,
G alena
e blende i ron p yrite ,
b lende ,
i ro n G al n a , ,
s,

pyrites q artz , u .

Iron p yrite ch l Iro p yrite h l py Iro p yrite


s, a h al op yrite
n s, c a co n s, c c ,

copy it r rite q artz


e, g lena b le de q rtz ,
u ,
a ,
n , ua .

G o ld q rtz
,
ua G o ld qu rtz
, G o ld quartz i ro n p yrite,
a , , ,
s,
pyrite b le de g lena r eni cal s, n ,
a , a s

p yrite s .

G ol d tel l ri m
, G o l d te ll ri m q rtz G o ld tell ri m i ron pyrit
u u , ,
u u ,
ua ,
u u ,
es ,
q rtz ua .

Cob l t n d n i k l Cob l t d n ickel


a a c Cob lt nd ni kel ore
e a an o1e s , a a c s,

ore s, p yrrh otite pyr h otite q artz , r ,


u .

T wo l fr m
111-ore , Ti w lf q
a t Ti , wo l fram q rtz
n -ore , o ra a1 , u ar z n o re , ,
ua ,

to rm line u a .

Ci b r
nn a a Ci b r i ron p yrite C i b r iro n py rite
, n na a ,
s, nn a a ,
s,
p yrit es, q artz q rtz l p r u , ua ,
ca c s a .

M g eti t
a n h l orite M g etite
e, c h lorite M g etite ,
h lo r ite gar et
a n ,
c ,
a n , c ,
n ,

g r et pyroxene py rite a n , ,
s .

C h o m ite
r
p C h ro mite erpenti e C h ro mite er penti e ol i i e
,
ser en ,
s n , ,
s n ,
v n
,
ti e n ,
o l ivi ne py o xene , r .

I n a general way e xp e rience has shown that tin tungsten or e s , , ,

and gol d hav e a preferenc e for siliceous rocks ; and iron c h ro ,

m i um platinum nick e l and copper for basic rocks


, , , .
O R E y am s . 85

R oc k T Un t il r e c e n t y e ars
e m p e ra tu re s in D e e p M in in g .

i t was bel ie v e d by phys i c i sts t hat the i ncr e a se of te mp e ra t ur e ,

nam e ly 1 F ahr for ev e ry 6 0 fee t obs e rved in th e driving of t h e


, .
,

Sain t G othard tunnel was th e normal rat e in all pa rts of t h e ,

crust of the ea rt h Thi s b e l ie f is n o w known to b e e rron e ous . .

O bservations tak e n i n d e ep m i n e s and bore holes in diffe r e nt par t s -

of E urop e America and Aus tralia during t he past de cad e hav e


, , , ,

prov e d t hat o

( ) Th
a e t emp e rature of t h e cr u st i ncreas es with the d i stanc e

from th e surfac e .

That t h e ratio of i ncr e as e of temp e rature to d e p th t e t h e ,


. .
,

temperatur e gradient is not the same in all places -


, .

( )
0 That t he t emp e rature gra d i e nt is not uniform for all d e p t hs -

e v e n in t he sam e plac e ; tha t is isog e oth e rms ar e no t ,

parall e l in the uppe r part of the crus t 1


.

( )
d That t he temperatur e g rad i ent incr e as e s with th e d e p t h -
.

I n the Comstock lod e which i s e nclosed in and e sit e s of middl e ,

T e rtiary dat e the temperatur e w as found to ris e 1 F ahr for


, .

every 30 f ee t in d e p th 2
Th i s i ncr e a s e is e xc e p ti onal and .

appar e ntly caus e d by a s t rong upwa rd o w of h e a te d wa te rs i n


th e v e in s s u r e s The g e olog i c condi ti ons sugg e s t t h e waning
-
.

phas e s of solfataric ac ti on as th e sourc e of th e h e a te d wa ters .

A t t h e O haeawa i qu i cksilv e r m i n e s in N ew Z e alan d th e rock ,

t e mp e ratur e incr e ased so rapidly tha t boil i ng water was met w i th


at a dep t h of 2 0 0 fe e t from th e surface H e r e again w e ar e .

man if e s tly d ealing with expir i ng volcanic heat Th e basa l t cap .

of quite late T e rt ia ry dat e t he ho t springs and sinters sulphur , , , ,

and cinnabar d e posits leav e lit tl e room for doubt in t h i s ins t anc e .

Volcanoes whe th e r r e c e nt or Te rtiary ar e situa t e d in a h


, ,

n o rmally ho t parts of the crus t Som e parts how e ver a re .


, ,

abnormally cool F or in stanc e P rof e ssor Agassiz found in t h e .


,

Calum e t and H e cla mine at L ake Supe rior a ris e of only 1 ,


F ahr for e very 2 2 3 feet in d e pth


.
3
.

I n four gold mining centr e s in V ictoria t h e increase of 4 -


,

temperate was foun d to b e as follows


South M aldon M ine M aldon ,

1 F ah r for e v e ry 8 1 feet i n d e pth down to 1 700 feet



. .

1
Pro fe or R e dmay n ,
ss e
U nd r r und T m ra ur s , S ou th S ta or dsh ir e ego e pe t e '

a nd E as t Wor ces ters h i r e I ns t M in E ng , 190 4 . . . .

2
G F B c r,.

. e ke
T h e G l y f th e m s c L d , Jlf onog rap h I I I , eo og o C o to k o e .

p . 2 6 3 , 1 88 2 , U S G a l S u r v ey , a sh n t n
. . o . W i go .

3 Poe o
r f ss r A iz
s e , A me r ic a n J ou r n a l of S c ien ce , v ol 18 95, p 5 03 i . . .

1
H C J e n in s ,

.

.R c

T m ra ur s in V c r a, P r oc A us t A ss oc o k e pe t e i to i . . .

A dv S e , v ol ix p 30 9, 1 90 2
. . . . .
86 MININ G GEOLOGY .

South G a i d e n G ully Bendigo ,

1 F ahr for every 1 7 fe e t m depth do wn to 300 0 f ee t



. .

Band and Albion Mi ne Ballarat ,

1 F ahr for e v e ry 80 f ee t in dep t h down to 2 0 80 fe e t


. .

Ne w Chum Railway B e ndigo ,

1 F ahr for ev e ry 7 7 5 feet i n d e pth down to 3 6 4 5 fee t


. .

Th e country rock l n each case is S ilu i ia n slate and sandston e


-
.

The following tabl e s of rock temperatures prepared by Professor -

E ver e tt are of much i nt e r e st in c onn e ction with this que stion


1
,
.

T AB L E I .
OB S ERVAT I ON S O F T E M PER A T U RE A T MI N ES

AN D V ER T I C AL B o a m e s .

F e et
Depth D e ree o f
pe r
( feet )
c
O

I mercas e
.

P a ru s c h ow itz ( S l s a ) iei ,

eb epi
S c h lad a c h ( n ea r L i s c ) ,
Spe b g e e i
re n e r ( n ar B rl n ) ,
W ee i g We t i gi i
h l n ( s V r n a),
Pe eto e
n dl e te
n ( n ar Man c h s r) ,
Port J k o n ac s

R b idg ( e r Wig )
os e r e n a an ,

D ki l d ( M n h e ter)
u n e a c s ,

A h to M o ( n ar M h
s n ss e an c e s te n

T m r k ( L ke S perio r )
a a ac a u ,

S arle ( L i o l h i re )
c nc ns ,

Ki g woo d ( ne r Bri tol )


n s a s ,

T AB L E 11 .
D 1 E THS A T WH I C H 10 0

FA H R .

T A B L E I II .
C A L C U L AT ED D EP T H S A T

WO U L D B E FO U N D .

F eet .

R os e b ridg e ,
S carl , e 344 9
Kin g s w o od , 34 69
D u kin e ld , 3 6 72
W e i g
h el n , 37 2 2
A to o
sh n M ss , 4 1 92

Pro fes or e ett


,

1
s J D Ev r
.
,
Ev ide nce bef or e th e Roy a l Co mm iss ion
Coa l S u pp lies , Lo o
nd n , 1 90 4 .
88 MININ G GEOLOG Y .

tur e it is r e markabl e how lit t l e trus t worthy info rma t ion has b ee n
,

record e d i n regard to progr e ss i v e und e rground t e mp e ra t ur e s e ven ,

i n plac e s wh e r e mining has b e en carr ie d on for g e nera t ions Th e .

ti m e i s approaching when the recording of rock t e mp e ratur e s -

must b e s yst e matically und e rtak e n in all d ee p m i nes .

T e mperatures should b e noted w it h r e asonabl e skill and pr e


c is io n a t regular int e rvals both when sinking a n d d r i ving i n n e w

ground 5 and at all plac e s wher e ther e is a chang e of rock .

O bserva t ions taken in a carel e ss or haphazard mann e r are of no


valu e a n d in som e cas e s may ev e n be worse than usel e ss as th ey
, ,

may l e ad to th e formation of e rron e ous conclusions .

Th e pr e caut i ons to b e obs e rv e d in taking und e rground t e m


e ra tu r e s have been succinctly summarised by H C J e n kin s
1
p as . .

follows
Temperatures should be taken in ne w g r ou nd that is i n th e
( )
1 , ,

fac e or head i ng fr e shly brok e n wh e r e th e work is b e ing ,

rapidly pushed ahead Th e rock walls soon becom e .

cool e d by v e n ti lating currents .

( )
2 Where possibl e th e rock should b e free from sulphid e s
easily oxidised since chemical r e actions a t t e nding ox i da
,

t ion are e xo t herm i c When sulphide s ar e pres e nt t he .

t e mperature should b e tak e n at onc e .

( )
3 V ery w e t ground must b e avoid e d as i t will gen e rally giv e ,

a lower r e ading than th e true on e s i nce t he water w i ll ,

in mo s t cases be descending surfac e wa te r O n th e -


.

oth e r hand ascend i ng de e ps e ated wat e r will t e nd t o


,

exaggerate th e temp e ratur e .

( 4 ) After drilling s u f c ie n t t i m e ,must be giv e n to p e rm i t th e


abnormal h e at of drilling to diss i pat e its e lf befor e taking
a rock t e mperature A f e w minutes will generally s u f c e
-
.

for t his .

( )
5 Th e drill hol e must be -
deep e nough to avoid th e tempera
tur e of the face of rock Agass i z used holes 10 f e et deep . .

I n th e maj ority of cases 6 f ee t holes are s u f c ie n t .

( ) The bor e hol e s should be horizon t al by pref e rence


6 -
.

7
( ) T h e t e mp e ratures should b e tak e n with a high class clinical -

t hermometer graduated from say 80 t o 1 15 F ahr a n d


, , ,

reading to 0 0 5 F ahr and corr e cted against a standard


,
.

thermom e ter Wh e n ins e r t e d in th e hole the t h e rmom e ter


.
,

should be wrapped round with three layers of a n n e l .

L im its O f D e e p M in in g M ining at great depths w i ll be .

limi t ed by t h e underground temperature and economic considera


1
H C
. . J e n kin s , R o k T em perat re
c u s in V i c tori a , P r oc . A u st . A ssoc . A dv
.

S e v ol . ix .
p 30 9, 1 90 2
. .
O RE V E I NS . 89

t ion s B y t h e ad op tion of secon dary v e n ti la t ion a n d m et hods of


.

r e frig e ra ti on mining coul d doub tl e s s b e ca rr i ed on a t de p t hs


ranging up to 65 0 0 fe e t according to t h e local i ncr e men t of
temp e ra t u re .

M e tas o m a tic R e p lac e m e n t Unt i l lat e ly it wa commonly s

b e l ie ved t ha t or e d e posi t s m e r e ly lle d pr e ex i s ti ng ss u r e s a n d


- -

cavi tie s in coun t ryrock I n r e c e nt y e ars write rs on or e forma ti on


.
-

hav e been incl i ned to plac e mor e or less s t ress on wha t has be e n
t ermed me tas om a tic r ep la ce men t
.

Accord i ng t o this it i s surmis e d tha t i n many cas e s a t l e as t no


, , ,

previous caviti e s e x i sted but tha t t he waters p e rcola t ing thr ough
,

t h e rocks dis solved cer t a i n t ra cks or zon es which t h e y r e plac e d


wi t h or e mat ter and gangu e
-
.

This proc e s s of r e placem e nt is w e ll known to petrologists to


have tak e n plac e among t he constituents of many roek mass e s no -
,

ma t te r how dens e includi ng all me tamo rphic rocks and all ol d er


, ,

i gn e o us and e rupt i v e mass e s .

I t is known as metasomatism ( mean i ng chang e of body ) a n d is ,

du e to inte rnal ch e mical r e ac ti ons wh i ch s e e m to tak e plac e as ,

r eadily in rocks as do th e m e tabolic chang e s in liv i ng organ i sms .

I n many cas es m i n e rals are replaced mol e cul e by molecul e ,

giving r i s e t o wha t i s te rm ed min e ral ps e udomorph i sm Bu t i n .

t h e processes wh i ch a ff e ct chang e s i n rock mas s e s r e ac ti ons ar e -


,

s e t up b et w e en t h e di ffer e n t cons t i t uen t m i nerals ther e by to ,

in g n e w min e rals capable of segr e ga t ing t hem s e lv e s i nto mass e s of


all siz e s .

G n e iss and mica schist a r e famil i ar exampl e s of t he work of


-

segr e ga t ion and mol e cular r ea rrang e ment of t he domin ant con
s t itu e n ts of alt e r e d sedimentary rocks Such altera t ion i s te rm e d .

anamorph i sm and always ta kes plac e in the anamorph i c zone .

Th e i nternal chang e s that affect eruptives ar e known to e v e ry


pe t rologist Bes i d e s t hese chang e s which are c h ie y mol e cular
.
, ,

rock masses and especially e rup ti v e rocks may b e so al te r e d by


-
, ,

th e a ct i on of c i rc u la t ing waters as to bear no r e s e mblanc e to t h e


o r iginal rock .

Thus in many cases andesi t es have b e en chang e d to propyli te


by t h e removal of c e r tain e ssential consti t u e nts a n d the s u bs t i
t u tion of o t he rs Rock r e plac e m e nt is doub tless pr e c ed e d by
.

alt e ration .

M e tasomatic r e placem e nt as de n e d by Van Hise and Emm ons


1
,
2
,

does not n e cessarily imply a mere subs t i t ut i on of mat ter mole ,

c ul e for mol e cul e as happens in the process of pseudomo rph i sm


, ,

which involves t he pr e servation of the o riginal form of t h e sub


1
V a n Hi se l 6th A n nu a l Rep o rt U S G eol S u rve y Part I
, p 6 89 . . .
, .
,
. .

2
S F Emm o ns U S G ao l S u rve y M mzog r ap h " I I
. .
, . .
p 5 65
.
, .
, . .
90 MININ G GEOLOGY .

stan c e replaced but an int e rchang e of substanc e th e dissolved


, ,

rock b e ing replac e d by gra i n s or cry s talli n e aggr e gat e s of on e or


nao r e nahne r a ls .

That subs ti tution did howev e r take place in some kinds of , ,

deposits is w e ll known I n t h e tin impregnat i ons in granit e .


-
,

in N ew S outh Wales pseudomorphs of t i n oxide in the form of


,
-
,

orthoclas e are not uncommon 5 and many o t her examples coul d b e


,

quoted having r e ference principally to th e r e placement of isolated


,

crystals in crystallin e and eruptiv e ro c ks


, .

Slow replac e men t of substan ce by a progressive movem e nt of


th e solu t ions in a de n ite dir e ction must b e assum e d to have
tak e n place in the formation of or e deposits compos e d of massiv e -

aggregates I n most cases the direction of movem e nt would be


.

determin e d by a rock fracture or line of fault .

I n the case of deposits formed by de e pcirculating solutions it ,

is manifest that circulation could no t be rapid as the fac e or breast ,

wher e metasoma t ic process e s w e r e active would form a blind end


or cu l de s a c Whatever circulation ex i st e d would be du e to con
- -
.

vection currents whi c h in deep seated cavit i es could only b e


,

feeble .

This now raises the question as to the transfer e nc e and supply


of dissolved matter to the continually advanc i ng fa c es of meta
somatic action .

The energy which caused or at any rat e ac c elerated this trans ,

f e rence was probably osmotic pressure which has been shown by


, ,

van t Ho ff to be a for c e of great intensity



.

I t has b e en p rov e d that when a po rt ion of dissolved substanc e


i s deposited from a solution at any point the osmo t ic balanc e is ,

dis t urbed 5 and immed i a t ely more dissolved mat t er travels to that
point i n accordance with the well e stablishe d laws of osmotic
di ff usion ther e by providing new matter to augm e nt the growing
,

mass of ore .

Arrhenius and G ill e tte hav e urged the claims of osmo t ic


pressur e t o be consid e red a facto r in ore format i on 1 -
.

O smotic pressure is the ch e mical principl e which compels


solut i ons to maintain an equal state of concen t rat i on throughout
th e ir whole mass and since it is always called into being when
,

deposition commences its operation as an agency in vein llin g ,


-

must have been assumed by writ e rs on th i s subj ect although ,

seldom s p e c ic ally m e ntioned .

M etasomatism is a proc e ss of lode formation by replacement -


,

an d does not concern itself with the source or origin of the


dissolved matte r contained in th e solutions .

1
G illette O sm osi s as a Fac tor in O re F ormatio n T r a ns A m I ns t M E
,

, . . . .
,

1 903.
92 MI N IN G G EOLOGY .

for many v e ins but admit s that for many others p e rhaps th e
,

maj ority of s s u re v e ins th e r e se e m s to b e som e thing lacki n g in


-

this explanation .

Vogt c la s s ie s th e metasoma ti c process e s caused by the circula


t ion of or e solu tions as follows
- 1

( a ) Al t eration forming greisen cassit e ri te rock et c , , .

( )
b S c a ol itis a t io n
p .

( c ) Propylitisation .

( ) Kaolinisation
d .

( ) Sericitisation
e .

(f ) Carbonatisat i on ( with dolomiti sation ) .

(g ) S il ic i c a t ion .

( )
h Z e o l itisa t i on .

()t I ntense con t act m e tamorphism .

He agr e es with E mmons Beck e r L indgren and othe rs , ,

m etasomatic replac e men t plays an important pa r t in the forma


tion of min e ral veins and ore bodi e s
- -
.

I nformation w ith r e gard to vein structur e charac t er a n d in -


, ,

u e n c e of wall rock should b e place d on record on all possibl e


-

occas i ons A p et rographical exam i na t ion of t h e vein ma tte r a n d


.
-

wall rock for som e d i stance on e ach s i de of t h e ore body will


- -

oft e n t hrow much l i ght on the genes i s of t he or e 5 but care mus t


b e taken i n forming g e neral i sat i ons on microscopic e vidence alon e .

1
Pro fe or V ogt
ss ,

Problem s in th e G eo l ogy of O re D epo s its ,
l oo
.
'

czt .
,

p 66 0
. .
CH A P T ER IV

T H E DY NA M I C S O F L O D E S A N D B E D S .

C ON T E N T S D niti n o f F ults F lt pa r ll l with B e l D ip F lt


: e o a au s a e i au s

S t p F l t T ro gh Faul ts R le fo r In l ined L od Z i mm er m nn

e au s u u s c es a s

G rap h i M et h od
c .

D e n itio n Of M in e ral beds and v ei n s may be ben t


F a u lts .

or frac t ur ed e l e vat e d or depressed by t h e slow s e cular move


, ,

ments which build u p continental areas 5 or til te d and d i slocated


by th e sharper mov e ments propaga te d by the intr us i on of an
igneo us magma 5 that is th e d i sturbing agent s may be orog e n i c
,

or hypogenic .

D i s locations wi t hout movem e nt of the rock on eith e r wall ar e


simple fractures 5 bu t in th e maj ority of cas e s t here has no t only
be e n fra cture but also displacemen t I n oth e r wo rds th e ren t s .
,

have b e come faults .

A faul t may be de n ed as a fractur e on on e s i de of which


movemen t has tak e n plac e whereby the roc ks on one s i de have
be e n displaced r e lativ e ly to thos e on t h e o ther sid e .

F aults ar e ca us ed by c rust stresses Th e y run i n all direct i ons .


,

but the maj or faults of a r e gion ofte n run in the same gen e ral
dir e c t ion .

A faul t may run parallel with the cours e or strik e of a bed , ,

or v e in 5 or cross t he c ou rse a t r i gh t angles or at any o t h e r angl e , .

F aults are no t often ve rtical bu t i ncl i n e to on e s i de or t h e


,

other A fault is said to hade wh e n it inclin e s from the ve rt i cal


.

plane The had e of a faul t is ther e for e t h e angl e which th e


.
, ,

fault makes w it h the v e rtica l plane .

The had el i ne of a fa u l t i s the oblique resulta n t of t wo


pri ncipal component forces namely gravitat i onal s t ress ac ti ng
,

v e r t ically or rad ially towards the centre of the e arth and la t eral ,

t hrust ma inly du e to subs i d e nce .

Faults ar e of two kinds namely ,

( ) a N or m a l f a u l ts .

b
( ) R e ve rs e d or o ver l ap fa u lts .

93
94 MININ G GEOLOGY .

I n normal faults th e downthrow is towards th e side to which


the fault hades .

FI G . 45 N
. ormal F a ul t .

I n F ig 4 5 the hade of the fault and downthro w of th e beds a re


.

tow ards t he west .

I n rev e rsed or overlap faults the downthrow is on the foot wall -

sid e of the fractur e .

FIG . 46 R
. ever ed o r O verl p Fa lt
s a u .

I n the above g u r e , t he hade is to the west ,


and the
thro w 0 11 the foot wal l si de
-
.

FI G . 47 R
. ever ed or O verlap Fa lt
s u .

FI G . 48 S h. arp F o ldi n g with o u t F ract ure .

Reversed faults are intimately connected with sharp


and synclinal fold i ng T h e stress e s i ntroduced by th
.

of beds are ofte n r elieved by faulting a n d shearing .


96 MININ G GEOLOGY .

The vertical line a h shows the vertical displa c e


m i n e rs d ownth r ow or up th r ow according as th e fault is ,

from th e e ast or west .

FI G . 52 .
S h o wi ng D i s placements by S trike F aul t .

The lin e c b shows the amount of horizontal displacement


d i sseverment whi c h is sometimes erroneously termed h e a ve .

FI G 53 p rt P l f Bed tr er ed b y S trike F lt L o we p rt
1
1p pe r

a an

. .
, o s av s au r a
.
,

C ro s s -s ec tl o n o f Bed lo g li e A H h o wi g r p titio o f di lo cat d bed


s a n n ,
s n e e n s e s.
T HE DYN A MI C S OF L O D ES A N D B E DS . 97

When a fault displ a ces s tra tied rocks th e lin e s of bedding ,

afford a measure of t h e vertical displac emen t 5 bu t in t h e absence


of bedding pla nes or some rock marked by a dis tinc t ive peculiari ty
-

of colour or compos i ti on th e r e is no c e rta in means of measuremen t


, .

A str i ke fault ca uses no la te ral d ispl a cement of the beds wh i ch


-
,

i t inte rs e cts 5 but wh e n the beds ar e inclin ed i t may produce a ,

rep et i ti on of thc d i slocated b e ds as shown in g 5 3 , . .

I n reg i ons which have been subj ect to long con t in ued denu da -

t ion on e s i d e of a faulted seam may be en t irely r e moved as


, ,

shown i n g 5 4 Th i s i s no t un common in th e cas e of young


. .

S e condary a n d T e r t iary coal me a sures h angin g on t h e a n ks of


-

mounta i n cha i ns .

FI G . 54 S . e tio o f N ormal Fault h o wi g


c n ,
s n on e s i de o f eam re mo ved
s

b y de datio nu n .

The s e am may be pa rt ly removed by d e nudat i on 0 11 on e or


both sides of th e faul t as indicat e d in gs 5 5 and 5 6
,
. .

55 Sec tion sh owi g S am p rtly remo ved


n e a on One S d i e al on g l in e
o f F lt
.

au

When a fault po ssesses t he sa m e dip and strik e as a seam or


min e ral v e in t ha t is when it conform s to t he bed din g pla n e s it
-
, ,
-
,

ca uses no apparent d i sturbance in the r e lat i on of the rock s on


98 MININ G GEOLOGY .

The only evidence of the existence of su ch a fault is the


smooth pol i shed and slicken sided s u rfaces on the line of move
, ,

FI G . 56 S
. e tio n
c sh o wi g S eam p rt ly re mo ed
n a v on Both S i des alo ng li e
n
o f F lt au .

ment I n t he case of a min e ral vein , the faul t ing may result in
.

t he product i on of a lay e r of friction breccia on the side on which


th e movement took plac e .

FI G . 57 .
S ec tio n o f Par llel T hr t P lane
a us .

Such a fault i s mer e ly a thrust plan e more often th e result oi -


,

shear i ng thrust than v e rtical or tangential stress .

D ip F l
a u ts A faul t which runs in the same general direction
.

as th e dip of a b e d or ve i n is te rmed a d ip fa ult ,


-
.

The d i st i nction bewe e n s t rik e faults and dip faults is not always - -

w ell marke d A fault may pursue any cours e b e tween th e s tr ike


.

and dip of a bed When i ts course is m i dway between th e d i p


.

and strik e of the b e d the fault may b e termed either a dip fault
,
-

or a str i ke faul t -
.

D ip faul t s produc e an app a r en t lat e ral displacement of th e bed


or v ei n wh i ch th ey cross
,
.

Wh e n faul t ing tak es place th e pr i ncipal movement is a vertical ,

on e Consequently wh e n the faulted v ei n is vertical there is no


.
,

la te ral displac e ment or heave as the diss e vered e nds merely slide ,

upon e ach other .

E v i denc e s of lateral thrust and shear i ng ar e often obs e rved


among Pal aeozoic sch i sts and gneiss but ar e sometimes seen in fault ,
1 00 MININ G GEOLOG Y .

displacement or downthrow ; and the cross c u t a o the amou nt of -

lateral d i splaceme n t or h e ave .

When th e drive da in g 5 8 reached the fault the vein was .


, ,

lost The lost vein was found at point c by cross cutting toward s
.

the east ; but obviously the pa rt of the vein struck at c was not
th e part corresponding to that driven on along da ( g .

I n this example th e fault dips t o the north 5 t her e for e the


, ,

d ownthrow i s on the north sid e of t he fault Henc e the crosscu t .


,

w i ll strik e a higher part of the v e in than that driven upon along ( ta .

The downthrow is the distanc e a b and at I) will be foun d th e ,

conti nuation of the portion of th e vein driven on at a .

S ometimes two or mor e faults run parallel with each other or ,

cross each other at an angl e I n other cases it happens that one


.
,

group of faults is int e rs e c t ed by another group of a later dat e .

When faulted veins or s e ams are again faulted many complicat e d ,

problems becom e involv e d i n the recov e ry of the lost portions .

S te p F a u lts A s e am or bed is sometimes cross e d by a


.

number of faul ts runn i ng more or less parallel to e ach oth e r and


, ,

FI G . 59 . Cro ss
-
s c e tion sh owi g G ro u p o f S tep Fault
n s .

d i pping in the same direction 5 or by some d i pping one way and


some another .

S uch faults are often small and their e ffects best seen wh e n ,

they dislocat e a seam of c oal .

FI G 6 0 C ro s s e tio n o f T ro gh Fault in D dley Port Mine S ta ords h ire


'
. . s c
-
u u
, .

( ) S am o f c oal
a e ( b) B l t . a sa .
T HE DYN A MI C S or L O D ES AND B E DS . 101

T ro u g Wh e n two pa rall e l faul t s d ip towa rds ea ch


h F a u l ts .

o t her p e rmit t ing a po rt ion of s t rata to b e t hrown down betw ee n
,

them they form what is spok e n of as a trou g h fa ul t A w e ll


,
-
.

known example is the t rough faul t of D udl e y Po rt Mi ne in -


,

S ta o rds h ire which has t hrown down the gr eat 10 ya rd seam a


'
-
,

distance of 4 5 0 feet as shown below , .

R EC O VER Y . 0 F L o sr L O D ES .

R u le s fo r I F our c a ses may occur when


n c lin e d L o de s .

driving on a vein dislocated by a faul t The v e in may dip to th e .

right or l e ft hand and the faul t towards you or away from you
, .

1 .When the vein dips to th e l e ft and is cut o ff by a fault ,

dipping to wa rds you th e lost vein will be found by dr iv ,

ing to the l e ft .

11 Wh e n th e vein dips to t he left and is cut o ff by a fault


.
,

dipping away from you t h e lost vein w i ll be foun d by driv ,

ing to the right .

111 When the vein dips to th e right and is cu t o ff by a faul t


.

dipping towards you th e lost v e in w ill b e found by driv ,

ing to the right .

IV When th e vein dips to t h e right and is cut o ff by a faul t


.
,

dipping away from you th e lo s t v e in will be found by driv ,

i ng to t he l e f t .

Th e faul t may cross th e fac e of th e d riv e s quare ly or it may ,

cross obliqu e ly Th e angl e a t which th e fault inte rs e cts th e v ei n


.

do e s not affe c t t h e application of th e rul e s .

V 1Vhen a horizon tal s e am i s cut o ff by a fault d i pping toward s


.

you its con t inua t ion w i ll be found a t a h i gh e r l e vel 5 bu t


,

wh e n t h e fault dips away from you th e los t sea m w ill ,

be found und e rfoo t .

Thes e rules are alway s t ru e e xcep t in t he cas e of revers e d ,

faults and strike faults which run parall e l with th e s t rik e of th e


-

v ei n or s e am .

Z imm e rm a n s G ra p h ic M e th od

Zimm e rman s graphic .

me t hod for n din g t he lost or faul t ed po rt ion of a lod e is as


follows
1 . L y down
a upon paper t he l i n e of st r ike of the lod e and faul t ,

producing t he l i n e s ti ll t hey in te rs e c t .

2 . D ete rmine by cons t ruction t h e poin t of inte rsection a t any


imaginary lower l e vel .

3 . D raw a line j oining t h e po in ts of inters e ct i on of th e lode and


fault a t the two levels .
10 2 MININ G GEOLOGY .

4 . P roduce the lin e of i nt e rsection through th e fault at upper


l e vel .

5 D ra w a line pe rpendicular to the fault at the point wh e re


.

the lin e of i nt e rsection e merges from th e faul t .

R u le O n what e ver side of the lin e of int e rse c tion produced


.

the perpendicular falls 0 11 that side will the lost l ode b e found
, .

Z i mmerman s law is always tru e ex c ept in the c as e of r e versed


faults and strike faults -


.

Unl e ss beds c a n b e recognised on each side of the fault the ,

e xtent of the throw cannot be dete r mined .

A p p lica tion of R u le E xa mp le 1 S uppose t h at in driving


. .

north on a lod e a fault is met wi th which displaces the lode The .

fault dips south at an angl e of and the lod e dips w e st at


an angl e of I n which dire c tion should th e lost portions
of the lode be found ?

FI G . 61 .
S ketc h Pl n to i llu tr te Example 1
a s a .

Procure a she e t of pap e r and plot t he approximat e position of


t h e lode and fault showing th e direction of dip of e ach with an arrow
,
.

L et the lode a n d fault be sho wn by a rm black l i ne as shown , ,

in g 6 1. .

Plot th e position the lod e and fault would occupy at a low e r


depth say at 10 0 f e e t representing them by a t hin l i n e Produc e
, , ,
.

t he lin e s till they meet T h e approxima te positions a t a lo we r .

l e vel can be plotted by inspection for i t is ev i dent that if the lod e ,

dipping at 6 0 deg travels out say i ih ch in 1 0 0 feet th e lode


.
, ,

dipping at the a tte r angle of 4 5 deg will d i p much faster and .


,

hence travel r e lativ e ly further out .

The exact d e parture or dis tance the lode and fault will trav e l
out i n 100 feet can be found by mult i plying the cotangent of the
angl e of dip by 10 0 .

D raw a l i ne through t he points of inte rsection and erect a per ;


,
1 04 MININ G GEOLOGY .

north instead of south at the sam e angle the diagram would be


, ,

as shown below .

E xa mp le 5 S uppose in d r iving no rth west on a lode dipping


.
-

FI G 6 4 T o i llustrate Example
. . 4 . FIG 6 5 T o ll us
. i tr te Ex
a a pe
m l 5 .

south west at an angle of


-
a fault were met with
E and W and dipping no rth at an angle of
. .
,
on which
would the lost lode be found ?

FI G . 66 . T o ll us
-
i trate Ex mple 6
a .

Suppos e in driving east on a lode dipping sou t h


6 .

at an angle of a fault were met with running N E . .

and dipp i ng S E at an angle of . wh e r e should the los t


portion of the lode be found ?
C H A FT E R V .

O R E D E P O S I T S G E N E T I C A L LY C O N S I D E R E D .

C ON T EN T S Genetic Cl ic ti
'

as s Mag m ti c S egregatio
a on C h ro mite i
a n n

Peri dotite N i kel I o N tive Copper P lati num M t l


c l n a Ore e a s s

fo rm ed b y Er pti ve A fter actio n


u S o l fat ri A tion o f A
- s di g a c c sc e n n

A lkal i e Water Fumaro l i Conta t Metamorph i c Depos it Region l


n s c c s a

M eta m orp h i D e po its M eteo ri c W ter O rg ni


c s a s a c .

O R E D EP O S I T S are of dive rse form and composition


-
Th e y ar e .

foun d as tru e veins , as d e tached mass e s , and as members of a


sedim e nta ry forma t ion I t is now known that t h e ir mod e of
.

occurr e nc e and to som e e xtent th e ir compos i t ion and form w e r e


, , , ,

d etermined by th e g e ological conditions prevail i ng at the ti me of


the i r form at i on .

I n t h e pas t decade a vast ma s s of fac ts has b e en add e d to th e


,

li te ratur e of the subj e ct par t icularly i n Am e rica wh e r e th e


, ,

magnitud e of th e op e rations conn e c te d wi th m i ning h as a ff orde d


gr ea t facil i ti e s for obs e rva t ion and res e arch .

Th e gen e s is of or e d e pos its pr e s e nts many dif c u l t probl e ms ,

and natur ally th e li teratur e of the subj e ct i s rich in t h e or e t i cal


d e duc t ions .

Th e i n t roduction of pet rographica l m ethods of investigation ,

and th e d e mons t rat i on of th e princ i pl e s of metasomatic r e plac e


men t and s e condary e nr ichm e n t hav e mark e d a n e w po i n t of ,

d e pa rt ure and le d to a t ru e r conc e ption of th e forma t ion of or e


,

d e pos its than form e rly exi s t ed .

I n this investigation w e m u st r e m e mb e r tha t e xis ti ng condi ti ons


ar e bu t a r e e c tion of th e pas t Th e ag e nci e s tha t bu i l t up t h e
.

crust of th e ea r th in i t s pr e s e nt form ar e still in op e ra t ion a n d ,

s ti ll govern e d by the sam e na t ural laws .

We ar e l i ving on th e e dge of a geolog i c e poch and i f w e woul d ,

righ t ly und e rs tand t h e pas t we mus t s t u dy t h e pr e s e n t Th e


,
.

occurr e nc e of or e d e p os its i s m e rely a g e ologic happ e ning an


inciden t in th e te c tonic arrangement of t he materials form i ng the
out e r sh e ll of t he globe .


Rec e n t petrogr aphi c al inv e stiga t ion has shown that ore d e posi ts
10 5
1 06 MININ G GEOLOG Y .

are always mo re or less intimately connected with ign eous rocks .

This c onstant association naturally l e ads to th e broad g e n e ra lisa


tion T h a t ore dep osits G 7 6 g enetica lly connected with th e ei up tton
-

of i neous m a mas
g g .

G e ne tic C las s i ca tio n .

The genetic c la s s ic a t ion which seems to most near ly sa tisfy our


present knowledge relati n g to mineral deposits is as follows
1 M agmati c segregation
. .

II E ruptive afte r actio n s


.
-

( ) S
a o f
l a tar ic .

u ma r olic
( )
b F .

( )
0 C on ta c t m e ta mmp htc
'
.

eg ion a l m e ta morp h ic
( )
d R .

III M eteori c waters


.

( )
a Ch e mi ca l .

( )
6 M ech a n ica l .

IV . O rga n ic .

I . M A G M AT I C
S E G RE G A T I ON .

I t has b e en shown by Professor and others S a n db e rg e r ,

igneous rocks c ontain all the co n stituents of min e ral veins .

Professor Vogt of Christiania maintains that a deep s e ated


, ,
-

ina c c e ssible re pository of the heavy metal s can no longer b e


sustained 1
M odern geologists h e points out hav e abandon e d
.
, ,

t h e old conception of the earth s inter i or condition which su pposed


f

,

that the int e rior was an enormously compress e d liquid molten


mass of high s p e c i c gravity charg e d with heavy m e ta ls .

The compos i tion of the molten magmas that hav e issu e d at th e


s u rface in suc c essive geologi c al ages do ,

th e sis which assumes th e e xis t ence of a


h e avy metals in the barysphere than in the upp e r crust or litho
sphere .

R e ferring to the distribution of the e l e ments in the e arth s

crust V ogt states that of th e entir e crust i ncluding


, ,

and atmosphere oxygen cons t i t utes by weight about,


2
silicon above one quarter -
.

1
Pro fe or ss in th e O rigi n o f Ore Depo s its
,

G en es is o Or e D ep os tt3 f
,
1 90 1 , p 6 37
. .

2
L oc. c it , p . 6 39.
1 08 MI N I N G GEOLOGY .

resulting from direct di ff erentiation in th e cooling magma are , as

follows
( )a Ch r omite in peridotit e and se rpentine .

Copper and nickel iron in serp e ntine -


.

0 ) Platinum m e tals in highly basic eruptives


( .

( )
d M agnetite and titanite in basi c and semi basic eruptives -
.

C h ro m ite in P the South I sland of Ne w


e rido tit e .
-
I n

Zealand there are two mo u ntain masses of p e ridotite in which


, ,

th e magmatic segrega t ion of c h romit e is exhibited on a large


s c ale .

A few m iles from the city of N elson D u n M ountain rises to a ,

h e ight of over 40 0 0 feet abov e sea l e vel I t cove rs an area of -


.

about 4 square mil e s and is compose d of massive olivine in wh i ch


, ,

chromit e of iron is uniformly disseminated in the form of n e


1
grains but occasionally occurs in large masses
, .

Th e adj ac e nt ro c ks ar e slaty shales and limestones of probably


J u ra ss ic ag e th e limestone occurring at the base of sedimenta ry
,

formation B e tween the lim e stone and the olivine to which


.
,

Ho c hstetter gav e th e distinctive nam e dunite there is a belt of


2
,

s e rpentin e half a mile wide .

The serpentin e contains l e nticular shaped masses of chromit e -


,

native copp e r and copper ores principally chalcopyrite with th e


, , ,

usual prod u cts of oxidation I t also contains thin irr e gular v e ins .

of diallage bronzite enstatite scapolit e wollastonite and chryso


, , , , ,

tile .

T h e larg e r masses of chromit e in the olivine and serp e ntin e


o c cur along t he ma rgin or boundary of t hese rocks .

Th e s e cond g rea t mass of peridotite forms R e d M ountain ,

situated 2 0 miles north of M ilford S ound in O tago 3


I t is over ,
.

6 0 0 0 feet high and covers an area of about 1 0 square miles


, .

The mountain is composed of olivine and chromite Th e latter .

occurs in much greater proportion t han at D u n M ountain .

Th e p e ridotit e is anked on two sid e s by bel t s of s e rp e n t in e ,

which separate it from the adj a c ent slat e s and sandstones of


suppos e d Pal aeozoic age .

The olivin e n e ar th e con tact with the sedimentary rocks 1s


, ,

often so highly charged with chromit e as to form massiv e bodies


of ore N o d e posits of c hromite are known in the se rpentine but
.
,

1
S H . x, . Co
hr m D
s s C o e epo it o
f N l s n, N ew Z ea la nd G eol R ep or ts e o
.

a nd E xp lor a tions , 1 88 1 8
, p . .

2
Dr F Von H O Ch S te tte r 2 5 1 3 0717 173 de f deu ts che n ge ol G esells , xv p 34 1 ,
'
0

. . i . .

1 864 .

3
J . P k
ar , N e w Z ea la nd G eolo ica l R e or ts a nd E x lor a tions ,
g p p 1886 -
87,
ORE D E P O S IT S G E N ET I C ALLY C O NS I D E R E D . 1 09

they may poss i bly exist as th e count ry is still p ra cti ca lly , un

N ic k e l I ro n
The sands in the s t reams which dr ain th e R e d.

M ountain se rpen t in e area yield small quant i t i es of th e rare nick e l


i ron alloy Awaruite d iscover e d by W Sk e y i n
,
I t has , .

be e n found in situ i n t he s erp e nt i ne , ,


.

A ni ck e l i ron alloy th e sa m e as or r e lated to Awarui t e h as b ee n


-
, ,

found i n gold bea ri ng sands a t t h e Riv e r B ie lla P i ed mon t-


, ,

ass oc i a t ed with chrom it e se para ted from per i do t ite ; i n s e rp e n


3

ti n e i n J os e ph in e County O r e gon ; in sands to ne ass oc i a te d wi t h


4
, ,

chromi te i n Fras e r R i v e r British Col u mb i a ; and i n Smi t h


,
5
,

R i ver D e l N o r te County Cal i fornia


, ,
.

N a tiv e C o p p e r The associa ti on of co pper and chromite in .

the serpen t ines a t D u n M oun ta in has alread y b e en m e n ti on e d .

N a t iv e copper is foun d in s e rpent ine in Cornwall Ne w Sou th ,

tales a n d ma ny oth e r pa rt s of t he world


, .

Larg e mass e s of na ti v e copper assoc i ated wi t h silver are found , ,

in amygdalo i dal d i aba s e a t L ak e S u perior .

I n 18 7 9 Prof S H Cox di s cover e d in th e M anukau d is trict a


, . . .
, ,

number of dyk e s of and e s it e which near the i r bo rders wer e , , ,

foun d to con tain small gra i ns of na t ive copper n e ly d i ss e m i na te d ,

throughou t the i gneous ma t rix 6


The dyk e s ar e i n t ruded in .

volcan i c br e cc i as of probably la ter Mi oc e n e ag e .

P l a tinu m M e tal s Pla t inum has only b ee n found i n a f e w .

cas e s i n t h e ma t rix in mtu a n d i n most case s i n basic or ul t ra


bas i c rocks I n the Ural M oun ta i ns i t occurs as gra i ns in


.
,

p e r i do tite and s e rpentin e .

The b e d rock of t h e Vy za j and Ka iv a rivers on t h e western


-
,

a n ks of t h e Ural s cons i sts of olivin e gabbro con ta i n i n g d i s ,


-
,

s e m i na t ed g rains of pla t inum but not apparently in pa yabl e ,

quant itie s .

A n ol i v i ne rock was d iscovered in 1 8 93 at G or ob la g e da ts k , ,

on t he wes te rn s i de of th e Urals conta i n i ng ch romite a n d ,

p la ti num t he la tter at th e rate of 1 4 d wt 9 g r to t he to n of rock


,
. . .

Carm i chael in 1 90 2 repo rt e d the occur renc e of plat i num i n a


7
, ,

n egra i ned dark basal ti c rock .

1
W . S key
T r a n s N Z I ns t , v ol x x
, , p
40 1 , 1 885 . . . . . iii . . .

9
G H U lr c h ,
. O u t h e D sc v ry , M od
. i i o e
f cc urre nc , a n d D s r u i n eo O e i t ib t o
o f th e N ic keI - r n ll y waru on th e io A o A
s ite
as f th e S u h I sla n d f We t Co t o o t o
e

N e w Z a la nd , Qu a r t J ou r G eo S oc L nd n . . . . o o .

3
Comp te s R on d us , c x p 171 ii . . .

4
A m J ou rn S e . xi x p 3 19, 1 90 5 . . . . .

5
L oc cit , p 31 9. . . .

6
S H . . Co
x, G l gy f a Ro dn y , N Z G eol Rep orts a nd E xp lor aeo o o C pe e . . .

timw, 1 8 79 80 , p 2 7 -
. .

7
E n g a nd M in J o an , N e w Y r , Fe b 1 2 , 1 90 2
. . ok . .
1 10 MI N I N G GEOLOG Y .

I .Pond in 18 86 discovered native platinum in serpen tine at


A .
, ,

Wade n ear Auckland and in a great vein traversing propylitised


, ,

and e site at the Tham e s g old e ld .

S i nce the discov e ry of platinum in the nickel c opper sulphid e -

ore at Sudbury in Canada careful analysis has d i s c los e d th e , ,

presence of the metal in minut e quantity in many sulphide ores


t hroughout the world But in this and all cases where platin u .
, ,

occurs in sulphid e b e ds or in veins its oc c urren c e is probably not ,

th e result of d i rect magmati c segregation .

II .
-
O R E s F O R M ED B Y E R U P T I VE AF T ER A C T I O N S
-
.

I t is manife st tha t the whole series of e r uptive after actions w ill -

commence at th e movement of intrusion of the magma and c on ,

tin u e until the rocks hav e become compl e tely c ooled .

I gneous magmas are now admitte d by petrologists to contain


mor e or less water toge ther with many constituents of a hydrous
or gaseous charact e r .

Hence th e fusion of magmas is not believed to be pyrogenet i c ,

that is th e result of dry hea t alone but h yda to pyrogenet i c t hat


, ,
-
,

i s fusion by heat in the presence of water According to


, , .

Arrhenius water renders the magma more l i quid


1
, .

I t has b e en shown by e xperiment that magmas which require a


te mpera t ure of 3000 F t o prod uce dry fusion can be fused "

.
,

i n th e presence of water at 5 00 F F urther it has b ee n

shown that the pr e s e nce of water aids in giving a magma u idity .

Barus was abl e to fuse glass at 2 00 C in the presen c e of water



2
. .

According t o Arrh e n i us water i n a mag m a a c t s the pa rt of an , , ,

ac i d l i bera t ing free s i licic acid a n d free bases


,
.

The a c tivity of wat e r at high t emperature is very gr e at .

Barns has shown that wa t er heated above 18 5 deg C a t tacks


3
, . .
,

th e silicates compos i ng soft glass with remarkable rapid i ty and


L e mberg has proved experim e n t ally that water at a temperature , , ,

of 2 10 C slowly dissolves anhydrous powdered silicates
.
, .

I t is probable that at gr e at depths the pressure will be , ,

s u f c ie n t to hold the water in the form of a liquid in a sup e r ,

h e at e d condition 4
A t high temp e ratures both wa te r and steam .
,

possess a great capaci ty for d i ssol ving min e ral substanc e s .

1
S v an rrh n u s , Z ur te A
hy s e i
de s V u l a n sm u s , G eol F or e n F k

P ik k i . . or .

S tockh ol m , 1 90 0 .

2
C B aru s , A m J ou
. S ci , i p 2 70 , 1 8 98 r . . v . . .

3
C a rn s , . B a Hot W te
r a n d S f G lass in h r T h rm dy n am c Re la n s
ot t ei e o i tio .

A m J u . o r
S ci I V , v ol i , 1 90 0 , p 1 6 1
. . . . x . . .

4
O R Van . s , S m . Hi e
r nc l s c n r ll n th e D s n f r s , o e P i ip e o to i g epo itio o O e
T r a n s A merica n I ns tztu te of M i ning E ng in eer s , v ol
.
p 2

7 . xxx . . .
1 12 MININ G GEOLOGY .

Where the hot springs ov e r ow on the surface they form ,

thick mushroom shaped mounds of silica The silica is some


-
.

times soft and porous and often de n se hard and chalc e donic
, , , .

I n all c ases the hot springs and geys e rs are grouped around
,

th e volcanic vents and along s s u r e s in lavas n e ar th e point of


,

e miss i on .

I n th e Hauraki gold mining area which a dj oins th e north e rn



,

e nd of this volcanic region t he country rocks consist of a vas t ,


-

p i l e of and e sitic lavas tu s and br e ccias of M ioc e ne ag e resting


'

, , ,

on slaty shales and greywack e of probably Tr i ass i c age .

Th e gold bearing v e ins traverse both the and e s i t e s and t u s



-

but are only pro ductive in th e former They are s s u re v ei ns .


-

but strictly speaking th e y do not conform to the usually acc e pt e d


, ,

d e fi nit i on of a t rue ss u r e v e i n since th e y are g e ne rally c on n e d


-
,

t o th e igneous rock formation -


.

Ne ar the bord e rs of th e and esites the veins are small and u n ,

important and g e nerally die out when they reach the underly i ng
,

basement rock On t h e other hand th e larger and more pro


.
,

du c t iv e veins are group e d around the old vents and have been ,

found to descend as deep as m i ning operat i ons have followed them .

Ther e seems to be no reason why t h e y should not des c end to


great depths .

Th e country rock on the walls of t he veins is propylitised to a


-
, ,

moderat e ly hard gray rock When two or more v ei ns run parall e l


.

with each other as th e y do in all th e Hauraki mini n g centr e s


, ,

the country rock between the v ei ns is often entir e ly altered or


-
,

propylitise d .

I n the Tham e s district the distance b e tween the numerous ,

parallel veins which traverse the g old e ld seldom exc e eds 2 00


yards and in almost every instan c e th e veins are s e parat ed from
,

each other by a narrow belt of hard unaltered andesite These .

hard bands or ba rs as the mine rs term them possess the sam e


, ,

general strike and dip as the veins and in cross sect i on pres e nt ,
-

t h e appearanc e of l e nticular and hourglass shap e d masses They -


.

vary from a f e w feet to 30 yards in width .

The country rock has b e en found to be propylitised down to a


-

d e pth of nearly 10 0 0 feet below sea l e v e l wh i ch is th e greatest -


,

depth reach e d by mining op e rations up to th e pr e s e nt time .

The propylitisation of t he andesites is not wid e spread but ,

c on n e d t o small areas grouped around th e old volcanic vents .

Away from the eruptiv e c entres th e andesites have su ff e red ,

surfac e decomposition but are not propyl i tised , .

The propylit i sa t ion was apparently e ff ected by hot mineral


waters circulating in fissures wh i ch are now ll e d wi t h ve i n
matter F rom these ssu re s the mi n eralised w aters a c ted on the
.
O RE D EP O S I T S G E N ET I C ALLY C O N S I D E R E D . 1 13

rock on e ach wall ; and where the ss u r e s wer e near eac h o t her ,

th e m etasoma ti c ag e nc i es opera ti ng from one ss u r e m et t hos e , ,

coming from th e o t h e r Wh e re the proc e ss e s of al te ra ti on did .

not m eet narro w irregular sh e e tl ik e mass e s of unal ter e d rock


, , ,

th e bars of the m i n e rs w e r e left b e twe e n the v e in s su r es -


.

A t Waih i a n d surroun di ng d i s t ri cts t he veins are pr i ncipally


, ,

compos ed of chalc e don i c quart z possess ing all the chara c t e ri s ti cs ,

of solfat ari c or i g i n S om e of th e larg e r lod e s can be t raced on .

t h e surfac e for a d i s t ance of f e et but th e l e ngth of the ,

majority i s und e r 5 0 0 0 fe e t .

Be s i des the v e in s having l i n ea r e xtens i on th e r e are many hug e ,

mush r oomshap e d mass e s of chalced onic quar t z clos e ly r e s e mbl i ng ,

in form t h e s i l i c eous deposits now forming in th e volca n i c r e g i ons


around Rotorua and L ak e Taupo .

A t Kuao t unu and G reat Ba rr ie r I sland t her e ar e many of these


mushroom shaped deposi t s in some cas e s covering hundreds i n
-
, ,

o th e rs t housands of acr e s A t Kuaotunu t hey ar e more or l e s s


, .

circular in s hape and s e ldom e xc e ed 2 0 f e e t i n thickness


,
.

A t G reat Barri e r I slan d the larg e st d e pos i t is of an unusual ,

charac ter 1
It i s nearly 2 m i les long h alf a mile wid e a n d
.
, ,

from 5 0 to 7 00 fe e t thick .

The pip e i s c omple t ely lle d wi t h mineral matte r I t has b e en .

i ntersected i n fo u r m i nes in a distan c e of a mil e and opened up , ,

by lev e ls for many hundreds of ya rds It varies from 1 2 to 4 0 .

f ee t i n w i d th and i s filled wi t h v e ry de n s e banded chalced on i c


,

qua rtz in wh i ch i ron and s i lver sulphides are s pa r i ngly d i s


,

tribute d .

The evidence furnished by t he mine workings implies t hat t he


overlying mushroom or umbr e lla of quartz was depos i ted on th e
surfac e from th e r mal wat e rs i s s u in g from a ss u r e i n t h e an de s it e .

Th e molybd e nit e depos its at Jeff s Camp in t h e Hodgki nson ,



,

g o ld e ld in Qu ee nsland
,
ar e d e scr i b ed by W E Cameron 2 as , . .

roughly c i rcular or oval shape d outc rops of quartz or blows ,


-
, ,

carrying wolfram and na t iv e bis muth .

The blows wh e n follow e d down d e velop into i rr e gul ar p i p e


, ,

shap e d masses surroun ded on a ll sides by gran i te wh i ch is t h e


, ,

co u ntry rock Wh e n t he quartz i s extracted there remain only


-
.
,

e mpty pipe s or vents .

These p i p e l i k e or e bodies poss ess a pecul i ar in te rest from a


- -

g e ne t ic s tand po i n t Th e y appear to closely r e s e mbl e t he s i l i c e ous


.

p i pes formed i n rhyolite by th e hot springs in t he Rotorua


1
J . P rka ,

T he G eol ogy an d Veins o f H au raki G o ld e lds ,

T r a ns .

N . Z . I n s titu te M i n ing E n g ine er s , ol i p 1 37, 1 8 97 v . . . .

2
W al te r E C am r n .

eo
l fram a n d M ly d n e M n
,
Wo o b e it i i g i Q ee
n n u ns
l and,

Q ue e ns la n d G eo ] S u r v ey R ep or t, N o 1 88 , p 7 , B ris an
f
. . . b e 1 90 4 , .

8 .
114 MININ G GEOLOGY .

volcanic region and the mushroom shap e d quartz blows at ,


- -

Kuaotunu .

S everal of the massive d e posits of chalc e donic qua rtz a t Waihi


are stated by F rank Rutl e y to be r e placements of the an desi t e
1
c ountry ro c k -
.

A similar r e placement of andesite by silica is d e scr i b e d by


Spurr as oc c urring at M onte Cri s to district i n Wash i ngton 2
, .

He mentions that t h e s ilic ica t ion has proce e ded un t i l most of t h e


rock is made up of quartz wh i ch he says varies from coarsely to , , ,

very n e ly crystalline in structure and conta i ns sulphides c h ie y , ,

blende pyrit e s ; and chalcopyrite in lenses of ore concentrat e d


,

along j oint p1anes bedd i ng planes and c on tacts


-
, ,
.

Spurr continues Thus we hav e a complete and gradual transi ,

tion from andesite to a sulphi d e ore with a quartz gangue by the , ,

progressiv e r e pla c ement o f t h e original materials by s i lica a n d



metall i c sulph i des .

I n 18 94 and 1 896 the author mad e an exhausti v e examination ,

of the Hauraki and e sit e s for gold and s i lver .

The samples subj e c t e d to examination were s e lect e d in s itu


, , .

Th e analyses wer e conducted by th e cyanide test on s amples ,

ranging from two to v e pounds in weight The pulv e rised .

material wa s l e ached w ith a 0 3 per cent aqueous solution of pure .

potassium cyan i d e for seventy two hours -


.

The cyan i d e solut i ons and washings w e r e e vapo rat e d u xe d ,

with pure lith a rge and the result i ng but t on of l e ad cupelled , .

S i multaneous tes t s w ere made on pure subs tan ces so as to check ,

the results .

All the and e sit e s were found to contain gold at the rat e of 1 5 g r .

per ton and silv e r varying from 3 g r to 30 g r p e r ton of rock


,
. . .

Th e aug i t e andesit e at 30 0 0 feet from th e mou t h of th e


-
,

M oa n a ta ia r i tunnel conta i ned 1 % g r of gold and 3 g r of silver to , . .

th e ton and the hyp e rsthene aug i te and e s ite from th e wat e rfall - -
, ,

in Waio tahi Creek near the F ame and F ortun e mine contain e d , ,

1 4 g r of gold and 30 g r of silver


.
3
, . .

A petrolog i cal examinat i on of the rocks showed that the felspars


were often kaolinised and the pyroxenes generally much alter ed 4
, .

The samples were s e l e cted from the least altered rocks obtain ed ,

and in no c ase did th e y contain v i sible pyrites .

1
J P a1k an d F R u l y ,
. N s o n Rh y l
. s te
f th e aura G olde lds , ote o ite o H ki
Qu a r t J ou r na l G eol S oc , L n d n ,
.
,
1 8 99 . . o o lv . .

2
. . p . .

J E S u rr, U S G eol S u r v ey T we n ty S ec on d A n n u a l R ep or t, 1 90 01 .

P t
ar I I O re D . s s,

p 833 epo it . .

3
J P k ar ,

T he G l y a n d V n s f au ra eo og
G ol d e lds ,

T ran N ew ei o H ki s
.

Z ea la nd I ns t M E , 1 897, p 5 2
. . .

1
J. ar

P k
S m ,
nd s o e A e ite
s fr m th e T h a m s G ol d e l ds , T r a n s N ew

o e .

Z ea la n d I n s ti tu te , v ol i , p 4 35 xxx v . . . .
11 6 MIN IN G GEOLOGY .

charg e d to gal e na from th e V esuvian mine F r eihung in Bavaria , ,


.

I n thes e th e b r e a n d annular r i ngs coul d be eas i ly recogn i s ed ,

b ei ng extr e m e ly pla i n on polish ed surfaces 1


.

M r R B A u dr em on t (B u ll d e la S oc G ol B e lg iqu e) stat e s that



. . . .

in a pitchblende min e at Joachimsthal in Bohemia a pi e ce of , ,

carbon i s e d wood from a dec i duous plant was found in a ssu re , ,

ll e d with volcan i c tu ff at a d e pth of 915 f ee t .

I n th e tu fts assoc i at e d with the Hauraki gold b e aring andes i tes -


,

mass e s of wood partly or wholly s ilic ie d and spangled with nests ,

and v e ins of iron pyr i tes are of common occurrence ,


.

T h e M artha lo d e and i ts num e rous ramify i ng branches a n d , ,

th e S i lverton Union and Amaranth lod e s at Waih i are all con


, , , ,

t a in e d in an area of abo u t a square mile Th e huge lod e s w i d e .


,

zones of s il ic i e d and e sit e and ex te nsiv e propylit i sation of the


and e s i te prov e that Waih i was an area of int e nse hydrothermal
,

acti vity som e time prior to the eruption of the later rhyolit e
o ws which now form the plains and wrap around the M artha
, ,

and Silverton veins .

The propylitisation has already been shown by the Waihi mine


workings to e xtend to a d e pth of nearly 8 0 0 feet below pr e sen t
water lev e l that is some 4 0 0 feet below sea l e vel O bviously th e
-
, ,
-
.
,

alteration of the and e site was due to the action of as c ending and
lat e rally moving thermal wa t e rs .

A t Thames and Coromandel som e of the m ost productive v ei ns


do not reach th e surface of the e nclos i ng rock 5 and th e m i n e

workings at Waih i have d i sclosed a similar f e ature in conn e c ti on


with a few valuabl e v e ins in th e Waih i Company s property 2
.

I n 1 8 98 Captain F W Hutton ,
as the r e sult of a . .
,

petrographical examination of th e Tham e s mining district con ,

clud e d that the veins w e re of hydroth e rmal orig i n 3


.

T A R i ckard a well known American geologist who exam i n e d


. .
,
-
,

the same g old e ld in 1 891 wh en discuss i ng Professor P os e p ny s ,



pap e r on The G enesis of O r e D eposits describ e s t he character ,

is tic features of t he district with the view of adducing a dditional ,

ev i d e nce of the associat i on of thermal springs and la te r e ruptiv e


rocks 4
He states t hat his examination of the ore occurr e nc e s and
.
-

vein structure though incomplete led him to con clude that the
-
, ,

1
Pro fe or Fra z P p y ss n os e n ,
T h e G en esis of Ore D ep os its , p 1 2 9, 1 90 1 . .

2
P 0 M o rga
. N ote . n,

s on th e G l y , Quar eo og R fs , a n d M n ral s f tz ee i e o
th e Waih i G ld ld T

o e ,
r a ns. A u str I n s titu te of M in ing En g in e ers , v ol
. .

viii .
p . 1 68 , 1 90 2 .

3
F . W
O u th e R c s f th e au ra
. H tton
u G ol de l d , T 7 a n3
,
ok o H ki '
.

A u s t A ssoc A d v S o ,
. vi p 2 4 5 , 1 888 ; a n d S u rc f G ld a th e
.

. vol . ii . . o eo o t

e
T h am s , N Z J ou r n a l of S c ience , 1 p 146 . . vol . . . .

4
T A . . ik
R c a rd, T he G enes is of Or e Dep o s its D s c u ss n , N e w Y r , i io ok
1 90 1 , p 2 22 . .
oar. D EP O S IT S G E N ET I C ALLY C O N S ID E RE D . 1 17

d e posi t ion of the gold and its associated minerals h a d followed


ce r tain lines of altered coun try rock which h ad be e n e xpos e d t o -
,

th e e ffe c ts of dying but ling e ring s olfataric ag e nci e s .

Th e O ha e awa i Hot Spri ngs quicks i lv e r de pos its nort h of t h e ,

Hauraki peni nsula ar e of gr e a t importa n c e on accoun t of t h e


, ,

evid e nce which t h ey furni sh in conn e ction wi th th e g e n es is of


solfa ta ric or e d e posi ts -
.

The bas e m e nt rocks co nsist o f low e r M esozo ic shal e s and


s ands t ones ov e rlain by gr ee nsands of lo w e r T e rti ary or uppe r
Cr e tac e ous age which are cov e red wi t h o ws of basal t and bed s
,

of scoriae It i s agr e ed by all geo log i s ts t ha t th e basal t cons t i t ut es


.

t h e young e st roc k forma ti on in t h e dis t ri c t


-
.

Th e surro u n din g coun t ry is studd e d wi t h old c rate rs ; and t h e r e


is e v e rywh e re e vidence of former i ntens e volcanic ac t ivi ty .

Th e ho t springs aroun d which th e quicksilve r d e pos i ts ar e


,

cl u s tere d are situa t ed abou t two mil e s sou t h ea s t of La k e


,
-

O map e r e wh i ch i ts e lf occupi e s t h e site of an old cra te r


, .

Th e y occur along the ed g e of a o w o f basalt wh i ch is ov e r ,

lain a t t his poin t by d e pos i ts of ca lcar e ous and sil i c e ous s i nte r
and so lidied sil i ceous and carbonaceous muds t h rough wh i ch ,

s ulphur and cinnabar ar e n e l d i ss e mina t ed


y .

There ar e a lso d e pos i ts of py rites w i t h or wi thou t c innabar in ,

som e cas e s conta in in g trace s of bo t h gold and s ilv e r 1


Th e .

s in ters also contain gold and s ilv e r .

The ground around t he springs is g e nerally very hot 5 and all


a t temp ts to d e v e lop the quicksil v e r deposits have b e en frus t rated
by t h e large volum e s of hot water e ncoun tered a t shallow d e pths
be low th e s u rfa c e .

Th e d is t r i c t has been e xamined a t diffe r e n t t im e s by Cap ta i n


Hu tton Sir Jam e s H e ctor A M Ka y and t h e au thor ; bu t t h e
, , .

,

bes t d e s cri pt i on is that of Andr e P G rif th s who con ducted .


,

e x tens iv e pros pec ting a n d mining ope ra ti ons ther e i n 18 95 a n d


18 98 .

The mining O pera t ions and bori n gs disclos ed many im po r ta n t


d e tails wh i ch could not be gathered from a surfac e e xamin a
,

The iron pyrite s occu rs in ma ss e s near th e basalt and also fill ,

ing c racks a n d ss u re s i n that roc k Th e thickn e ss of th e masse s .

varies from 3 inch e s to 3 f ee t but their oth e r d i me ns ions ar e ,

extrem e ly irr e gul ar .

Clos e to the pyri t ic mass e s th e re is a hard whi te s i l i c e ous ,

sinter from 8 to 1 0 i nch e s t hick w h i ch G r if ths fo u n d to


, ,

contain gold and s ilver in places O n e assay of th e sinter gave a .

1
An dre P G rif th s T h e O h ae a wai Qu ic k s il ver Depos its T r a ns N ew
.
,

,
.

Z e a l a nd I n s tit u te M in ing E ng .
, v ol . ii .
p 8
. 4 .
11 8 MININ G GEOLOGY .

valu e of 3 per ton but unfortunat e ly th e propor ti ons of th e


,

gold and silv e r are no t g i v e n 1


.

Th e cinnabar g e n e rally occurs l i ning small caviti e s and cracks


in th e s olidi e d muds and sint e rs surround i ng the original ss u re s
in th e basalt I t also occurs impr e gnating the sinter in an e x
.

t r e m e ly n e ly divided form .

S u lphur occurs throughout the sinter in larg e r propo rtion than


eith e r the cin n abar or pyrites .

T h e hot springs give 0 11 large quantities of H 2 8 and occasion ,

ally a lit tl e steam Th e gas escaping through the wat e r of th e


.

pools and small streams is partially oxidised l i berating sulphur ,

which imparts a milky white colour to th e pools locally known ,

as whit e lakes .

The b e a c hes of the so call e d whit e lak es co n sist of sulphur


-
,

mixed with magn e tic ir on sa n d and a small proportion of alum , .

Sulphur is also b e ing sublim e d at th e vents or openings in th e ,

rocks from which 11 2 8 and S O 2 gases e scape


, .

T h e prospecting work conducted by G r if th s disclosed som e


inter e st i ng features .

A d e posit of cinnabar and pyrites crops out a t the foot of th e


hills to the south w e st of the main deposits A shaft was sunk
,
-
.

n e ar it and cut the lode at a depth of 35 f ee t The or e was 2


, .

f e et thick and consisted of small crystals of pyrites cem e nted by


,

cinnabar A t th i s d e pth t here was a strong evolution of HZ S


.
,

a n d th e h e at of the rocks increased so rapidly with the d e pth

that mining was extremely dif c u lt .

I t is noteworthy as showing th e r e c e n t formation of th e cin


,

nabar that n e ar the outcrop of this lod e was found th e charr e d


,

t runk of a tr ee part i ally emb e dd e d in hard siliceous mud Th e


,
.

trunk and roots of th e tre e were coat e d with a t h i n lm of c i n


nabar as also w e re some pi e ces of fossil kauri gum found near
,

the roots .

I n a small trench sunk over a fumarol e t h e temperatur e of th e ,

rock at a d e pth of 10 feet was found to be 1 8 5 F ahr


N o 1 bor e hole cas e d with 3 inch piping was put down to a


.
-
,
-
,

d e pth of 10 4 fe e t wher e it e ncountered th e e dg e of th e basal t


,
.

A t th e same t i me it struck a ss u r e from which hot mud was ,

proj e ct e d a h e ight of 60 fe e t abov e the s u rfac e for about forty


e ight hou rs .

The mud was succeed e d by boiling water charg e d with H28 ,

gas w hich was found to issue at a pressure of 30 1b p e r square


, .

inch .

G r ifth s further ment i ons that th e richest deposits of cinnabar


were found in clos e proximity to th e hottest fumarol e s and that ,

1
A ndre P G rif th s loo cit p 5 0 .
, . .
, . .
120 MININ G GEOLOG Y .

Baron von Richthofen who examined th e Comsto ck lode at ,


1
,

a time wh e n no abnormal te mperatu re was noticeabl e ascrib e d th e ,

origin of t h e lod e to e arl ie r solfa taric action .

Th e quicksilv e r mines at Sulphur Bank in Californ i a furnish , ,

impor tant e videnc e in r e lation to the gen e sis of or e d e po s i ts


.

A t this plac e the basement rocks are slate and san dstones ,

ov e rla i n by a freshwater form ation which in turn is capp e d by ,

a o w of basalt The geologic f e atur e s ar e almost id e n t ical with


.

thos e existing a t O haeawai .

Th e sandstones and slates are broken and s s u re d in such a


way as to form a br e ccia Th e int e rspac e s ar e lle d partly wi t h .

a still sof t or alr e ady indurat e d siliceous past e containing n e ly ,

diss e minat e d metallic sulph i d e s and partly wi th cinnabar for th e , ,

most part in coh e r e nt crusts 2


.

I n th e sam e min e th e basalt i s reduc e d to a porous m ass ,

and trav e rs e d by irregular s s u re s lle d wi th sulphur and ,

cinnabar 3
.

Hot m i neral wat e r and gas e s carrying H2 S forc e their way , ,

through th e int e rstic e s of t h e d e po sit i n the s s u r e d sandston e s


and slat e s .

The silica deposits are found in all stages of consolidation from ,

a g e latinous mass to chalcedony and alt e rnat e with layers of ,

m e tall i c sulphid e s consis t ing of cinnabar and pyrites , .

Unfor tuna t ely no i nformation is ob tainable as to th e nature of


th e fr e shwat e r formation lying b e tw e en the Cr e taceous sa nds ton e
and basalt .

According to B e cker the hot water is rich in c hlo r ides borax , , ,

and sodium carbonat e The gas e s l i be rat e d from th e wat e r con .

sist e d of 8 93 parts of 0 0 2 2 parts of HZ S 7 9 parts of marsh gas , ,

and 2 5 parts of ni t rogen in 10 0 0 parts .

Accord i ng t o D r Me lvill e th e marcasit e associated with th e , ,

cinnabar contain e d traces of gold and copper and in th e


,

e lor e s c e n c e from the m i n e workings Becker detected trac e s of



,

cobalt a n d nick e l .

I n t he upper zone only sulphur was found low e r down sulphur


and c i nnabar and in depth c i nnabar and pyrit e s occurring upon ,

or within d e posits of silica .

The St e amboat Springs in N evada furnish equ ally important , ,

1
F
. v on R i h th o fe
T h e Com stock L ode I ts Cha r a cte r a nd P r oba ble M ode
c n,
of Contin u a nc e in D ep th , S a n F ranc sc
,
1 86 6, p 5 4 i o . .

2
JL eC o te
n ,
O u M n ral V n s n ow in r r ss a S am a S r n s i e ei p og e t te bo t p i g
o p e it
c m ar d w h th e s a m

e t p
a S ul h ur B an , A m J ou r of S cie nce, k . . vol xxv . .

p . 40 4 .

3
Pro fe or F P T he G e e i of D epo s its A m ee
'

ss . ose p n
y, n s s O re ,
T r a ns . zc a n
'

I ns t . M in in g En g , v ol . xxiii .
p 1 97 . .
O RE D EP O S I T S G E N ET I CAL LY C O N S I D ER ED . 12 1

e vidence of v e in g by h ot s rin
p g action Th e y hav e b ee n
ll in r .

fully d e scrib e d by L e Conte Beck e r and o th e r wri te rs


1 2
, ,
.

I n a valley surrounded w it h e rup ti v e rock s and u nd e rlain by


al te r e d s e d i m e n taries b e liev e d to b e of arch aean age t herma l , ,

s prings issu e from s e v e ral po i nts from no rth a n d sou t h s s u r e s .

Th e oor of t he vall e y is cov e r e d i n plac e s wi t h a sh ee t of , ,

ca lcareous s in t er in which t h e r e ar e many ss u re s h e r e and t h e r e


, ,

still op e n bu t mos tly cl os e d by t he d e pos it of sil i ca on th ei r wall s


, .

F rom som e of t he sp rin gs hot vapours and gases c h ic y COQ ,

a nd H S
2
s t ill i ss ue , .

Beck e r fo u nd in th e mineral water small amoun ts of m e rcury , ,

sulphi de and sod ium sulphide .

About a mil e to t he w e st of th e ma in group t h e r e are similar


ss u r e s yield i ng s t ea m and C O I n th e s i n ters of t h e s e occur
s e v e ral m e tallic s ulphid e s .

Beck e r analys e d t he llin g of s e v e ral s s u re s and fo u nd , ,

b e si des hydra te d fe rric ox i d e l e ad copper and m e rcury s ulphid e s , , ,

gold and silver a n d t rac e s of zinc man g an e se cobal t a n d n i ck e l


, , , , .

The occ ur renc e of m e tall i c sulphid e s i n t he s i n ters a t Sulphur


Bank Stea mb oa t Springs a n d O ha e awai Hot Spring s ; th e
, ,

mushroom capped lod e s a t Wa i hi and G r e a t Barri e r I slan d ; t h e


-

t r ee stems replac ed by sulphides found in v e ins a t gr e a t d e p th s


-
,

below th e pres e nt su rfac e afford conclusiv e e vid e nc e of th e llin g ,

of veins by hot asc e nding wa ters and gas e s in areas occupi e d by


late e r uptiv e rocks .

It is a no torious circums ta nc e t ha t ore depos its are mo s t


.
-

common i n the n ei ghbourhood of e xt e nded zones of ign eous rocks ,

as in Hungary Transyl v ania Ne vad a Colo r ado and Ne w Zealand


, , , , ,

wher e th e v e in b e ar i ng rocks ar e pr i ncipall y andesi te phonol ite


-
, ,

and t rachyte I n o ther rocks vein s ar e f e w e r and mor e s c a t ter ed


. .

F or v ei ns in th e alt e r e d la ter e ruptiv e s L i ndgr e n s ugg e s ts th e


nam e propyl i te v e ins bu t i t is doub t ful whether t h e g e n et ic
-
,

diff er e nc e b e tw ee n t h e m and t ru e ss u r e v e in s is s u f c ie n t ly -

marked to j ustify th e d i s tinction M or e ov e r t h e roo ts of propyl i te .


,

v e ins would be dif c u l t to distingu i s h from ss ur e v ei ns conn e cte d -

w it h a plu ton i c intrusion .

Profe ss or S u ess speaking of t he impo rta nc e of th e 1 01e


3
,
'

played by th e wan i ng phases of volcanic phenom e na in t h e


forma ti on of mineral v e ins says Ho t springs may b e tak e n as -
, ,

1
J L C onte O M i ner l Vein w i Progre t S tea m b t S pri g
. e ,
n a s no n ss a oa n s
co m p red with th am e t S lph r B a k A m J r f S n
a e s l xxv a u u n ,
. ou . o cze ce , v o . .

p 424
. .

3
G F B c r, . . e ke
G l y f th e Qu c s l v r D e s s f th e P eo og o iki e po it o a c i c

o e
S l p , U S G eo l S u rv ey , ash n n , 1888, p 3 3 1
. . . W i gto . .

3
Poe o
r f ss r Edwa rd S u ss , L c ur s , T he G eog r ap h ic a l J ou rn a l , v ol e et e . xx .
,

N ov 1 90 2 , p 5 2 0
. . .
12 2 MININ G GEOLOGY .

the latest phases of a whol e seri e s which led up to th e pr e sent



deposits of ore .

A c tion of a scend ing A lka line Wa ter s Th e wat e rs wh i ch r i s e to


the surfac e in th e r e g i on about L ak e Rotorua ar e alkalin e neu t ral or , ,

acid Shafts and bor e ho l e s pu t down in th e pum i c e a n d rhyoli tes


.
-
,

which constitute th e great b u lk of the rocks in this ar e a hav e shown ,

that th e alkalin e waters come from a d e ep seated sourc e whil e th e -


,

acid wat e rs hav e quite a s u pe r c ia l origin This has l e d to th e .

erron e ous conclusion that all the wa t er s have not a common origin .

L ake Rotorua is an old crater lak e the southern shor e s of which -


,

are crus t ed ov e r with deposits of s i nt e r formed by the exis t ing hot


springs Below the sinter ther e is a thick deposit of pumic e and
.
,

below th e pumic e o ws of rhyolite g e nerally pum i c e ous or p i solitic .

I n th e pumic e ther e ar e m a n y de pos its of n e ly diss e m i nated'

marcasite which were apparently formed by solfatari c action at


some e arlier dat e in th e way t hat th e d e posits of pyrit e s and
,

cinnabar are now being formed at O ha e awai Hot Springs nor t h ,

of Auckland The hot ascend i ng alkaline chlorinated waters


.

becom e partially or wholly oxid i s e d into sulphates by contact with


the decomposing iron sulphid e with forma t ion of free sulphuric
and hydrochloric acids and liberation of sulphurett e d hy drogen
,

and sulphurous acids I n this way the ascending alkaline waters


.

that happen to com e in contact wi t h masses of pyrites b e com e


oxidised in t h e superficial laye rs of th e pumice and ris e to the ,

surfac e as neutral or acid springs according to the d e gree of oxida


tion th ey have u n dergone .

Thus within a small ar e a we have the sing u lar phenom e non of


,

waters that r e ach the surface in all conditions ra n ging from the
highly alkaline to th e ex t r e mely acid according to the degree of
oxidation of the contain e d salts .

Th e composition of the salts in the alkaline waters of Ra c h e l


1

Spring in grains p e r gallon is as follows


Sodium chlorid e ,

Potassium chlor i d e ,

L ithium chlorid e ,

Sodium s u lphat e ,

Silica ,

Sodium silicat e ,

Calc i um silica te ,

M agn e sium silicate ,

O xides of iron and alumina ,

Total ,

1
T h e M ine ra l Wa ters a nd H ea lth Resorts of N ew Z ea la nd , Dr Woh l mann ,
P t
a r I , 190 4,
.
p 3 9. .
OR E D EP O S I T S G E N ET I C ALLY C O NS I D E R E D . 12 3

Also sul phur ett ed hydrog e n and carbon dioxi de no t estimated .

I n th e major ity of c a s e s th e alkal i n e spr i ngs d e pos it lay e rs of


,

s i lica on th e walls of th e v e n t and at th e su r fac e th e latte r ofte n ,

form i ng larg e mushroom shap e d mass e s -


.

Th e composi t ion of th e wat e rs of th e Pri e st ho t spring wh i ch ,

may b e tak e n as typical of th e acid wate rs is as follows ,

G rai ns pe r g allo n .

Sulphate of soda ,

po tash trac e s
,

lime ,

magn e s i a ,

alum i na ,

iron ,

Sulphur i c acid (free ) ,

Hy drochloric acid (free ) ,

S i lica ,

96 7 7

Th e t e mperature of the alkal i n e wa te rs as their de e p seat e d ,


-

o rig i n would sugg e s t is very high varying from 180 to 2 1 2


, ,

Fahr whil e tha t of the acid wat e rs is low commonly ranging ,

from 98 to 1 10 F ahr

.

The sinte rs are found of all degrees of ha rdn e s s Th ey ar e .

soft spongy and v e sicular or hard and compact Th e sin te r


, , , .

encrus t i n g the walls of t h e ss u re s and pip e s from which th e


wat e rs escap e at th e sur fac e is generally hard and chalc e donic
a n d arrang e d in laye rs wh i ch often present a n e ribbon s t ructur e -

Hand sp e cim e ns of the hard e r sint e rs canno t b e


from much of th e o r e found a t t h e outc rop of th e
Martha lod e at Waihi I n pl a c e s t h e s i nt e rs conta i n n e ly d i s
.

sem i nated marcasit e and a t rac e of gol d and s i lv e r .

Around Roto rua we can see or e d e pos its of th e solfa ta ric clas s
still in process of formation on a scal e of consid e rable magn i tud e .

O f th e genesis of the ascending alkal i n e waters nothing is known


.

at pre s e nt .

( ) F u m a ro l ic
6 I n this class ar e group e d d e posi ts of s ulph ur
.
-
,

f e rr i c chlorid e cupric oxid e and boron sal t s forme d by t h e e scap e


, , ,

of steam and gas e ous emanations in volcan i c r e gions O f th e se .


,

sulphur and boric acid alone ar e of economic value .

Boron salts are common in many vol can i c reg i ons Th e ent i r e .

production of boric ac i d from Ita ly is ob ta i n e d from t h e s te am


fumarol e s in th e provinc e s of Pisa a n d G rosse to .

Sulphur is subl i m e d from fumarol e s and crat e rs by t h e mutual


r eac t ion of hydrog e n s u lphide and sulphur d io xid e I t is found .
124 MININ G GEOLO G Y .

impregnating vesicular lavas tufts and sili c eous sinters and mix e d , , ,

wi th volcanic muds and gypsum deposits .

Th e most important known d e posits of sulphur occur in Italy ,

Spa i n Hungary Chili Me xico Japan Uni te d S tat e s and Ne w


, , , , , ,

Zealand .

The sulphurd e posits of I taly occur in veins or len t icular


masses in rocks of Mi ocene ag e c h ie y in the provinces of
, ,

Cal tan i setta and G irg e nti .

I n N evada the sulphur b e aring rock oc c u rs in b e ds lying


,
-

b e twe e n limeston e and magnesian rocks .

111 Utah th e sulphur occurs associat e d with gypsum near an


, ,

old crater .

A t Tiki te r e in N ew Zealand th e re are e xt e nsive deposits of


, ,

sulphur in an old crat e r A large proportion of the sulphur is.

th e black amorphous variety The heat of the fumaroles and hot .

S prings is too gr e at to permit the excavation of the sulphur to a


gr e at e r depth than 6 or 8 feet .

A t Whit e I sland th e d e posits of sulphur occur in and around


,

th e crater lake mixed with gypsum The crat e r water is ho t


-
, .
-
,

and highly charged with free hydrochloric and sulphuric acids .

Th e gypsum is deposit e d in crystall i n e incrustations on the sides ,

and oor of the cra t er lak e The sourc e of the lime has not y e t
-
.

be e n d e termine d ; but the supply must be constant as gypsum i s ,

b e ing deposi t ed continuously .

The sulphur is depos i ted in the wat e r from gas springs which -

are s e en bubbling e verywhere in th e oor of the lake and also


from fumarol e s around th e margin of the crater .

6 ) C o n t a c t M e ta m o r h ic D o i
( p e p s ts A molten magma .

t e n ds to e ffe ct changes in th e rocks with which i t com e s in


contact I n th e case of ov e r o w magmas the thermal chang e s
.
,

ar e g e nerally t r i in g and in many cases hardly appr e c i abl e


, .

E v e n magmas tha t hav e cool e d in r e nts in sedimen t ari e s at


shallow d e pths hav e not al ways caus e d great chang e s in the
,

enclosing rock .

The gr e at e st alteration will naturally tak e plac e in the case of , ,

magmas that do not reach t h e surfac e but cool slowly under ,

gr e at pr e ssure .

Th e gr e a t er the mass of the intrusive magma th e slow e r wil l ,

b e the rat e of cooling ; and th e slow e r the rate of cooling the ,

long e r will th e adj acent rocks b e h e at e d .

Th e rate of cooling will be mainly dependent upon the mass


of the i ntr usion th e dis tance from the su rface a n d the rela ti v e
, ,

thermal conductivity of the adjac e nt rocks .

The changes effect e d in the country rock by the intrusion of an -

igneous magma will be mechanical and thermal .


12 6 MININ G GEOLOGY .

I t is probable that t he cir c ulation of the heated mineralised


solutions in the later phases will t e nd to effe c t a redistribution of
, ,

the ores and minerals d e pos i t e d in the e arlier stages I n some cases .
,

t he ascending wa te rs and gases may reach the zon e of surface


circula ti on and mix wi th t he met e oric waters which may then
, ,

reapp e ar as hot springs forming ore bodies and v e ins not directly ,
-

in con tact w i th th e eruptive magma .

W ee d and som e oth e r wri te rs have made an attempt to


s ub di v id e conta c t metamorphic deposits i nto groups dep e nding
-
,

mainly upon the mode of occurrence B u t the form and mode of .

d i s t ribut i on may be du e to accid e n t s of de n sity or porosity ,

composition and hydrous condition of the rocks a ffecte d rather ,

than d i ffe r e nces in genetic formation .

M oreover the mass of the magma the weight of s u pe rin c u m


, ,

b e n t rocks t he amount of hea t and subsequent contraction a n d


, ,

phase of t he af t er action are all doub tless contr i buting factors in


-
,

connection with the form and distr i bution of th e heavy metals .

M asses of ore occurring as contactdepos i ts ss u re v e ins and


, ,
-
,

bed impr e gnations in the zon e of metamorphism may all be t raced


-
, ,

t o the same gen e tic caus e s .

Professor L de L aunay of Paris supports the vi e ws of the school


.
, ,

of D e Beaumont and D au b r e e i n respect of th e primary in u e n c e of


volatil e m i neral i se rs emanating from eruptive magmas The emana .

t i ons he contends must have prepar e d th e way by in t roducing into


, , ,

t he enclos i ng rocks or simply by deposit i ng in the vein ss u r e s


,
-
,

const i tuents such as sulphid e s u or ide s chlor i des etc which s u b s e , , , .


, ,

qu e ntly dissolv e d ane w by th e circulation of s u p e r c ia l wat e rs hav e ,

rend e red the latter essential aid in th e proc e sses of al t eration 1


.

The extent of contact me tamorph i sm e ff e cted by the granite -

intrusions of Albany i n N ew Hampshir e was fully i nv e stigat e d by, ,

Hawes 2
His analyses show e d a progr e ss i ve series of changes in
.

the schists as th e y approach th e gran i te The rocks are de .

hydrat e d boric a n d silicic ac i ds have be e n added to them and


, ,

there appears to have b e en an inf u sion of alkal i at the time of


contact He regarded th e schists as having been impr e gnat e d by
.

hot vapours and solut i ons emanating from t h e grani te .

Contact deposi t s frequently lie at th e boun dary b e tween the


-

erupt i ve and the country ro c k ; also at variable distances from -

t he e ruptive but nev e r outsid e th e zone of metamorph i sm


, .

M ore par ti cularly conta c t ores occur in limeston e s ma rly and


,
-
,

clay slat e s a n d are accompanied by the usual c ontact min e ral s


-
,
-
,

garn e t v e suvianit e scapolite wollastonit e aug i te m ica horn


, , , , , ,

bl e nd e e tc and in clay slat e by chiastol i te e tc


, .
,
-
,
.

1
L de L a u n a y T he G e nesis of Or e D ep os its 1 90 1 D i sc u ss io n p 6 1 6
.
, , , ,
. .

3
G W Hawes A me r J o u r n S c i xx i 1 88 1 p 2 1
. .
, . .
, .
, , . .
O RE D EP O S IT S G E N ET I C ALLY C O N S I D ERED . 12 7

Contact ores ar e pr i nc i pa lly magn etit e a n d spec ular i ron bu t


-
,

sulphi de s of copp e r l e ad a n d zinc oft en oc cur , , .

con tact d e pos its ar e typ i cally repr e s e nte d by t h ose of


-

in N orway R i o Tinto Tharsis and San D omin go i n , , , ,

Spa i n .

Th e pyr it i c or e mass i n M oun t L yell M ine i n Tas mania is


-
, ,

g e n e rally d e scrib e d as a r e plac e m e n t conta c t d e pos it al though its ,

g eo log i c occurr e nc e d oes no t s trj c tly conform t o t h e co m mon de


n it io n of such a body Prof e s s or G r e gory d esc r i bes i t as a b oa t
.

shap e d mass ly i ng b et w ee n talcos e sch i s t a n d conglom e ra te s


,
1
.

Th e m i ne worki ngs hav e shown t hat i t gradually t ape rs down


-

wards from the ou t crop b ei ng cu t o ff w it h a rounded base by a ,

gr e a t t hr us t plane ( too a t )
-
.

There ar e no eruptiv e s i n ac t ual c on tac t w it h t he or e body -


,

bu t dykes of d i abase and o ther i gn eous rocks occur in t h e dis t ri c t ,

a t no gr e at distanc e Th e pr e s e nc e of t h e s e dyk e s and of ban d s


.
,

of sch i s t i mpr e gna t ed w it h sulphides forming fahlbands woul d


, , ,

lead to t he b e lie f tha t a t o ne ti m e ther e ex i s t ed chann e ls of com


m u n ica t ion l e ad i ng from the e ru p ti v e magma s to t h e v e in cavi tie s -
.

I n all p robab i l ity th e M oun t Lyell sul ph i de ore bod ie s a n d be d -

impregna ti ons were forme d in t h e la ter or solfata r i c s ta ges of , ,

e rup ti ve aft e r ac t ions -


.

( )
d R e g io n a l M e t a m o r p h ic D e p o s it s To t h i s group .

belong t he d e posi ts of iron o r e which occur i n al tered sed i -

m e n t ary rocks g e n e rally of old e r Pal aeozoic age


,
.

Th e i ron probably ex i sted or i gi nally as sed i men tary d e posi ts ,

and b e cam e conc e n t ra t e d a n d r e arrang e d und e r the in u e n c e of


th e h ea t pressur e and solu t ions wh i c h caused the me tamorph i sm
, , ,

of t he enclos i ng rocks .

E xampl e s of d epos i ts of ore due to regional m e tamo rph i sm i n ,

wh i ch m e tasoma ti c proc e ss e s doub tl e ss took an activ e pa rt ar e ,

foun d among t h e valuable magnet i c d e pos i t s of Swe d en and t h e


vas t specular iron and magn etite mass e s of M ich i gan .

Mass i v e aggr e ga te s of magne tite ar e common i n chlori t e schis t -

and m i ca sch i st in all par t s of t h e globe


-
.

Metamorph i c rocks also e nclos e be d s of iron pyri te s and pyr


r h ot it e t h e or i gin of which is st i ll obscur e
, .

III M E T E O R I C WA T ERS . .

( )
a C h e m ic a l I n this group are i nclud
. e d d e posits of sal t ,

borax nitr e bog i ron ore and some d e pos it s of gypsum a n d


, ,
-
,

mangan e s e .

1
P ro fe or J W G regory T h M o nt Lyell Mi i ng F iel d T
ss .

A u t ,

e u n ,
r a ns . s .

I t Mi
ns . E n . l 1 Part I V J ly 1 90 4 p 2 8 1
vo . . .
,
u , . .
128 MININ G GEOL OGY .

M This group includ e s all sedimentary ro ck s


( )
b e ch a n ica l .

form e d by th e ag e ncy of water i n lak e s and seas also alluv ial


drift s wh e th e r loose or compac t of river or lake origin con tai n
, , ,

ing gol d t i n pla t inum a n d g e ms and ore bear i ng


, , ,
-

d e posi t s.

IV .
OR G A N I C .

V b 1 o u p e mbraces all vari e ti e s of


( )
61 e g e t a l e This
.
g
fuel rang ing f1 o m peat t o an thrac i te also graph i te 0 11 shal e
, , ,

m i n e ral o i l and natural gas


,
.

A n im a l .The m i nerals i nclud e d in t his subdivision are


l im e stone s including chalk and m i n e ral phosphates
,
.
1 30 MININ G GEOLOGY .

belonging to the r st group are i n frequent and


O re -deposits ,

therefore economically subordinat e in impo rtanc e to those of the


se c ond group They include according to Vogt
.
,

( )a The o c currences of titani c iron ores in basi c and semi basi c -

eruptives .

( b) Chromite in peridotite .

( )c S ulphide deposits i n c luding the ni c keliferous py r rhotite of


,

Sudbury in Canada ,
.

( )
d Platinum metals in highly basic eruptive ro c ks
-
.

() e Copper and metalli c ni c kel iron in serpentinised peridotite .

That sulphides c a n be segregat e d from e ruptive magmas in the


rs t conc e ntration has yet to b e proved and it is still doubtful
how far V ogt s c onclusions respe c ting the occurrence of sulphide

or e as a product of primary segregation from a molten magma


, ,

a re admissibl e .

I n all cases metasomati c pro c esses a re sa id to have played an


important part in th e formation of these valuable depos i ts .

111 the e ruptive after action group V ogt i n c ludes cassiterite


-
,

and apat ite veins and ore deposits of contact metamorphic zone - -
.

Cassiterite deposits are everywhere conne c ted with acid crup


t iv e s principally granite and oc c asionally qu a rt z po rphyry and
, ,
-

rhyolite Partly for this reason and partly because of the


.
,

chara c teristi c paragen e sis of u or ide bora t e and phosphate , ,

minerals he supports the common view that tin deposits are


,
-

genetically connect e d with granitic eruptions a n d that various ,

volatile u oride s took part in th e ir formation .

Cassiterit e veins were forme d he thinks by p neu matoly tic , ,


1
p ro cesses that is by the action of gases and water at high
, ,

t emperature and pressure .

H e further urges that they were formed immediately after the


eruption and before t he c omplete cooling of the granite one
, ,

proof o f which h e thinks is the o cc urren c e of tin vein mine rals in


, ,
-

veins of pegmatite in th e granite .

Cassiter it e veins are admittedly independent of the immediately


adj acent country rock and for t his r e ason seem to be mo r e nearly
-
,

related to deposits of magmatic s e gregation than to conta c t meta -

morphi c d e pos i ts .

I t is probable that the magmatic segregation of chromite in


peridotite was in some cases e ffe ct e d by pneumatolytic agencies
b e fore the complete cooling of the magma It i s not uncommon .

to h n d chromi t e in v ei n like masses that have the appearan c e of


-

hav i ng be e n segregat e d i n cavit i es of c ontra c tion in the pasty


1
Pn eumatoly s i s is a term rs t u sed by B unsen to describe th e c ombi ned
actio n o f gases a nd water .
T H EO R I ES o r V E IN F O RM AT I O N . 1 31

magma As the agency of unde rground wate r cannot hav e been


.

act i v e i n this class of ore d e posit t he aggregat i on must hav e be e n -


,

e ffected by metal bearing s t eam and gas e s occluded i n th e igneous


-

P e gmatite veins while generally conne c ted w i th grani t ic ,

e ru p ti ons s ee m to be of lat e r format i on than the ca ssiterite veins


, .

They often pass into quartz a n d frequently possess sha rp w e ll ,

de n e d walls wh i ch suggest the ir forf na tion i n shr i nkag e cracks


by p n e u m a toh y da to gene t ic ag e ncies in t he wan i ng phas e s of t h e
-

aft er act i ons d ev e loped by th e progress i v e cool i ng of t he eru p ti ve


-
,

ma gma Teall h as sugg e sted that micrope gma tite is an eu t ec ti c


.

wh i ch crystallis e s at the lowest poss i bl e temperature a n d re ,

pr e s e nts i n c e rta i n rocks th e n a l mo t her l i quor from which th e -

o th e r minerals have crystallis e d ou t .

The di ffe r e n t phases of af t e r ac ti on must nec e ssar i ly m e rg e i n t o -

each o ther and henc e we may e xpect to n d as w e do ti n v e in


, , ,
-

minerals and e v e n c a ss it erite in veins of pegma tite .

Among ore deposi t s of contact m e tamorph i c origin V ogt in -


,

c lu de s the or e bod i es wh i ch occur with in th e m e ta morphos e d


-

contact zon e of d ee p e ruptiv e s esp e c i ally grani te


-
,
.

He d i s t i ngu i shes s e veral typ e s of contact d eposit Th e -


.

Christian i a typ e i nclude s i ron or e d e pos i ts tha t appea r t o have -

b e en formed befor e t h e solidi ca tion of th e grani ti c magma .

Th e se ores are n e ver foun d i n the gr ani te but al ways i n t he ,

adj acent rocks I f they h a d been introduced aft er th e cooling of


.

th e magm a they would also hav e been depo sit ed in th e granite


, .

Th e eruptiv e magma i s b e l ie ved to be the sourc e of th e


me tal which is ex pelled in th e heated steam into t he surround
.
i ng rocks .

I n 1 90 2 Weed proposed t h e following provisional g e n e t i c


1
,

c la ss ic a t ion bas e d on t ha t of V ogt

(
L I g n e ou s magmatic s e gr e gation )
( )
a S i liceous .

( )
6 Bas i c .

11 I gneous ( e manation deposits )


.

( )
a Contact m e tamorphic d e posits -
.

( )
6 V eins ( related to magmat i c v ei ns and d i vis i on IV
III F umarolic
. .

IV G as aqu e ous (pn e u m a toh yda to genetic) d e posits


.
- -

( )
a Fi lling d e pos i ts .

( )
b Replacement deposi t s .

1
W H Weed . . O re D epo s its near I gneo u s Co nta c ts
,

T r a ns A , . mer .

I ns t M E
. v ol xxx iii ,
1 903 p 71 5
. .
, , . .
1 32 MI N IN G GEO L OG Y .

V . M eteoric waters
( ) Underground
a .

( )
6 S u e r c ia l
p .

I n this c las s ica tion the maj or subdivisions are based upon
magmatic segr egation at one end and cold a queous deposition at
the oth e r w i th i nt e rmediate groups chara c teristic of the diff e rent
,

phases of erup t ive after a c tions -


.

Weed divides magmati c segregations into two groups namely , ,

S ili c eous and Basi c The latter embra c es deposits of iron c opper
.
, ,

e tc
.
,
found at igneous borde r s and as dykes and the former the ,

ore bear i ng pegmatites with quartz v e ins as extreme e xamples



,
1 -
.

This is a dist i nct departure from V ogt s con c eption of magmatic

segrega t ion I t is almo s t certa in that the segregation of ores


.

from basi c magmas and th e formation of cass i ter i te and pegmat i t e


,

ve i ns ar e genetically connected with the after act i ons of de e p


,
-

seated erup ti ons and as such must in some degree be relat e d and
, , ,

merge into each other But this genetic conne c tion whil e i t .
,

increases the dif c u lty of formulating a satisfac t ory c la ss ic a t ion ,

ha rdly j u s tie s th e subdivision proposed by Weed .

Th e synthetic exper i ments of D au b re e seem to support the


views of V ogt Beck and other observ e rs who maintain t hat
, ,

cass i teri te a n d pegmatite veins are formed by gaseous and aque


ous e manat i ons and not by direct segregation
,
.

G ol d is commonly assoc i at e d with acid ro c ks but it do e s not ,

o cc ur in such a mann e r as to suggest dire c t segregat i on 111 .

Queenslan d Ne w South Wal e s and N ew Z e aland it i s found in


, ,

quartz v e ins i n granite and quartz porphyry but in these cas e s the
-
,

veins m anifestly ll contraction c ra c ks .

Weed strongly dissents from the view expressed by Van Hise ,

that meteoric waters are an important creative fa c tor in the for


mation of ore veins He thinks however that primary hot ore
-
.
, ,

bear i ng solutions and hot vapours m a y rise into th e zone of


circulating meteoric wate rs heating the latt e r and charging th e m ,

with metall i c salts and such a c tive mineral solvents as u orin e ,

chlorine and bo ron He summarises his views relating to the


, .

formation of contact deposits as follows -

Contact metamorphic ore deposits oc c ur about the margin


of intrusive masses of granular i gneous rock either at the actual ,

contact or in the zone of metamorphosed sedimentar i es The .

depos i ts of e conom i c value oc c ur only where strata or blocks of


impur e limestone have been crystallis e d as garnet i f e rous or
act i nolite cal c ite rocks with cons e quent porosity
-
,
The ore .

minerals are intimately associated with these alum i nous silicates ,

1
Weed ,
Z oe . cit p 7 17
. .
1 34 MININ G GEOLOG Y .

Th e latter do not compare with the fo rme r as an e f c ie n t


cause .

T h e o ry o f L a te ra l S e c re t io n According to this th e ory it . ,

is assum e d that m e t e oric wat e rs percolating t hrough the c ountry


rock by the aid of carbon dioxid e and alkalies dissolve out
, ,

c ertain c onstituents which are afterwards d e posited in fissures ,

ther e by forming mineral veins -


.

The origin of the theory is unknown but it is certai n that ,

D elius in 1 7 7 0 G e rh arde in 1 7 8 1 and L asius in 1 7 89 wer e


, , ,

supporters of it th e latte r basing his conceptions u pon a c ar e ful


,

e xamination of the veins of th e Hartz mountains 1


.

I n 184 7 Professor Bischof of Bonn a distinguished geologi s t


, , ,

and chemist in his fascinating T ex book of Che mica l a nd P h y sica l
t
,

G eolog y dis c usses the chemical processes which take plac e when
,

met e oric waters and different kinds of aqueous solutions com e in


conta c t with rocks His work crea t ed a new s c ie n ti c basis of
.

r e sear c h in this branch of economi c geology He contended that .

ores were obtained by leaching from th e rocks travers e d by th e


v e ins and suggested the possibility of the v e in constituents
,
-

being found in th e adj ace n t r ocks .

I n 18 5 5 Forch h a m m e r th e famous chemist of Cop e nhagen


, , ,

found traces of lead copper and zin c in the r oo n g slates of , ,

N orth Wales a discov e ry which was held to a ff ord conclusiv e


,

proof of the or i gin of ore v e ins by processes of lateral secretion -


.

I n 18 7 3 Prof e ssor F S a n db e rg e r of Wurzburg dis sa tis e d with


,
.
, ,

the meagre results obtained from th e e xamination of sedimentary


rocks dir e cted his attention to a systematic chemical investigation
,

of the rocks t raversed by ore veins in di e r e n t mining centres in -

the Black F orest and of the v e in stuff itself ,


-
.

I n clay slate he discovered copper zinc l e ad arseni c antimony


-
, , , , ,

t i n cobalt and nickel in sandstone lead and copper ; whil e


, , ,

ti tanic and phosphori c acids were found to be present e verywher e


in small quant i ty .

S a n db e rg e r s r e sults showed that a clos e r elationship exist e d


b e tween v e in contents and the country rock ; but he was by no


- -

m e ans s a tis e d as to the origin of the heavy metals He accord .

in g ly extend e d h i s investigation to an examina t ion of the con


s t itu e n t s of ign e ous ro c ks .

He crushe d large samples of rock and separated the cons t ituent


minerals by solutions of different densities Samples of th e .

individual crystallised silicates thus isolated were subj ected to


c areful analysis and by this means w er e found all the usual
,

elements p r esent in metall iferous v e ins .

1
G eorge :Las i u s O b servations on th e H artz M ounta ins Ores a nd
, ,

M in er a ls v ol ii Han o ve r 1 789
,
. .
, , .
T H E R ES O I O F V E IN F O RM A T I O N . 1 35

Thus in olivin e h e foun d iron nickel c opp e r and cobalt in , , ,

aug it e coppe r cobalt i ron n i ck e l lead ti n a n d z i nc ; and in t h e


, , , , , , ,

m i cas many bas e metals Gol d mercury and tellurium were not .
, ,

sought for .

I n 1880 S a n db e rg e r announced his beli e f that t he mineral


,

con t en t s of veins w e r e d e r i v e d not from some unknown d e pth , ,

but from the immediat e wall rock -


.

G old b e aring v ei ns are common in slates and sandstones of


-

marin e origin and as s e a wa te i according to the announcem e nt - '

of S on s ta dt in 18 7 2 and of Profe s sor L iv e rs e dg e i n 1 893 con tains , , ,

according t o th e la tte r amounts ranging from 0 5 4 to 1 grain to ,

t h e ton it is held by the exponents of lateral se c r e tion t hat the


,

sea is t h e r e for e t h e source of th e gold in veins trave rsing ma rin e


, ,

s e dimentari e s .

I t is ma i nta i ned that wh e n sedimen ts are formed on the oo r


of the sea t h e y must nec e ssarily e n t angl e a c e rtain propo rtion of
s e a water and t hat when these s e dim e n ts b e com e consol i dated
,

th e gold must r e ma i n in th e m .

Th e theory of lat e ral secre t ion received a n e w impulse from th e


res e arch e s of S a n db e rg e r I t seem e d compet e n t to e xplain t h e .

origin of many orev e ins and although strongly opposed by ,

Prof e ssor S te lz n e r of F r ei b e rg and Professor P os e pn y of P r z i , , ,

bram it found much support in America in a mor e or less


, ,

m od i e d form .

Thus E mmons 1 discus s ing t he manner in which he consid e rs ,

t h e L e adv i lle ore d e pos i ts w e r e prod uced summari s es his vi e ws ,

0 11 ore formation in g e n e ral as follows


-

( 1) O r e d e posi ts hav e b e en d e pos ited from solu ti on rar e ly in


-
,

op e n cavi ti es mos t fr e qu e ntly by metasoma t ic interchang e ,


.

( ) Solu ti ons do not n e c e ssar i ly come dir e c t ly upwa rd s bu t


2 ,

simply follow th e e as ie st chann e ls of approach .

( ) Th e mat e rial was d e rived from sourc e s with i n limited and


3
conc e ivabl e d i sta nc e v e ry ofte n the older in t rus i v e r ocks ,
.

E mmons while s upporting th e principle of lateral s e cr e tion


, ,

disclaims th e narrow views of S a n db e rg e r who limi t ed t h e sourc e ,

of the ve i n con te n ts to th e wall rock i n immediate conta ct with


- -

the vein 2
.

I n th e cri t ical discussion which follow e d th e publica tion of



Professor P os e pn y s paper 0 11 The G enesis of Ore D epos i ts i n

,

18 93 Blake a n d W i nslow r e a f rm ed their b e lief t hat t he z i nc and


,

lead ores of Wiscons i n were form e d by lateral secret i on


- 3
.

F E m m o ns T h e G enes i s o f Certain O re D epo s its



1
S . .
,
T r a ns A m

,
. .

I ns t
3
. M E . .
, v ol
p 12 5. xxx . . .

T he G e n es is of Ore D eposits , 1 90 1 , p 1 99 . .

3
L oc . cit ,
p 1 88
. . .
1 36 MI N IN G GEOLOGY .

Becker whil e strongly dissenting from P ose pny s view that


,

metasomatic repla c ement was inc apable of producing such pro


n o u n c e d ore bodies as those at L eadville makes a clea r statement
-
,

of the supposed operation of metasomatic proc e sses He says .


,

Replacement like solution must o c cur along ss u r e s or channels


, , ,

and metasomatic ore bodies will present analogies in form to th e


-

Open spaces of caves of solution ( loo cit p .


,
.

Rickard dis c usses the problem of ore fo r mation from a wide -

standpoint and is n ot a dogmatic suppo r te r of the ext r e me doc


,

trines of e ither as c e n sion or late ral se cr etion 1


He a f rm s that .

there is n o ground for the belief in the existen c e of a r ese rvoir of


water at g reat depth and maintains that all ascending water
,

must at one tim e have been desce n ding water .

This last ca n only be true in regard to meteoric wate rs S o far .

as the existen c e of deep seat e d water is c once rned his view is not
-
,

in accord with the hydrofusion theory of modern petrologists .

Rickard poss e ssing a personal knowledge of the g old elds of


,

Australia and Ne w Zealand discusses the probable orig i n of the ,

veins of the Thames g old e ld in the latter country ; and in the


main agrees with Captain H utton that th e y were formed by pro
cesses of lateral secretion by th e rmal waters .

Professor J L e Conte i n a carefully prepared thesis combats


, ,

the extreme views of both P os e p ny and S a n db e rg e r (toe c it p


'

,
. . .

He makes an earnest attempt to combine what is true in


each a n d reconcile their di ff erences I t is manifest however
, .
, ,

that h e leans favourably to the sid e of lateral se c retion processes ,

al though not de n e d as such .

He conside rs both sid e s partly right a n d both pa r tly w ro n g .

Asce n sionists he thinks are righ t in de riving metals mainly


, , ,

by as c ending solutions from great depths but wrong in imagin ,

ing th e se depths to be an exceptionally metalliferous barysphere


and wrong in not allowing subordinate contributio n s by lat e ral
curr e nts from t h e wall rock high e r u p-
.

The lateral s e cre tion is ts on the othe r hand are right he thinks
-
, , , ,

in deriving metals by l eaching from the wall ro ck but wrong in -


,

not making the thermospher e the main source .

L e Conte succinctly summarise s his views in the following


terms '

( )
1 O re -
deposits using the term in its widest sense may tak e
, ,

pla c e from many kinds of waters but especially from ,

alkalin e solutions ; for these are the natural solvents of


metallic sulphides and metalli c sulphides are usually the
,

original form of such deposits .

1
L oc . cit. , pp.1 90 a nd 2 11 .
1 38 MININ G GEOLOGY .

cha ra c te rs are certainly due t o the e e c t of descending


'

waters .

( )
8 That the maj ority of ore deposits if not all are partly -
, ,

deposited in pre existing op e nings and are partly replace-


,

m e nts of wall rocks -


.

From the above he seems to attach too little importa nce to the

genetic connection existing between ore deposits and eruptive
processes and pla c es much dependence upon the formative power
of meteoric waters .

Professor Ke m p contends that mining operations in America


1

show conclusively tha t mines become drier with incr e asing depth
and deep mining in South Africa Australia and N ew Zealand , ,

adds con rm a tion to this view The dryness of mines in dep t h .

seems to destroy the foundations of V an Hise s main contention

respecting the u nderground circulat i on of meteoric water .

V an H i se admits that there are ore deposits which have a dir e ct -

ign e ous origin but thinks they are of limit e d e xtent I n his
, .

rej oinder to Kemp he seems to som e what modify his former con
c e p t ion with respect to the r 61e of meteori c waters in v e in forma -

tion and admits that the r l e of igneous intrusions may b e very


,
2
considerable .

I t has b e en suggested by the oppon e nts of lateral secretion


that the m e tals contained in the silicat e minerals of eruptive rocks
ar e not primary but seconda ry consti t uents According to t h e ir
, , .

vie w lat e ral s e c r e tion is only a process of concentration


, .

A s c e ns io n O f S o lu tio ns Accor ding to this theory i t i s . ,

assumed that the material whi c h lls a lode has b e en brought in


solutio n from gr e at depths and not from th e rocks in th e immediat e
,

vicinity of the lode .

I n his classic memoir on T h e G enesis of Or e D ep osits the ,

late P r ofessor P os e pn y an ardent su pporter of the as c ension hypo


,

thesis laid great stress upon the occurren c e of sulphur and


,

cinnabar at S ulphu r Bank impregnating a de c omposed basalt and ,

still mildly in pro c ess of formation from gaseous emanations and


hot mineral waters .

Similar con ditions exist at S tea m boat S prings in West e rn


N evada wh e re we hav e an exampl e of a mineral vein in proc e ss
,

of formation The matrix is banded siliceous ve i n stone conta i n


.
-

ing iron and copper sulphid e s sulphur and metall i c gold , ,


.

S a n db e rg e r who was an equally strenuous supporter of lateral


,

se c retion obj e c ted to this view on the ground that he knew of no


, ,

1
J F . m ,
. Ke p
T h e R6l e f

u u s R c s in th e o Aq eo ok F ormatio n o f Vei n s,
T h e G en es is of Or e D ep os its , 1 90 1 , p 6 8 1 . .

3
C R Va n
. Hi e
s , T h e G en e sis of Or e D ep os its , 1 90 1 ,
. D i scu ss ion , p 76 3
. .
O I
T H E R ES or VEI N FO R M AT I O N . 1 39

spring which deposited mineral incrusta t ions on the walls of t h e ir


chann e ls He regarded t h e Sulphur Ban k and Steamboat Sp rings
.

phenomena as exceptional .

Becker who made a special examination of the d e po sits at


,

Sulphu r Bank a n d S t eamboat Springs s t rongly opposed t he views ,

of t he ex t rem e asc e n sionists And wi t h r e ga rd t o the orig i n of.

the deposits he e xpr e ss e d th e following views


,

Th e ev i d e nce
is ov e rwhelming that t he cinn a bar pyr i te and gold of the quick , ,

s i lver mines of t h e P a c ic slop e r e ached t he i r present pos it io n s


in hot solutions of doubl e s u lphid e s which w e re leached out fr om ,
1
masses underlying th e gran i t e and th e grani t e its elf F u rt h e r .

on h e says : I r e gard many of the gold vei ns of California as


having an origin entir e ly simila r to that of t he quicksilver



deposits .

Beck e r s views postulate a new hypothesis which lies midway



,

betw ee n the as cension and lat e ral secre t ion theori e s and e xpresses -
,

our pres e nt knowledge of oreformation more nea rly than th e


e xtr e me views of P os e pn y and S a n db e rg e r .

According to th e de n it ion of la t eral secretion by the latter ,

t h e d e sc e n d ing wate rs b e ca me charg e d with mineral matter by


l e aching th e rocks in the region of vadose circulation O n the .

oth e r hand P os e pn y ass umed tha t the asc e nding wa t ers b e cam e
,

charged a t gr e a t d e pths by coming in con ta c t w ith a de e p seated -

b u t hypoth e tical repository of metalliferous ma t ter .

Th e m odi ca t ion sugg e s t ed by Becker favours the ascension


t h e ory and di ffers only from th e lateral s e cr et ion hypothesis in


,
-

assuming a d ee p e r sourc e for the mineral conte n ts of the v e in


matter .

S u m m a ry F rom t h e da ta r e co rd e d in th e pr e ceding pages


. ,

we may deduce the following conclusions r e spe c ting th e g e nesis of


ore deposi t s
-

( )
1 That t he maj ority of ore d e posits are g e n e tically connect e d
-

with ign e ous i n t rusion s wh i ch may be plutonic or volcan i c .

(2) That c i rc u lating und e rgr ound wa ters a n d gas es are th e


princ i pal agents conc e rn e d i n t h e d i s s olu ti on primary ,

conc e ntration and deposition of vein ma tte r


,
-
.

( )
3 Tha t oredepo sits do not necessar i ly occupy pre e xisting -

s s u r e s and cav itie s .

( )
4 That vein llin g was in many cas es effected by metasomatic
-

repla c em e n t .

( )
5 That vein llin g waters are a scending waters bu t not
-
,

nec es sa r i ly d e epseated .

1
G . F . c Be ke
r, T h e G l y f t h e eo og o Qu i ck s il ver D epos its o f th e P ac ic
Sl ope ,
U n ited S ta tes G eol S u r vey , M n
. o ograph xx iii , . 1 8 88, p 44 9. .
1 40 MININ G GEOLOGY .

That the mine ral contents are d e rived from rocks contiguous
to the zone of fractur e or zone of metamorphism .

That the accessory agents of dissolution are heat and


pressure aide d by dissolved alkaline minerals
,
.

That precipitation from th e asce n ding wat e rs tak e s plac e


in mor e or less o rd e rly hor i zontal zones in a cc ordance
wi th the laws governing solution a n d precipitation .

That s e condary enri chm e nt is in the maj ority of cases due


, ,

to the migration of mineral c ontents from a high e r to a


lower level through the agency of des c ending m e teori c
,

waters .

The theo ries of lateral secr e tion and as c ension of solutions are
based on the f u ndam e ntal assumption that the mineral matt e r
llin g cavities was deposited from circulating wate rs Th e ir .

d i fferenc e s lie principally in th e di ff erent c onceptions as to the


direction and operation of the circulating liquids .

( )
1 The lateral secretion theory supposes
( )
a That th e ll in
g of cavities was the work of des c ending

met e oric wate rs .

( )
6 That the ll in
g matt e r was principally obtain e d from

the adj a c e nt rocks by a process of leachi n g .

The asce n sion theory assumes


(a ) That the ll in
g of veins was eff e cted by d e ep c ir c u la t

ing wat e rs ascending t hrough open or partially


, ,

op e n ssu re s .

( )
b That th e mineral and metallic contents were deriv e d
from a de e p seat e d mineralised zon e
.

M any write rs assume that as c ending and descending wate rs a re

merely units in what may be termed a hydraulic circ uit th e ,

interchange being caused by gravitation ass i sted by capillary act i on


,

and the difference of tempe rature of the ascending and d e scending


waters .

M u c h of the mov e men t it is claimed is n e c essarily lateral a nd


, , ,

towards channels lle d with ascending waters .

I t was mainta i ned by Prof e ssor P os e pny and D r Raymond


that d e scending waters w e re mer e ly oxi dis i ng and incapabl e of
depositing sulphid e s Th i s contention has however be e n succ e ss
.
, ,

fully disproved by E mmons Becker V an Hise and other Am e rican


, , ,

geologis t s who hav e shown the e xistence of s e condary sulph i d e s


,

both above and below water level or in what may be termed the
-
,

zone of vadose circulation .


C H A P T ER VI I .

O RES A N D M I NE RA L S CONSI DE R E D
E C O N O M I CA L L Y .

CO N T E N T S Al
A l um i n i m
um A nti mo ny A rseni c A be to
u s s s
A sph ltum Barytes Bi mu th Bor x Cement C h rom i u m Co l
a s a a
Cob lt 0 0 pp Cry o l ite D iam o n d
a er F i recl y F l orite G old a u
Graph ite Gy p m Iron Le d Mag e iteM a gane e M i
su a n s n s ca

M o ly bdenu m N i ckel O il S h le Petro le m Pho ph ate R o k


a u s c
P l ti n m
a Q i c ks i lve r
u S i lver
u S late S l ph ur T lc T in u a

T un g ten Z i
s nc .

E VER Y mini n g student should possess a general knowledge of


the conditions under which the c ommonly useful ores a n d minerals
occur in N atur e and of the market condition quality and value , ,

of the m i nerals inten ded for metallurgical and manufactur i ng


purposes .

The market values are subj ect to cont i nual u c tu a t ion s and ,

the quotations given must be regarded more as a guide than a


standard of s e lling pri c es The min e rals and o r es are dealt with
-
.

in alphabeti c order .

A LUM .

The principal sou rc es of alum are alunite alum shales bauxite , , ,

and cryolite .

A lu m te o c curs in veins and masses in eruptive rocks and for


'

the most part in acid lavas of later date in which it has probably ,

been formed by metasomatic replacement attending waning


solfataric action .

A t Tolfa n e ar Civita V e cc hia in the neighbourhood of Rome it


, , ,

occurs as thin irregular veins wh ich are supposed to have been


, ,

formed in contraction c racks by th e action of hot wate rs and


-

sulphurous gases upon the felspars of the containin g trachyte .

A n important deposit of alunite oc c u rs at B u lla h de la h


M ountain in N e w South Wales I t c onsis t s of minerals rang i ng
,
.

from pu r e alunite to an impure form containing 4 0 per cent of .

silica The deposit is over a m i le long nearly three qua rte rs of a


.
,
-

142
O RE S A N D M IN ER AL S CON S I D ERED E C O N O MI CA LLY . 14 3

m ile wide and th e thickest band of stone varies from 6 0 to 7 0


,

yards wide I t is gen et ically connec ted with felsitic dyk e s which
.
,

t rav e rse Carboniferous slat e s The averag e compos it ion of t h e .

mineral is as follows

Wat e r ,

Alumina ,

I ron oxide ,

Po tash ,

Sulphuric a c id ,

S i l i ca ,

Alum is obtained by calci n ing and washing aluni te a n d


evaporating the liquors .

N atural alum is obtained in c ons i derable quanti t i e s in E ngland


and S cotland from the coal shales and alum c lays - -
.

Bauxi t e i s an i mpo rtant source of alum and aluminium sulpha t e


c entrated alum ) i n America F ranc e and G erma ny It
( con is an , , . .

aluminium iron hydra te a n aluminous form of l i moni te conta i n


-

i ng generally fr om 5 0 to 60 per cent of alumina .

O f Am e ri can bauxi te from 65 to 7 0 per cent i s produc e d , .

in t he S tate of G eorgia and the balanc e i n Arkansas and ,

. Alabama .

The bauxite deposits i n the D epa rtment of Var in F rance are , ,

mostly massive ooli ti c and c emented by carbona t e of l i me They


, .

o c cur in old lak e b a s i ns extending westwa rd from Cannet du L uc


, .

Th e or i gin of the mineral is still doubtful but by some w r ite rs i t


1s supposed t o hav e b ee n genetically conn e c t e d w i t h solfata r i c
act i on i n and around t he anc i ent lak e s .

A t Ba ux near Arle s t he bauxite occu rs ooli t ic and as gr ain s in


, , ,

a compact l i mestone .

O nly t h e varie t i e s of ba u xite free from iron oxide ca n be ut ilised


in the manufac t ur e of alum Th e purer grad e s are used for t he .

preparat i on of aluminium hydrate from whi ch the metal aluminium ,

is man u fac tured .

Cr y olzte another i mpo r tan t source of alum still continues to be


'

, ,

d e rived from th e min e s at I vigtut in G ree n land , .

Th e aluni te of Ne w South Wales is valued at abou t 3 per ton .

The American domestic bauxi t e ranges in value from 1 4 8 to .

1 8 8 per ton
. F r e nch bauxite is d e l i v e r e d at Am e r i can seapo rt s
.

a t a somewhat lower rat e than the domestic mineral on accoun t of


the railroad freight charges -
.
144 MIN I N G GEO L O G Y .

A LU M I N I UM .

This metal is largely manufa c tur ed in G ermany A me r i c a and , ,

F ran c e from bauxite principally produ c ed in the D epartment of


Var in S outhe r n F rance ( F or B a u xi te see
, .
,

A N T I M ON Y .

The only commercial ore of antimony is the sulphide antimonite ,

the oxides are secondary produ c ts found near the out c rop The , .

sulphide generally o cc u rs in veins in schist slate and sa ndston e , ,

and also asso c iated to a small ex t ent with ores of lead bismuth , ,

and copper .

The principal produ c e rs of antimonite ar e F ran c e Alger i a I ta ly , , ,

M exico Turkey Hungary Ch i na and Canada Considerable


, , , ,
.

deposits o c cur in N ew South Wales and N ew Zealand but the ore ,

is generally of too low a grade to be payable .

The ore must be very pure to be worth handling When u nde r .

2 5 per c ent in the mine it is pra c tically impossible to separate the


.

ore from its gangue .

Antimony ores are bought by smelters on a b asis of 45 per cent


-
.

of metal ea c h unit above that being pa i d for at s c hedule rate s


, .

Und e r 4 5 per c ent there is a discount until the limit is reached


.
,

below which the or e has no commerc ial valu e E n glish smel te rs .

do not care to tou c h ores containing unde r 4 0 p e r cent of metal . .

I n America an ore to be marketable must contain not less than


,

5 0 per cent of antimony . .

O res intended for the E ngl i sh market must be free from lead ,

arseni c c opper and zinc O n e per c ent of lead will r ende r the
, , . .

ore unsaleabl e .

The size of the ore also a ff e c ts the market val u e of the dr e ssed
mat e rial whi c h should not be b roken in pieces smaller than a
,

hazel nut
-
.

A n allowan c e is made for gold and silver when present in


s u f c ie n t quantity to pay f or extraction

The smelters payments .

are based on the dry weight The percentage of m e tal shoul d b e .

d e termined by the wet assay the re assay not being s u f c ie n tly ,

reliable .

Antimony is mostly used for the manufacture of type metal -


.

I ts value u ct u a t e s conside rably

A RS E N I C .

The arsenious oxide of c omme rc e is manufactured from ars e nical ,

pyrites which is generally mined in association w ith o r es of gold


, ,
14 6 n un1 no GEOLOGY .

of rain wate r The lake contains no liquid asphalt N early


-
. .

everywhe re the d e posit i s r m enough to walk upon .

A c cording to M alo th e average compos i tion of the c rude


1
,

asphalt is as follows

The g reater part of the U nited States production is obtained


f rom bituminous sandstones in Califor n ia and Kentucky The .

bituminous sandstone of California occurs in large qua n tities at


various points between San F ran c isco and L os Angeles 2
It .

contains from 1 2 to 1 8 per c ent of bitumen the remainder being .


,

quartz sa nd -
.

The asphalt deposits of Kentucky oc c ur in n early horizontal


n e grai n ed sandstone belonging to the lower Carboniferous
-

e r iod
p .

Bituminous limesto n es are the most important sou rc e of asphalt


in F ra nce Switzerland Cuba and the States of U tah Texas and
, , , , ,

I ndian Territory in the U nited States .

The Val de Travers mine at N eu c h atel in Switzerlan d and , , ,

the S eyssel mines in F rance yield an asphalt from bituminous , ,

l i meston e extensively used for paving purposes A t S e yssel .

there are seven beds of bituminous limestone varying from 10 fe e t ,

to 2 0 feet in thickness and containing from 4 to 10 per c ent of , .

bitumen .

The Tu rkish supply is mainly derived from Albania and


Pales t ine The depos i ts in th e D ead S e a region hav e long b e en
.

notable The bitumen springs at N ebi M usa contain from 30 to


.
-

4 0 per cent of asphaltum . .

The ozokerite deposits at Boryslaw in G alici a Austria supply , , ,



p ra c ti cally the world s annual output .

B ARY T E S .

This mineral is found as irregular masses in schists and l l me


s tone I t is often associated wi t h lead ores
.
-
.

The world s production is pr i ncipally obtained from G ermany



,

G reat Brita i n U n ited States and B e lgium On e of the largest


, , .

1
Leon M al o L ,
A sp h a lte, p 2 0 , ar

. P i s, 18 88 .

2
F V G reene
. .
,
Ap
s h al t
a n d its U s e s T ra n s A m I . . n s t. AL E ,
v ol . vii
x .
,
3 5 5 , 1 888
p. .
0 3 11s A N D MIN ER ALS CO N S I D ERE D E CO N O M IC A LLY . 14 7

known deposits occu rs at Silver I sland near the no rt h end of ,

Lake Supe rior .

Baryt e s is now largely employ e d i n t h e manufactur e of paints .

Th e price of th e raw ma ter i al varies from 1 2 3 to 2 18 per t on . . .

B AU " I T E .
( S e e
Alu m .

B I S MU T H .

M etall i c b i smuth g e n e rally occu rs in v e ins in gne i ss schist and , ,

clay sla t e accompany i ng or e s of silver cobal t lead wolfram z i nc


-
, , , , ,

and gold It i s c h ie y derived from t h e s i lv e r and cobal t m i nes


.

in Saxony a n d Boh e mia .

The p rinc i pal ores of commercial value are th e sulphi de ,

telluri d e and carbonate which ar e found ass ociated wi t h m oly b


, ,

de n ite u o rite pyr ite s chalcopyr i te and apat it e


, , , ,
.

The worl d s supply of bismu t h comes pri ncipally from the S ta te


mines in Saxony Small quan titi es come from Colo rad o Ne w


.
,

South Wal e s and Queensland , .

The supply i s greater than the demand and or e s conta in i ng le s s ,

than 5 per c e nt of the m e tal leave no margin of pro t Th e


. .

price is abou t 68 pe r pound . .

B O RA" .

This mineral occurs as i ncru s tations in old lak e bas ins i n rain
less r e gion s and mix e d w it h clay in mars hes and shallow lagoons
,
.

Col e manite which is a ca lcium bora te is found in Californ i a i n


, ,

bedde d depos its as larg e mass e s mor e or l e ss connected by ,

s t ring e rs a n d bands N ear D agg et t th e coleman i t e deposits vary


.
,

.
from 5 f e e t to 30 fe et in thickn e ss 1
.

The worl d s supply i s derived from t he Un ited S ta te s Chili



, ,

Peru I ta ly and Turk e y The produc t ion of th e United States


, , .

i s ch ie y deri v e d fr om th e col e mani te d e pos its in Californ i a .

B owie a c id which i s largely u s e d in t he manufactur e of borax


, ,

is obta i ned from th e gas e ous e mana ti ons of steam fumarol es i n


vol c anic regions The ent ir e yi e ld of it from It aly is d erived from
.

the fuma rol e s in th e Provinces of Pisa and G ros seto .

C EME N
T .

Ch e mically considered cement i s an int i ma te admixtur e of lim e ,

and clay Ther e ar e two kinds of cement in th e mark e t namely


.
,

a rt i c ia l and natural .

R C am pbell Rec o nnai sa n e o f th Borax De p it o f D e th


.
,
s c e os s a

M oj ave De ert B l let in f the U S G l S



s y N
,
2 00 u o . eo . u r ve ,
o .
,
14 8 MININ G GEOLOGY .

c e ments are made in almost all civilised c ountries


A r ti c ia l .

N a tu ra lc e m e nts are produc e d direct from rock containing


more or less the requisite proport i ons of lim e an
United States and N e w Zealand produce c on s id
,

of natural c e ment from argillaceous limestone deposits of great


e xt e n t
.

Th e hydraul i c limestone at G renoble in F rance from which , ,

the n e s t natural cement in th e world is produced occurs ,

bed 15 feet thick interbedded i n a c ompact l i mestone I ts com


,
.

position is as follows
P e r c en t
.

S i l i ca ,
to
Alum i na ,

I ron oxid e s ,

Calcium carbonate ,

M agn e s i um carbo n ate ,


traces
Water loss etc , ,
.
,

10 0 0 0

The hydraulic limestones in Ne w Z ealand are of Upp er


Cretac e ous age They vary from 2 0 f e et to 1 4 0 feet in thickness
. .

Cement manufactured from the rock at M ahurangi show e d th e


follow i ng composition

S i lica ,

Alumina ,

I ron oxides ,

L im e carbona t e ,

M agnesia carbonate
Alkalies and loss ,

10 0 0 0

Th e iron seldom exceeds 3 per cent I t mostly o c c urs as .

grains of glauconite .

N a tu ra l c e ments ar e often e qual to the best a rtic ia l Portland


cements bu t g e nerally speaking t hey lack th e uniformi ty in
, , ,

composi t ion of the a rti c ia l prod u ct .

C H R O M I UM .

Chromite of iron occu rs in irreg u lar masses in peridotite and


s e rp e nt i ne The world s supply is principally produced by
.

Turkey N ew Caledonia G ree c e Ne w South Wal e s Canada a n d


, , , , ,
15 0 MININ G GEOLOGY .

hydrous oxide of manganese mixed with a variable pe rcentage of


cobalt .

The ores of cobalt are g e n e rally found accompanying those of


nickel and silver and som e tim e s t hose of copper and manganese
,
.

Th e cobaltif e rous bands at S ku tte ru d i n N orway cons i s t of , ,

alt e rnating thin b e ds of m i ca schist and quartz schis t th e latt e r - -


,

impregnated with pyrites cobalt glan c e cobaltif e rous mispick e l and


, , ,

a li t tl e chalcopyri t e S o far th ey hav e not proved of much va l ue


. .

The hydrat e d oxid e of cobal t of N ew Caledonia is largely


expo r ted to E urope and America I t occu rs intimately associated .

w ith hydrat e d oxide of manganese which is found in irregular ,

p oc k e ts of red clay in serpentin e This c obaltif e rous wad contains .

from 2 5 to 5 p e r ce n t of cobalt and at present is the principal


.
,

source of the world s supply .

U p till th e end of 1 90 1 a consid e rable po rtion of the domestic


supply of the United States was obtained as a by product in the -

treatment of the lead ores from M ine L a M o t te in the S tate of-


,

M issouri .

C O PP ER .

The chief sou rc es of cop pe r are the sulphides prin c ipally the
yellow sulphid e and nativ e coppe r When t he ore occu rs in .

large masses capable of being c heaply mi n e d 1 to 3 per cent of ,


.

th e metal is payable Th e great bulk of th e copper annually .

placed in the market 1s produced from very low grade or e s -


,

asso c iat e d with iron pyrites and often c ontaining a little gold and ,

silver .

The most important copper mines of t he world at the presen t -

t ime are those of M ansfeld in G e r many 5 Rio Tinto and Tharsis , ,

in Spa i n 5 San D omingo in Portugal 5 L ake Superior M ontana , , ,

and Arizona in the United States 5 and M ount L yell in


, ,

Tasmania .


The world s production of c opper amounts to over tons ,

of which the Uni t ed S tates p r odu c es over 5 5 per cent .

U N I T E D S T A T E s A t L ake S uperior in M ichigan the copper is


.
, ,

found in beds of conglomerate and sandstone in t e rs tra tie d with ,

o ws of amygdaloidal diabase forming what is known as th e ,

K e weenawan series and which is probably of pre Cambrian age .


,

The c onglome rates are the most productive I n th e m the copp e r .

occurs as the cementing material 5 it has evidently been deposit e d


from an aqueous solution The diabase o ws are amygdaloidal i n .

their upper layers and o cc asionally the lower side also may be
,

vesicular 1
They contain ri c h patch e s of native copper associated
.

with native silver .

1
T A R i c k ard T h e Copp er M ines of L a ke S up er ior p
. .
,
N e w Y ork ,
.
.
0 11115 AN D MIN ERALS C O N S I D ER ED E C O N O MI CA LL Y . 15 1

Copper i s also found in s s ur e veins crossing th e Keweenawan -

se ri es of th e nort hern end of th e peninsula Th e v e ins vary from .

10 feet to 30 f eet in wi d t h Th e y ar e riches t in th e diabas e


.
,

i n which t he copp e r occurs in the nativ e s tate being gen e rally ,

foun d in mass e s t he larg e s t mass w ei ghing nea rly 600 to ns


, .

Th e mos t productiv e min e s i n t h i s reg i on are th e Calum et



and Hecla O sceola
, Tamarack and Quincy
,
The two ,
.

fo rmer have shaf ts r e ach i ng th e great d e pth of nearly 5 0 00


fee t
.

It sho uld b e noted tha t e xtr e m e ly low grade or e containing as -


,

littl e as 1 5 p e r c e n t of coppe r ar e mad e to y ie ld large p ro ts in ,

t h e Lak e Superior dist ric t To achiev e this resul t enormous .

quanti t i e s of or e ar e min ed and stampe d .

Th e d i stinguishing f e atur e s of the M ichigan copper mines are -

t he e normous tonnag e of low g rade ore stamped t he low cos t of -


,

produ c tion and th e gr eat depth of th e mines


,
.

The production of the copp e r min e s in Butte distric t i n -


,

Montana is e v e n gr eate r than that of th e L ak e Superior m in


,

Th e mos t product i ve min e s a re the Anaconda Pa rr o t Bu t te and , ,

Boston Boston and M on ta na and Colo rado


, , .

The copper is found in east and west lod e s in gr anite The .

main lod e which runs t h rough t h e An a conda and Pa rrot mines


, ,

has proved p rod uc t ive for a dis tance of 3 m il e s alo n g the stri ke .

Th e av e rage width of t h e lod e s is 10 feet T h e coppe r occ ur s .

princ i pally as sul phides which ar e s ilv e rbearing t he propo rt ion


, ,

of s ilver varying from 5 o z to 2 o z pe r un it of c opper . . .

The Arizona copper m ines produce larg e quantities of oxides


-

and ca rbonates which occur in or n ear a Carbo nif e rous limesto ne


, ,

often nea r the poin t of contact with gr anite or with sandston e s ,


.

S P A I N AN D P O R T U G AL Th e copp e r depos its a t Rio T i n to


.
-
,

Tharsis and San D omi n go ar e of great exte nt They con sist


,
.

of compa ct pyrit e s conta i n i ng from 1 to 2 5 per c en t of copper


.

pyrites d i ss e minated t hroughout t he whole mass .

N ext to the Calum e t and H e cla t he Rio T i n to is t he greatest ,

c opp e r m in e in t he globe
-
.

G ER M AN Y The M ansfe ld copper min e s i n S axony have b e e n


.
-

work e d sinc e the twelf t h centur y The or e is found in a a t .

lying bed of cupriferous shal e of Upp e r P e rmi an ag e and not , ,

withstand i ng its th i nn e ss and compara t iv e ly low g rade in metal ,

it can b e work e d wi th p ro t It occurs in n e ly dis sem inated .

pa rticles throughout t h e shal e A gold e n y e ll ow colour indicates .


-

chalcopyr i tes ; a bl u ish a n d reddish va ri e gated colour in dicates


borni t e ; a ste e l gray copper glanc e 5 a grayish yellow i ron
,
- -
,

pyri tes ; and a l e ad e n gr ay gal e na-


,
.

Th e whol e bed conta i ns c opper but o nl y th e botto m 3 inch or ,


15 2 MININ G G EOLOG Y .

4 inch are rich and on an a ve rage contain 2 to 3 p e r c e nt of


,
.

copp e r and 16 3 oz of s ilver to the ton of copper


. .

A U S T R ALA S I A M ount L yell M ine on th e w e st coast of T a s


.
,

mania is on e of the principal copper produc e rs in th e Com mon


,
-

w e alth of Australia .

A t t he surfa c e the lode was a huge gossan consist i ng of dense ,

dark h ae matite and friabl e limonite containi n g gold and silver .

Below the oxidis e d zon e the ore pass e d into massive pyri te s l y ing
between talcos e sch i sts on on e side and conglom e rates on the other .

I n N ew S outh Wal e s there is a copper bearing area variously -

estimated at from 5 0 0 0 to 6 5 0 0 square mil e s I t is situate d in .

the great arid plain lying b e tween the D arling Be gan and

, ,

L achlan rivers The c ount ry r oc k is Silu r ian slate whi ch is


.
-
,

trave rs e d by s su re veins N one of the mines have been work e d


-
.

continuously .

C RY O L I T E .

This is a u oride of sodium and aluminium containing ,

about 5 1 per cent of sodium u oride when pur e . Practically .

the whole of the world s supply is obtained from the D anish

cryolite mines at I vigtut on th e west c oast of G reenland


-
, .

Th e white cryolite o cc urs in great snow white masses which -


,

ar e par t ially transparent I t constitutes a large bed or mass in.

a granitic dyke which traverses a gray gneiss .

Associa te d with the cryolite are quartz siderite gal e na pyrit e s , , , ,

chalcopyrite wolframite ; also u orite mispickel and cassiterite


, , ,
.

The ore is c on n e d to the granite but there is no clear lin e of ,

demarcation between i t and the surrounding roc k into which it


pas ses The mineral is mined by ope n cuts about 2 0 0 feet wide
.

and 10 0 feet or more d e e p 1


.

T h e G reenland mines pr oduce nearly 8 0 0 0 tons of c ryolit e a


year valued at about 3 per ton at the mines Th e bulk of t h e
, .

output is exported to the U nited States for the manufactur e of


alumini u m for making sodium and aluminium sal ts and for the
, ,

manufacture of s odium u oride which is used to prev e nt incrusta ,

t i ons forming in steam boilers -


.

Cryolite is also used to a limited e xtent in the man ufacture of


an opalescent glass which resembles F r e nch porc e lain .

D IA M O ND .

Until the dis c overy of the mines at J a g e rs fon t e in and Kimberl ey ,

in the years 18 70 and 18 7 1 th e re is no record that diamonds h a d ,

been found exc e pt in alluvial deposits or conglomerates .

1
M in er a l R e sou rces of U n ited S ta tes 1 90 1 Wash i n gt on p 883 , , , . .
15 4 MININ G GEOLOGY .

blue or dark green colour in pla c es resembling some va r ieties of


-
,

serpentine .

F our fth s of the material forming the blue gr o und is a dark


-

green dense serp e n t in e which c ontains glistening plates of brown ,

mica small dark red garn ets ( mostly pyrope ) larg e dark green
,
-
,
-

crystals and grains of olivine b e sides enstatite smaragdit e , , ,

ch rome diopside ch romite magnetite and ilmenite Small frag


-
, , ,
.

ments of al t ered black shale are often so abundant as to giv e t he


rock a b r ec c iated appearance .

FI G . 67 .
S e c tion o f Ki mberley D iamond Pipe .

a, Y ll w e o gro und . a ct , B lue gro u nd . 5, Ba l t heet


sa s . a, S h a le s . d , M ela
ph y re . f Q artzite
,
u .
g, S late s .

The blu e g round is g reasy to the touch When e xposed to .

the weather for a time it soon disintegrates and is then eas i ly ,

crush e d th e diamonds being afterwards extracted by washing and


,

hand pick i ng .

Th e late Prof e ssor H G L e wis described the blue ground as a


1
. .

porphyritic vol canic peridotite of basaltic stru c ture for which he



proposed the name Kimberlit e .

I t has be e n not e d by several write rs that while the c o mposition


of th e m aterial llin g the pip e s appears to be th e same in all e ach ,

mine has its own parti c ular kind of diamond which is so distinctive
1
Pro fess or H 0 L ewi s T h e Matri x o f th e D iam ond Manch ester
. .
,

,

M eeti ng B riti sh A ss oc iation A u g a nd S ept 1 8 87


, , . . .
oa a s A N D MIN ERAL S C O N S I D ER ED E C O N O MI C A LLY . 155

tha t an exper t buyer can usually say from which mine any
pa rticular s tone is derived .

A ce r tain propo rtion of the diamonds are broken crysta ls and ,

s e ldom or p e rhaps n e ver hav e th e corr e sponding p i ec e s b ee n


, ,

M any of the diamonds ar e in a state of str e ss and som e y t o ,

pieces or splinte r wh e n re moved from t h ei r ma t rix and wh e n


being cut .

Professor Bonney b e li e v e s that the d i amond is a primary


1

cons t itu e nt of t h e i gn e ous rock as much as th e garn et m i ca and , ,

oth e r minerals with which it is assoc iated He believ e s tha t th e .

diamond was forme d nei t her by th e a ct i on of molte n rock on


carbonaceous ma t ter nor by th e action of ste am or ho t wa ter in
a subsequent solfata ric stage of t he vol ca no but w as se g re g ra te d ,

by the usual proc ess e s of di ff erentiation in so me d e eps e ated ,

magma which was afterwa rds forced up from b e low into the
s
p 1 .

Williams agrees with Profess or Bonney that the


F
blue gr ound must b e d e signated a breccia w hi ch h as been
forc ed up from b e low by som e igneous ag e ncy poss ibly in th e ,

nature of a mud volcano Among the fac t s which led h i m to .

thi s belief h e mentions the fr e quent oc c u rrenc e of b r oken diamonds


e mb e dded in th e hard Kimb e rlite as well as pebbl e s and boulders ,

with po lished surfaces as if wat e r wo rn -


.

Professor L ewis advan ce d the theory that t he diam on ds were


formed from hydrocarbons de rived from t he fra g ments of
carbon a ceous shale enclos ed in the blue gr ound which he ,

r e garded as a true lava This view is contested by M r .

Williams who sta tes that all the pipes co nta ining Kimberlite
,

do no t conta in diamonds while diamonds exist in som e mines , ,

such as t hos e in the Pr e toria district wher e no carbonac eous ,

shal e s are to be foun d .

P ar e nt R o c k o f D ia m o n d M r Williams while agreeing .


,

with Profess or Bonney that th e diamonds ar e a primary con


s t it u e n t
of some deep seated ign eo us r ock d e ni e s that e clog i te ,

i s the parent roc k of t he g em s at Kimberley .

Profe ssor Bonney in 1 8 99 r e ported the discove ry of diamonds


3
, ,

in sp e c i mens of a coa rsely crysta ll ine garnetiferous roc k rela t ed t o ,

eclogite obta ined from the N e wla n ds min es situated about 4 0


, ,

miles fr om Kimb e rley Commenting on th i s discove ry h e


.
,

1
Pro fe or ss T . G . B onney ,
P r oceed in gs f
o th e R oy a l S ociety , v ol . lxv .

p .

3
G ardn er
Will iam T h G ene i o f th D iamond T
F . s,

e s s e ,
ra n s . A m I. ns t.
M E P p et S ept 190 4
,
am h l , . .

Pro fe or Bonney P r ed i g f th R y l S oci ty vol l x v


3
ss ,
oce n s o e o a e ,
. .
p 2 2 5 , 1 8 99
. .
15 6 MININ G GEOLOGY .

c on c lu de d
th a t e clogite was the pa re nt rock of
dia m ond in -
th e
S ou th Africa a view which has generally been acc e pt e d by
,

E nglish geologists since that date .

The s tatem e nt that eclogit e was th e or i ginal ma t rix of the


diamond caused M r Williams for many y e ars G e n e ra l M a n a g e r of , .

th e Kimb e rley min e s to carefully exam i n e th e eclogit e wh i ch


,

occurs in tons in all the pip e s w h e re i t is tr e at e d as waste rock , .

T w e nty tons of this rock wer e coll e ct e d and tested by crush i ng


and j igging in a test plant but not a single diamond was found -
,

in th e material M r Williams further states that h e had also


.

examined hundr e ds of pi e ces of e clogit e but nev e r found a ,

diamond nor had he ever h e ard of a diamo n d having been


,

found in this rock during all th e y e ars the min e s had been
worked .

The occurren c e of diamonds in the eclogi t e from N e wla n ds M ine


must be regarded as sporadic and not general That a peridoti t e .

or some ultra basi c igneous rock was the parent


-
rock of S outh
African diamonds may be inferred from the laws of magmatic
parage n esis .

G e n e s is o f D ia m o nd Assuming the diamond to be a primary .

constituent of an igneous ro c k the original condition of the ,

carbon is still a matter for conj e c tur e D id t he gem crys t allise .

from carbonaceous matter from a hydrocarbon carbon dioxide , , ,

or a carbide ? Oi the source of the carbon nothing de n ite is


known or of the proc e sses which prevented its oxidation along
,

w i th the iron with which it is always associated I t is important .

to remember that th e diamond bea ring pip e s in the Transvaal -

penetrate carbona c eous shales .

Williams mentions that large diamonds have been found en clos


ing small ones while twins a re not rar e from which it may be
, ,

inf e rred that th e formatio n or growth of the diamond follow e d


the ord i nary laws of c rystallisation in a magmatic solution of rock
mat e rial .

M oissan in his diamondmaking experiments fused 1ron I l Ch in


, ,

carbon and allowed it to cool in such a way tha t the separation


,

of the e xcess of carbon took place under pressure I n t his way .

micros c opic diamonds were formed M ic ros c oP ic diamonds hav e .

been found in ordinary cast iron 5 hen c e it is inferr e d that -

abno rmal pressure is not ne c essary to ensure success in the


exp e rim e nt .

The exp e riments of D r F riedlander have a close r bearing upon


the natural formation of d i amonds Fr ie dla n de r l fused a small .

pie c e of olivine a c e ntimetre in diamet e r by m e ans of a gas blow


, ,

1
E F He n e ag e
. . T h e P h en omen a o f th e D i a m o n di fero us D epo s its in S ou th
,

A fri ca T r a ns I n st M in a nd M et v ol xii p 1 2 5
, . . . . . . .
15 8 MININ G GEOLOGY .

ravines to the c onglomerate beds which provided the material


c ontained in them The conglomerates are c h ic y composed of a
.

micaceous sandstone which is manifestly not the original matrix


of the diamonds The gems wer e pro bably d e rived from some
.

rock surface subj e c ted to denudation a t the time the sandston e


-

was being formed .

The greatest diamonds of whi c h there is any re c ord prior to


1 90 5 are the Koh i nor 7 93 c arats the G reat M ogu l 7 8 7 5 c arats
-
, , , ,

and the Regent 4 10 carats all found in the great mines of G an i


, ,

Cou l ou r and G ani P a r te a l in I ndia -


A ston e of over 4 0 0 carats
, .

was found at Kimberley in 18 8 4 and one of 97 2 carats named , ,



the E xcelsior at Jagersfontein The great Cullinan diamond

,
.

found e arly in 1 90 5 in the Prem i er M ine 3 1 miles from Pretoria , ,

is r e ported to weigh carats its size being 2 5 inches by 2 ,

inch e s by 4 inches Th i s is th e larges t stone i n the world I t


. .

is said to b e p e rfe c t l n c olour and free from a ws .


The great bulk of t h e world s supply of diamonds at present
comes from the Kimberley m i nes wh i ch in 1903 are reported to ,

have produced stones to the value of nearly four millions sterli n g .

FI RE C L A Y .

This material occurs in s tra ti e d laye rs or beds generally in


associat i on with seams of coal As a rule it lies u n d e 1 the coal .
,

and is the soil on which the c oal vegetation grew .

F ire clays are found in all c oal bearing regions but all coal seams -
,
-

are not u n derlain by material suitable for use as a r e clay G ood .

r eclay s should contain from 5 2 to 62 per cent of silica 2 2 to 3 2 .


,

per cent of alumina and 10 to 14 p e r cent of wate r The presenc e


.
, . .

of 1 per cent of lime magnesia potash or soda renders a clay


.
, , ,

too fusibl e to be u seful for r e c lay pu rposes I ron oxides ar e .

also inj urious and when over 3 per cent of the protoxide is
, .

present the clay should be dis c arded S tou rbridge re c lay con .

tains about 2 per cent .


China clay or kaolin is found in veins and irre g ular deposits in
places where granite has b een altered probably by the emanation
of steam and gases from c racks and ssu r e s .

I nvestigation has shown that the kaolinisation of granite a n d


other highly acidic rocks is not the result of mere atmospheric
weathering That decomposition of th e f e lspa rs in the zon e of
.

katamorphism does take pla c e is well known but the deep seated ,
-

kaolinisation which h as been noted in Corn wall D evon N ew , ,

S outh Wales Qu e ensland and N ew Zealand must be ascrib e d to


, ,

fumaroli c age n cies .


O RES AN D MIN ERAL S C O N S I D ERED E C O N O M I C A LLY . 1 59

FLU O R I T E .

This mineral ofte n called ,


u ors p a r is generally found i n
,

veins in limestone gneiss sandstones and c lay sla t e I t also


, , ,
-
.

occur s as the gangue of meta lli c ores especially of lead , .

F luorite is c hie y used as a u x for iron -ores A small quan tity .

is employed in the ma n u fa c tu 1 e of opalescen t glass and for th e ,

produ c tion of h y d1 o u or ic ac i d .

The world s output amoun t s to over



tons a y e ar of ,

wh i ch th e Un i ted Sta tes produces about one t h i rd and Pru ssia -

abou t on e quart er Th e value varies from 1 68 t o 1 2 s p e r ton


-
. .
, . .

G O LD .

This m e tal is found in v e ins in nearly all kinds of rock wi thou t ,

r e ga rd to ag e compos i tion or si t ua ti on The most produ c t iv e


, , .

v ei ns ar e thos e t rave rsing Pal aeozoic s e dimentar i es anc ie n t ,

granites and older Tertiary e ruptives especially thos e of a s e m i


, ,

bas i c type .

Th e d e nudation of gold b e aring rocks has libe rated large -

quantiti e s of gold which ha ve become more or less conc e n tra t ed


,

in alluv i al gravels or place rs These plac e rs ar e foun d of all ages


.
,

exten ding from M iddl e Te rtiary to recent t imes .

Th e gold found in veins traversing rocks of Pal aeozoic or older


Secondary age i s g e n e rally of high valu e wh i le tha t derived from ,

veins in andes ite and o t her old e r Tertiary e ruptives is commonly


of low valu e being largely alloyed with s i lv e r
, .

The gold of Aus tral i a mainly or en t irely der i ved from roc ks of
,

Pal ae ozo i c ag e is of h i gh value 5 as also is tha t of t h e Transv aa l


, .

The gold found in t he Pal aeozo i c mica schis t s and sla te s in t he -

South I sland of Ne w Zealand i s al mos t pur e 5 while tha t deriv e d


from the Te rtiary andesi t es in Aucklan d i s of low value being ,

alloyed wi th on e third in w e ight of silv e r


-
.

Th e same f eature characterises t he gold produc ed in t he


N or t he rn H e mispher e Russian gold is of high value wh i le that
.
,

derived from the andesi tes of Transylvania is of low valu e .

Th e vein and pla c er gold of Cal i fornia is commonly v e ry pure 5


but that of Ne vada and Colorado mos tly deri v e d from veins ,

trav e rs i ng later e r uptives is of low grad e being gen e rally alloyed


, ,

wi t h a larg e propor ti on of silver .

This p e cul i ar phenomenon is too general to b e accidental I t i s .

a happ e n i ng of wh i ch no adequat e e xplanation can at presen t b e


off e r e d
.

A cons i derabl e quantity of gold i s d e rived from s i lver copp e r , ,


16 0 MININ G GEOLOGY .

and lead ores 5 and a smaller amo u nt from ores of antimony ,

ars e nic manganes e a n d tungsten


, , .

The value of the world s production of gold for 1 90 4 was

e stimated at 7
The gold produced by t he v e gr eat producing r egions i n 1904

and 190 5 according to M r F Hobart wa s as follows


, .
,

1 90 4 .

Transvaal ,

U n it e d Stat e s ,

Australasia ,

Russia ,

Can ada ,

Th e most productive g old e ld centres in the globe are the Rand ,

Kalgoorli e and Cr i pple Cr e ek, .

I n the Commonwealth of Australia and United S tates which ,

are of continental d i m e ns i ons the gold bearing d e posits o cc ur ,


-

under many vary i ng geological condition s .


V I C T O R I A I n th i s State the gold is derived from thre e principal
.

sources namely from quartz veins from Tertiary deep leads and
,
-
, ,

from recent gravel drifts .

The de e p leads consist of placer gravels of M ioc en e and Pliocene


-

age The latt e r hav e prov e d th e most prod u ctive and are in many
.
,

places as for example near Ballara t protected by a thick sheet


, , , ,

of basalt the lava having o we d down the ancient valley and


,

cov e red up th e river gravels and sands .

The quartz veins occur mainly in Silurian slates The gold


-
.

bearing veins at Bend i go belong to the interesting class of or e


d e posits termed sa ddle reefs wh i ch occur in the crown of a n t i cl i nal
-
,

arches and send down tapering prolongations or legs r u nn i ng


, ,

more or l e ss parallel with b e dding plan es of the country rock - -


.

The distin c t i ve feature of the veins in t h e Ballarat G olde ld is


the presence of the famous indica tor beds These are thin beds .

of black carbonaceou s pyritic slate which occur in th e Silurian ,

slates and consequently constitute a dis t inct member or horizon


,

of the country rock T h e slates stand in a nearly v e rtical


-
.

position wh i le th e contained gold bearing ve i ns l i e nearly hori


,
-

z on ta l . Along the plane of intersect i on of the quartz veins and -

indic a tors ther e g e nerally occu rs ri c h ore .

W E ST ER N A U S T RA L I A Tu this State the c rystall i ne schists


.

which form the base m ent rocks of th e country are trav e rs ed by


wide belts of ancient eru ptives These eru pt i ves are dioritic or .

hornblendic in different pla c es and are often so much altere d th a t ,

the i r original c h aracter i s not always easily det e rm i ned : A t


Kalgoorli e th e hornblendic belts have been altered and s ilic ie d ,
1 62 MININ G GEOLOGY .

Silurian age 111 the L isle and G ol c onda G olde lds gold occurs
.

in veins intersecting a belt of granite .

N E W Z E ALAN D I n this colony gold is found in r e cent and


.

Tertiary place rs and in quartz v ei ns I n O tago the gold bearing


,
-
.
-

veins o cc ur in Silurian mi c a schist 5 in Reefton distr i ct in clay -


,

stones and sandstones of suppos e d Carboniferous age 5 and in t he


Hauraki Peninsula in altered andesites of M iddle T e rtiary age
,
.

Th e quartz conglomerates and cements at the bas e of th e


M iddl e Tertiary coal measures contain wat e r wo rn gold but - -
,

seldom in payabl e quantities It is noteworthy how e ver that .


, ,

many of the richest pla c ers in O tago and Westland are a rewash
of these ancient grav e ls .

U N I T ED S T AT E S The gold of th i s country is obtained from


.

veins or from plac e rs resul t ing from the e ros i on of gold bearing
,
-

country and th e concentrat i on of the valuabl e contents .

I n the State of Cal i for n i a the vein system known as th e ,


-


M other L ode is contain e d i n slates a n d al t ered ign e ous rocks
of Carbonif e rous and J u rass ic age I n Tuol u mne and Calav e ras .

counties and more particularly at N evada City and G rass V alley


,
1
,

the v ei ns o c cur in a n d near intrusiv e masses of granod i orite Th e .

placers along t his gold belt are among the richest in N or th


America Th e age of this remarkabl e stretch of gold bearing
.
-

veins i s believed to be Cretaceous The contained gold is of .

high quality .

A second gold belt of great importance li e s in E astern Cali


f o r n ia w i thin the watersh e d of th e Colorado River
, 111 this b e l t .

the v e ins o c cur in andes i tes phonol i t e s and trachyte of probably , ,

Mi ddl e Tertiary age The gold is alloy e d wi th s i lver and assoc i


.
,

ated with silve r or e s pyri te s et c -


, , .

Th e larger part of t he gold produ c tion of California is obtained -

from the Cr e taceous b e lt .

The gold produced in the State of Colora do is mainly deriv e d


from ve i ns trav e rsing Archaean granit e or the overlying andesitic ,

tu fts and breccias wh i ch are typically develope d in the Crippl e


,

Creek district These i gneous rocks wh i ch cons i st of h e avy o ws


.
,

as well as fragm e ntary mat t er are beli e ved by American g eolo ,

g i sts to be of post M iocene age -


.

A cons i derabl e quantity of gold is also derived as a b y product -

from the s i lv e r lead or e s of L eadville and other m i ning centr e s


-
,

wh i ch occur in v e ins in alter e d sed i m e ntari e s and e ruptives of


M esozo i c age Colorado is th e larg e s t gol d produc i ng Stat e i n
.
-

Am e rica The placer d e posits are not of gr e a t extent


.
-
.

The bulk of the gold of M ontana is derived from l e ad silv e r -

1
Waldemar L i ndgren T h e G e ol ogical Featu res o f th e G old Produ ctio n
,

o f N orth A m e rl ca T r a ns A m I nst M in E n g v ol xxxiii p 81 7


.

, . . . . .
, . . .
,
oat s A N D MIN ERALS C O N S ID ERED E C O N O M IC A LLY . 1 63

v e ins in Arch aea n rocks or from v ei ns of c opper or e occurring in ,


-

intrusiv e gr an i t e s of suppos ed Uppe r Cretaceous or L ow e r T e rt i ary


age princ i pally d e v e lope d near Butte
,
.

I n th e Sta t e of N evada the basem e nt rocks are sedimenta ri e s ,

of Pal aeozoic a n d Me sozoic ag e i n t rude d by many dyk e s of por ,

h
p y y r and smothered
,
by T e r ti ary rhyoli tes andes i t e s and , ,

basal t s Th e Comstoc k L od e long cel e bra t ed for its dry gol d


.
,

silver ores is con tain ed in a nd e si te The silver l e ad ore s of


,
.
-

E ur e ka occur in lim e s tones near e rup t ives a n d carry on e t h i rd


1
,
-

of th e ir value i n gold Th e gold s i lv e r m i ne D e Lamar i n .


-
,

Sou th e rn Ne vada occurs in Pal aeozo i c quart z ite s ,


.

Th e gold bea ring deposi t s of Black H i lls in South D akota


-
, ,

b e long to two groups I n on e group t h e mos t i mportan t t her e .


, ,

ar e t he mas s i v e lod e s of t he Homestake d i strict wh i ch cons i s t of ,

a bel t of Arch aean sch i sts clo s e ly in te rs ected in gr e a t ar e as by ,

th i n s t rings a n d v e ins of quar t z carry i ng free gold a n d gold


b e aring pyr ite s Th i s d e pos i t locally known as T h e B e l t is 6 0 0 0
.
, ,

f eet long and 2 000 f eet w i de 3


The or e is very low g ra de a n d i s .
,

only rend e r e d p r o ta ble by t he magn it ud e of t h e O pera ti ons .

Th e gold ou tput of Br iti sh Columb i a i s d e r i ved from placers


and v ei ns inte rsecting old e r M esozo i c and Pal ae ozo i c rocks I n .

the Kootenay d i s t rict t h e gold occurs principa lly i n copper b e ar -

ing v ei ns wh i ch inters e ct rocks of L ower Me so z oic ag e


,
.

A LAS KA Th e gol d of th e c e l e brate d Treadw e ll Mi n e s on


.
,

D ouglas I s lan d in Alaska is d e ri v e d from a m i neral i s ed alb ite


, ,

d i or ite wh i ch accord i ng to Professor Beck e r has be e n al te r e d


, , ,

a n d s ilic i e d by solfataric or hydro t h e rmal ac ti on Th e d i ori te .

occurs as i n t rusiv e dykes in black s la te s th e b e d d ing planes of ,


-

wh i ch th e y clos e ly follow .

A C Spenc e r
.
3
s ta te s that th e or e b e ari ng dyk e s b e long t o a
.
-

seri e s of i n t rus i ons wh i ch app e ar i n te rrup te dly along th e s t r i ke


for a di s tanc e of about 3 m i l e s i n a zon e approximat e ly 30 0 0 fe et ,

w i de I n t h e gr e a te r par t of t h e i n t rude d area e xposur e s ar e


.

few a n d only small dykes outc rop on t h e s id e towa rd t h e centr e


,

of t he islan d 0 11 t h i s s i d e the zon e s e ems t o b e irr e gularly


.

l i mi t ed but nex t to t h e shore of G atineau chann e l th e bo rde r i s


,

de n e d by a h e avy b e d of gr ee ns t on e runn i ng parall e l w it h t h e


sla te s a n d th e in t rusiv e dyk e s and d i pp i ng w it h them toward ,

t h e adjac e n t chann e l Th e m i n e ral i sed dyk e s wh i ch cons tit u te .

t h e known minable ore occur j u s t b e nea t h this gr e ens tone wh i ch ,

1
L i n dgren ,
Fe a tu r es , e tc ,
G eol og ic a l 82 9 . .

3
F B . . ar nC pe te
r, T h e O re D s s f th e B lac

epo it o k Hi ll f Dakota s o ,

T r a ns A . m I nst 111311 E ng ,
. . l x v p 5 7 0 , 1 88 9
1 . vo . . ii . . .

3
A C . . p
S e n c r, G e
l y f th e T r a dw ll r D eo og o
s e e O e epo it A la ka P m ph s, s ,
a

l e t, A m I ns t .11 E , p 14 , 1 90 4

. . . . . .
1 64 MININ G GEOLOGY .

thus c onstitutes the hanging wall both of the intrusion zone and -

of the ore bodies M any of the dykes of a lb ite d iorite away from
-
.

the hanging wall have been greatly altered and impr e gnated with
-

pyrite but workable ore bodies have no t yet be e n discovered


,
-

i n them .

T h e r e lat i ons of th e mineralised diorite dykes to the asso c iated


country rock are shown in th e accompanying diagram
-
.

Fig 6 8
. . C ro e tio th ro gh A l k a T re dwell M i e
ss - s c n u as -
a n and N orth e rn
S i de o f D o gla I la du ( A fter S pe er )
s s n . nc .

The gold is g e nerally associated with pyri te s in str i ngs of


quartz a n d calci t e ramifying t hrough th e or e body 1 -
.

The ore i s e xtr e m e ly low g rad e b u t notwithsta nding this the , , ,

annual pr o ts are large and r e gular .

I n th e Yukon and N om e di stric ts th e gold is deriv e d from


placers .

T R AN SV AAL Pract i cally th e whol e of the gold of this Sta t e is


.
-

d e riv e d from b e ds of pyr i tic quar t zose conglom e rat e int e rbedd e d ,

w i th quartzi te s of L ow e r Pal aeozo i c ag e Th e ba n ke t re e fs as .


,

thes e gold b e ar i n g conglomerates are locally t e rm e d vary from a


-
,

f e w i nches to 4 fe e t in thickn e ss Th e y d i p south at angl e s w hi ch .

a r e st e eper at the outcrop than e lse where The most productiv e .

beds occur in a b e lt of quartzite about 1 1 5 feet thick .

T h e gold i s not contain e d in th e quartz p e bbl e s bu t in th e ,

siliceous cement i ng matrix Th e bankets a r e r e markabl e for th ei r .

great extent a n d un i form value over wide str e tch e s A deta i l e d .

description of th e chi e f ba n k e t beds is given in Chap t er I I -


.

R U SS I A Almost all th e gold produc e d in Russ i a is d e rive d


.
,

from plac e r d e posits on the western a n ks of th e Ural M oun t ains


-
.

Th e footh i lls on th e west e rn slop e s of the range cons i st of younger


Pal aeozoic sedim e ntar ie s intruded by mass e s of granite dior i t e , ,

and diabase G old bearing veins but not generally v e ry pro


.
-
,

1
R A. . Ki zie n T h e T r adw l l G r u
,
fMn e e o p o i e D o gla I land A l k
s, u s s ,
as a,

P p et
am h l , p 9, T r a n s A m I n st M in E ng , v ol
. . . . . . xxx i v p 334 1 894
. . .
, .
1 66 MI NIN G GEOLOGY .

At the presen t tim e F ranc e produces mor e than half th e


world s output Then follow the Unit e d Sta te s with an output

.
,

amounting to 30 p e r c e nt Canada with 8 p e r cent and G reat .


, .
,

Brita i n wi t h 7 p e r c e nt of th e total product i on 1


. .

Gypsum is used in th e manufacture of plaster of Paris of ,

plast e r for interior walls of hous e s and for agricultural purposes ,


.

The price vari e s according to locali ty from 6s to 1 2 s per ton


, , . . .

Th e ores of iron of commercial valu e are sid e rite limonite or , ,

brown h ae matite magn e t i te and h aematite or specular iron


, ,
.

The carbonat e or spathic ores commonly occur in beds forming


members of a s tra ti e d s e ri e s or in lay e rs of nodular masses more , ,

e specially in as sociation wi th coal measures Clay ironston e an - .


,

impure arg i llac e ous carbonat e of iron is common in most of th e ,

British c oa le lds and in thos e of P e nnsylvania and O hio in the


, ,

Uni te d S tates I n S cotland i t contains a large proportion of


.

carbonaceous matter and is known as bla ckba nd or e , .

The clos e association of coal and iron or e e nabl e d Britain for -

many years to occupy a dominant position in the manufactur e of


iron and ste e l .

Beds nodular layers a nd even veins of sp a thic iron occur in


, ,

many g e ological formations The v e ins are g e n e rally small and .

of littl e value Among th e most valuabl e deposits of spathos e


.

ore outsid e th e Carboni fe rous coal measures ar e those of Cleve


,
-

land wh i ch occur in th e Mi ddle L ias of E ngland


,
.

The red and brown h ae matite deposits of B i lb oa in Spain are


, ,

of gr e at ext e nt and furnish about 7 0 p e r cent of th e raw ore


, .

import e d into G rea t Britain for the manufacture of iron and st e el .

They occur in bed s in a limes ton e of Cretaceous ag e .

The brown h aematite deposits of the Unit e d Sta t es a r e of great


e xtent and valu e They e mbrac e all the vari e ties of hydrat e d
.

s e squioxid e of iron recognis e d as limoni t e g o thit e turgite bog


' '

, , ,

or e s e tc T h e principal produc e rs ar e the Stat e s of V irginia


,
.
,

W e st V irgin i a Alabam a Colorado and Pennsylvania


, , , .

The H u ron i an and L aurentian rocks of N orth Am e rica c ontain


vast d e posits of magnetite and red h ae ma t ite which occur as hug e ,

contact deposits and as r e gional metamorphic masses in te rs t ra tie d


-

with th e crystalline rocks with which they are associated .

The most valuable depos i ts of magn e t i c or e occur in L aurentian


rocks in the S tates of Pennsyl vania N ew J e rse y N ew Y ork and , , ,

M ichigan 3
.

1
T h e M in er a l R esou r ces of th e U n i ted S ta tes Wash i n gto n 1 90 1 , ,
.

3
T h e M in e ra l R sou r ces of th e U n ited S ta tes 1 90 3 Was h i n gto n
e 44 , , , .
0 112 s A N D MIN ERALS C O N S I D ERED E C O N O M IC A LLY . 1 67

Red h aemat i t e const i tu te s 8 3 per cen t of t he annual output of .

iron or e i n t h e Uni te d S tates a n d con t inues to b e suppl i ed by t h e


-
,

L ak e Sup e r i or r e g i on Th e principal sourc e s of supply ar e t he


.

Me sabi Ra ng e in Mi nnesota w it h an annual o u tp u t of


, ,

tons 5 th e M enomine e Rang e in th e S ta tes of M ich i gan and ,

Wis c onsin with an ou tput of


, to ns ; M arqu e t te Ra ng e ,

i n Mi chigan , to ns ; and G og e bic Rang e tons , .

The annual output of the M esabi Ra ng e ha s n e v e r be e n


reached by any oth e r iron or region in th e world the cl oses t -
,

compe titor being th e Bil b oa district i n Biscayan Spain which , ,

produces tons .

The ou tput of iron ore in G r e at Brita in amounts to nea rly


-

tons being ma in ly spa thic and haematite ores


,
.

The magne t i t e and sp e cular iron ore d e posi ts of S c andinavia -


,

more espe cially of Sw e d e n ar e of g r e at e x te nt Th e y occur , .

g e nerally in crys t alline rocks in som e districts as r e gional ,

m e ta morphic d e posits and in o t h e rs as c on ta c t d e po s its g e n eti cally


,

co n necte d with eruptiv e s The to tal annual o u tput is about .

tons the bulk of which i s e xpo r ted t o G ermany


, .

I ron o r e s of comm e rcial valu e are not very abundan t in


Australasia What h as b e en d e scribe d as t h e mos t importa nt is
.

tha t at th e I ron Knob and I ron M onarch 4 1 m i l e s W S VV of ,


. . .

Port Augus ta i n Sou t h Australia which has been es ti ma t ed to


, ,

conta i n tons of h i gh grad e h aema tit e and mangan i c i ron - 1


.

111 N ew Z e alan d a large d e pos i t of l i mon ite oc cu rs a t Pa rapara 5 and


,

e normous quan t it ie s of ti ta nic iro n sa n d ar e d i s tributed along th e


s hor e s of Taranaki and Patea .

I ron or e s con ta i ning l e ss than 4 0 per cent of the metal ar e


-
.

rarely smelt e d and only t hos e conta i ning over 50 p e r c e nt ar e


,
.

consid e r e d rich A rich commercial sampl e of r e d h ae ma t i te


.

should con tain from 60 to 6 5 pe r c e nt of t h e m e tal . .

A d e posi t of i ron to b e com e of any marke t valu e mu s t b e of


gr e a t e xt e nt mus t con tain rich or e be fr ee from s i l i ca sulphur
, , , ,

and phosphorus e as i ly smelted s i tuated in th e proxim ity of coal


, ,

and limeston e or so acc e ss i bl e to d ee p wat e r t ha t i t could b e


,

transpo rt e d to t h e sm e l t ers a t a min imum cost for handl i ng and ,

w i t hin e asy reach of t h e grea t mark e ts of t h e world .

Sil i ca i s t h e most d e l e t e rious matt e r found i n iron ores and -


,

should not e xce e d 1 0 per c e n t Sulphideor e s ar e of no com .

m e r c ia l valu e for t he produc t ion of i ron as the whole of t he ,

sulphur can only be r e moved by a dead oxi di sing roas t wh i ch is ,

a cos tly op e ration I ron pyri t es howev e r i s m i n e d for the manu


.
-
, ,

facture of sulph u ric acid D e posits of rich h aema ti te are some


.

1
H Y L B ro w n
. . . N ote s on th e Iro n a n d P ho s ph ate D epo s its o f S o u th
,

A u stralia S u pp le me nta ry M in i ng R ecords 1 90 5 p 6 A dela i de


, , , . . .
1 68 MININ G GEOLOGY .

times rendered val u eless by the presence of a percentage of


sulphid e or e -
.

Arsenical pyrites is generally of 11 0 value as a source of arsenic ,

e xc e p t it conta i ns gold or tin .

The pr e sence of sulphur c opper or arseni c in iron or e s should , ,


-

i n no case exc e ed per cent The cok e availabl e for smelting .

must not conta i n sulphur exce e ding 1 per cent .

I ron ores for the manufacture of ac i d steel must be practically


-

fr e e from sulphur or phosphorus O n th e other hand or e s r i ch .


,

i n phosphor u s may be us e d for th e manufactur e of basic steel .

I n normal blastfurnac e work n e arly the whole of t he phospho rus


presen t in the or e goes into the p ig .

F or steel making purposes the relative value of iron ores as -


,

regards their phosphorus contents depends on the process i n view ~

, .

F or th e Bess e mer acid process or e s r is e in val u e i n proportion as ,

th e phosphorus 18 low the maximum b e ing about 0 0 3 p e r cent


,
.

F or t h e Bessemer basic proc e ss the valuation is the reverse .

A n average sample of pig for the basic process contains


P er c e t
n .

Silicon ,

Sulphur ,
0 0 5 0 1 5
M anganes e ,
0 35 2 0 0
Phosphorus 30 0
,

Ore s containing a phosphorus p e rc e ntage between th e abov e -

limits ar e suitabl e for foundry work in wh i ch however an e xcess


-
, , ,

of phosphorus is very obj e ctionabl e .

L EA D .

The most valuable and abundant ores of lead are gal e na and
c e russite which ar e generally found in veins in limestones
, ,

calcareous slat e s and sandstones and occasionally in gneiss


, , ,

mica sch i st and andesit e Cer u ssit e in only found in th e shallow


-
, .

parts of l e ad min e s G al e na usually contains a small proportion


-
.

of silver varying from 2 o z to 3 oz to hundr eds of ounces p e r


, . .

t on and i s commonly as sociated with blende and pyrit e


, .

Th e world s produc t ion of l e ad amounts to about


short tons of which the Unit e d S tat e s dom e stic ou tput is e qual
,

to 2 6 per c e nt of t he whole The other chi e f producers of l e ad


. .

are Spa i n G ermany M exico a n d N e w S outh Wal e s


, ,
1
, .

The Broken H i ll Proprie t ary Company ( L imited ) in Ne w ,

S outh Wales is th e mos t productive lead mine in the world


,
'
.

L ead ores ar e purchased by smelt e rs on the r e assay


-
.

1
T h e M ine ra l I n du stt y v ol x iii 1 90 4 , .
,
.
1 70 MININ G GEOLOGY .

M I CA .

M ica is a cons t ituent of many rocks but only possesses a ,

commercial value wh e n it occurs in blocks or mass e s that are


capable of b e ing spl i t into sheets a square inch or mor e in size .

Th e valuable d e posits ar e not abundan t and occur generally in ,

p e gmatitic veins in grani te and in micaceous gn e iss in hornbl e nd e ,

and mica schist Th e veins vary from a f e w inches to s e v e ral


-
.

hundred feet thick .

These pegmatite veins or dykes as some writers suppose them , ,

to b e c onsist of the thre e ess e ntial min e rals quartz felspar and
, , ,

mica in varying proportions They commonly r e semble a coars e


.

granit e and in general the best mica is found in thos e veins in


,

which th e constituent min e rals hav e crystallised in larg e masses .

Wh e re the f e lspar and qua rt z are in small mass e s the mica is ,

usually of little valu e Th e Canadian mica is found in apa t it e


. .

Valuable mica occurs in th e vein in rough crystals call e d blocks ,

or books sometimes e v e nly distribut e d t hroughout th e mass a t


, ,

oth e r times near the contact with th e country rock -


.

M ica when found on the surfac e is soft and cracked Clear e r .


and better coloured mineral is found low e r down in the solid 5 a n d
th e harder and more uniform the rock formation th e bett e r is th e -
,

mica in colour and substance I n other words th e quality .


,

improves with the depth .

V eins under 2 fe e t in width seldom contain mica of commercial


value exc e pt as scrap mica
,
-
.

As a g e n e ral rul e not more than 10 per cent of the mica min e d .

is c apable of being c u t into plat e s the balanc e b e ing waste or ,

scrap mica 111 some m l n e s in the Un i t e d S t ates the yield of


-
.

sheet mica is l e ss than 3 p e r cent


- 1
.

I ndia and Canada ar e th e chi e f sources of the mica us e d in


E urope and the United States The latter country contains mica .

d e posits in many places but f e w ar e of co m mercial value a n d at


, ,

pr e sent the supply for dom e stic us e is ma i nly d e riv e d from I ndia .

111 th e mica mines of B e ngal in I nd i a t he b e st m i ca is found in


-
,

ro ck Th e gr e at e st demand ther e is for sh ee ts of the ruby


.

colour e d var ie ty from 3 square inches upwards , .

Sheet m i ca is larg e ly used for furnac e and stov e windows and


doors lamp protectors and insulators for electrical mach i n e ry
,
-
,
.

F or furnac e and stove doors and windows t he mater i al must b e


clear and fr ee from spots Th e cho i cest is in blocks of win e .

colour whit e mica b e ing pref e rr e d next Biotite or black m i ca is


, .

of lit tl e value T h e sta ndard sizes for the purposes stat e d abov e
.

range from 15 in by 2 in up to 8 in by 10 in S mall e r sizes


. .

. .

1
M in e r a l R e ou r ces of th e U n ited S ta tes p 8 7 4
s Was h i ngton 190 1 , . .
,
.
O R ES A N D MIN ERAL S C O N S I D ER ED E C O N O MI C ALLY . 17 1

seldom pay for m i ning and pr e paration La rg e s i z e and n e n e ss .

of gra i n ar e essential cha r ac t ers .

The bulk of th e mi c a plac e d on the mark e t is us e d for e l e ctr i ca l


purp os es p rincipa lly in t h e construct i on of dynamos alterna tors


, , ,

transformers e tc F or thes e us e s th e sheets must be e x ib l e fr ee


, .
,

from cracks capabl e of withstand i ng high temperat u res and must


, ,

b e non conducting a low percen tage of iron be i ng an essential for


-
,

t h e la t ter Colour is of l i ttl e mom e nt but pe rfec t cl e avag e is of


.
,

th e high e st impo rta nce as e l e ctrical m ica must be of un i form
,

thickn e ss and i s oft e n gauged to th e t housand th pa rt of an inch


, .

Th e following co mmunica ti on r e c e ived by the Ag e n t G e n e ral ,


-
,

in L ondon for S o u t h Australia from M essrs N athan


, Co of ,
.
,

L on don gives so me us e ful pa rticula rs as to t he pr i c e and mark e t


,
1
co ndition of mica

A l l th e sizes which the native crysta l will yield ar e at pr e sent
readily sal ea bl e by auction at p r ices ranging from 3d p e r po und .

for 2 in by 3 i11 to 78 6d per pound for 8 in by 1 2 in Thick


. .
, . . . .

n e ss must not exc e ed 1 in Anyth i ng from 7 3 ih to g in is


1
. . . .

sa l ea bl e All qual iti e s are saleabl e bu t i t is obviously i mposs i bl e


.
,

to give an e s t ima te of probabl e pric e s as no two prop e rt ie s yi e l d ,

precisely s i milar mica and it would b e necessary to s ee a ca s e or


,

t wo of th e actual s t u ff b e fore any th i ng approaching a n a l


j udgm e n t co uld b e passed upon it .

O n e or two important points may be made Th e mica crystal s .


,

after being split may be trimmed with ord i nary hand s hea rs all
,
-
,

cracked edges b e ing r e moved D o not was te th e mater i al by .

aiming at regularity of shape but as far as possibl e w i t hout , , ,

such wast e r e m e mb e r that r e cta ngular plates are pr e ferred


, .

Th e chi e f thing to s e cure is soun d ar e a wi t hou t crack s for it is ,

obvious tha t even mic ro scopic cra cks would m i l itat e agains t a
mat e rial to be us e d as an elec t ric insulator .

Th e n e xt in impo rtance is to s e cur e a perfe c tly at surfac e on


split t ing th e mica i n t o sh eets Any lumps or un e v e nnes s b et w ee n
.

th e laminae ar e du e to hydration or of te n to m etall i c i ns e rt ion ,

a n d the latt e r shows i tself in spot s M ica w i th m e tallic ins e rtion s .

is us e d for a vari ety of purpo ses but i s us e l e ss for insulating ,


.

Summarising
Avoid marginal cracks .

( )6 S pl i t to a t hickn e ss of 1
15
in to 1 in
. .

0 ) Avoid uneven plat e s as far as poss i bl e


( .

( ) Cut in recta ngular plates as far as poss i bl e


d .

( ) Throw out broken plates alto ge t h e r t hey w i ll


e

a
p y fr e ight and charg e s .

1
T h e N e w Z ea la nd M in es Rec or d Feb ruary 1 90 5 p 2 99 , , . .
172 MININ G GEOLOGY .

F or some purpos e s small irregular pi e c es of mica otherwise ,

usel e ss are cemented together and built up into sh e e ts of any


, ,

desired size and thickness .

G round mica is used as a lubri cant and for decorative pu rpos e s .

The greatest care must b e exercised in the preparation of mica


for th e market 1
T h e sheet sho u ld be about 4 in thick and cut
. .
,

cleanly and sharply into r ectangular shapes if possible .

The plates should be tr i mmed so as to c u t away any crumpl e d


or a we d pieces and sorted ac c ording to their colour
, .

The pr i c e of mica va ries a cc o rding to its size and c olour I t .

rises rapidly with increase of size ; thus E nglish pri c e lists quote
sh e ets 2 in by 6 in at 2 8 6d per 1b and 3 in by 6 in at
. . . . .
,
. .

68 6d p e r 1b
. . .

FI G . 69 .
S ec tio n th ro ugh
Peg m tite Vei n ( A fter H K S ott a . . . c .
)
a, M et m o rp h i c h i t 5 b de o m po ed peg m tite with
a sc s , c s a
m i a book 5 q rtz
c s c, ua .

M O L Y B D E N UM .

The comm e rcial o res of this metal are molybde n ite the sulphide 5 ,

molybdit e t h e yellow oxid e 5 and to a small extent wulfenite the


, ,

molybdate of l e ad .

M olybdenite occurs in beds or diss e minated in scales through ,

out crystallin e rocks such as granite gneiss and granular lim e , ,

stone I t is produced in co m mercial quantit i es in California and


.

Canada I n th e Haliburton district in O ntario it o c curs in


.
, ,

quartz veins commonly associated with pyrites pyrrhotit e and


, , ,

chalcopyrite .

A t Wolfram Camp in the Hodgkinson G ol d e ld Queensla n d


, , ,

molybd e nit e has been found in payable quantities in c l e an whi t e


1
H Ki l b u rn S c ott
. 0 11 th e O c currenc e o f M i c a in B ra zi l a n d on its
,

Preparation for th e Market T r a ns I nst M in a nd M et vol xi 1 902 3



, . . . . .
,
-
.
1 74 MININ G GEOLOGY .

has been attended with great success during the past few years ,

and the production of nickel has be e n so large that the monopoly


so long enj oyed by the N ew Caledonia mines has been complet e ly
brok e n u p .

I n addition to nick e l the Sudbury ore contains copper about ,

2 8 p e r cent and cobalt about 0 8 per cent and a littl e


.
,
.
,

platinum about 1 o z in 10 00 lh of nickel matt e


,
. . .

I n the S udbury district there is no regular vein system The -


.

ore bodies occur separately or in detached groups


-
, .

The d e posits are commonly lenti c ular pinch i ng out in both ,

directions and conforming to the general strike of th e enclosing

Huronian schists The ore always occurs in and contains frag .


,

ments oi a basic and altered eruptive of the gabbro type relative


,

to norite .

Accord i ng to C W D ickson the ore bodies occ u r either We ll


1
. .
-

with i n this erup t ive or at its contact with th e oth e r pr e va i ling


rocks of the d i strict namely grani te or granitic gneiss quartzi t e , ,
-
, ,

or th e metamorphosed repres e ntative of a series of basi c sed i


m e n ta rie s 11 0 W termed gre e nstones by the Survey of Canada
,
.

S ec tio n
o f O D e po it at Copper Cli ( A fter J H Co l li ns
'
?
70 . re s . .
)
a, H uro i n h i t 5 b D iorite (n orite ) 5 Py riti
n a sc s s , c, c o re - bo dy .

Three main belts of these norites and associated micro pegma -

t it e s are n o w recognised des i gnat e d as the N or th e r n Mi d dle and , , ,

Southern belts respectively They are at present mapped as .


, ,

s e parate bu t gen e tically and mineralogically t hey are e ss e nt i ally


,

identical E conom i cally the Southern bel t i s the most important


. .

1 O . W D i c k s on
.
,

T h e Ore -
Depo s its o f S ud b ry O tario
u ,
n ,
T r a ns . A m .

I n s t. M E , v ol
. i p 3 , 1 90 4
. . xxx v . . .

2
, ,
o i
J H C ll n s , Qu a r t J o u r G eo . . . S oc L
. o nd
on , v ol xl i v
. .
p 8 34 , 1 88 8
. .
O RES AN D MIN ERAL S C O N S I DER ED E C O N O M IC A LLY . 175

Th e genesis of t he pyrrhotite of Sudbury is still a question of


doubt . Acco rding to som e write rs includ i ng V ogt it i s du e to , ,

t he d e v e lopm e nt of magma t ic differentiation in a c ooling roc k


magma .That many d e pos i ts of magnetite chromite and , ,

corundum hav e originated in th i s way is almos t c e rtain 5 bu t


tha t m etall i c sulphid e s can separate out as primary con sti t uents
of a rock magma is s t ill op e n to doub t
-
.

Phil i p Argall cons i d e rs th a t th e nick e l and copper were leached


1
.

out of t he nori t e i n which they w e re ori g i nally form ed and con


c e n t ra te d along zones of fra c t ure by a p roc e ss of replacement a view ,

supported by Profess or Be ck of F re i b e rg who mainta ins t hat th e


3
,

br e ccia ted nature of th e ore must have be e n due to depos i t i on


during or after the m e tamorph i sm
, ,
.

The most i mpo rtan t us e of nick e l is in t he manufacture of


nickel steel conta i ning about 3 5 per cent of n i ckel Cons i derable
-
,
. .

quan ti t ie s ar e used for pla t ing iron goods and i n the co i nage of ,

the Un i ted S ta tes and many E uropean co u n t ri e s .

O I L S HA L E
-
.

Th i s occurs in beds or laye rs as membe rs of a s tra tie d forma


tion It yi e lds m i n e ral oil by slow d i st i llat i on
. .

The orig i n of the hydro carbon a ceous ma t te r in these shal e s is -

s om e wha t obscure I n many cases it h as b e en shown by m i cro


.

scop i c observa ti on to be du e to accum ul a t ions of gela ti nous algae


wh i ch lived in s hallow fr e sh wa t er lak e s and lagoons -
.

Th e shal e de pos it s i n t he L othians of Sco tland ar e of grea t


-

e x t en t and of poor qual ity Th e B roxbur n shal e s yield from


,
3
.

2 4 to 30 gallon s of cru d e o i l and 4 2 lbs of ammon i um sulpha t e .

p e r ton wh i l e th e D r u ms h or e la n d shal e s yi e ld 2 0 gallons of


,

crude o i l and abou t 6 0 lbs of ammonium sulpha t e The in du s tr v . .

i s maintain ed by th e product i on of bye produc t s -


.

Th e Fe rmo carboniferous shales of N ew South Wal e s ar e of


-

high grad e but occur gen e rally i n thin seams Th ey are now
, .

n e arly e xhaus t ed .

Th e o i l shal e s of Ne w Zealand are of Mi ddle T e rtiary ag e


-
.

Th e y ar e i n pl a ces of great exten t but gene rally poor and low i n


, , ,

a m monia .

P E T R O L EUM .

Mi neral o i l is found i n geological formations of all ages but i n ,

commerc i al quan ti t i es occurs c h ie y in two horizons nam e ly ,

t h e Mi d dl e Pal aeo z o i c a n d low e r half of t he T e rt i ary .

P C l S 1S c De em ber 1 893
r oc . o . e . o .
,
c .

R B k L h 3
d E l g
. t it t
ec 1 90 1 ,
e re vo n en rz a e rs c
'

e n, .

T n I 3
t Mi E g v ol xx ii p 5 8 1 1 90 2
ra s . ns . n . u .
,
. . .
, .
17 6 MININ G GEOLOGY .

I n Ameri c a it is found mostly in rocks ranging from S ilurian


to Carbonif e rous and in E astern E urope and Asi a in ro c ks of the
,

E ocene and M iocene periods .

G enerally speaking petroleum is found beneath the crowns of


,

anticlinal folds saturating porous unc e mented sandstones


, .

The genesis of natural oil has not y e t been satisfactorily


e xplained The F rench school maintain that it is chemica l
.
,

r e sulting from the r e action of alkali metals at a h i gh temp e rature


0 11 steam and carbon dioxide Crude petroleum in many r e spects
.
,

the same as natural oil was prepared synthetically by Ber t helot in


,

th i s way Th e hydrogen of the wat e r and the carbon of the


.

carbon dioxi d e hav i ng been deprived of th e ir oxygen unite to form ,

an oily substanc e closely r e sembling rock oil -


.

Th e d e structive d i s t illation of shal e peat w ood and animal , , ,

matter prod u c e s an o i l having the same carbon and hydrog e n


compounds as the natural oil of Pennsylvania But 0 11 the oth e r .
,

han d oils have be e n fou n d in Canada Tennessee and elsewher e


, , ,

of a d i ffe rent compos i tion llin g cavities in a richly foss i liferous


,

rock The rock in wh i ch the oil is imprisoned is a thickly b e dd e d


.

lim e stone of Silurian age probably d e posited in a d e e p sea swarm


,

i ng with animal lif e I t is gene rally ass u med that the oil wh i ch
.
,

can apparently b e liberated only when the rock is broken is ,

indigenous to th e rock in wh i ch it occurs .

The porous o i l bearing sandston e s of Pennsylvania are under


-

lain com for m ab ly by a formation of shale more than 1 0 0 0 f ee t


t hick containing fossil animals and fossil seaweed in vast quantiti e s
, .

E xp e riments hav e shown that th i s fucoidal shal e wh e n subj e ct e d ,

to slow destructive dist i lla t ion in some cas e s yiel ds as much as,

5 0 gallons of crude o i l to the ton of rock This o i l in many .

resp e cts can hardly be distinguished from the natural crude o i l .

The commonly accepted theory is that petrol e um is a na t ural


d i st i llate from carbonaceous or a n i mal remains imprison e d in rocks .

The distillate would naturally rise into the ov e rly i ng strata wher e ,

it would b e come c ondensed 5 and where the rocks w e r e porous i t


would accumulate .

The heat required for the dist i llation may hav e b e en d erived
from igneous in t rus i ons plutonic or volcanic from t h e r e act i ons
, ,

of d e epseated metamorphism or from the heat due to pres ,

sure i n cases where th e s t rata have been involved i n d e ep crust


folds .

Mi n e ral oil i s produced i n vas t quantities in the Unite d States ,

particularly in the States of Pennsylvania Texas O hio Cal i fornia , , , ,

a n d I ndiana ; in the Baku region i n Southern Russ i a 5 G alicia in , ,

Austr i a ; Roumania Burmah Borneo Sumatra a n d J ava


, , , , .

The output of the Appala c h i a n oil e lds in Pennsylvania a n d -


1 78 MININ G GEOLOG Y .

The once famous beds of South Carolina ar e considered to be of


-

Post Pliocene ag e
- 1
.

Th e phosphate of lime formerly work e d a t Aruba and Sombrero ,

in t h e West I nd ie s was or i g i nally a coral l i m e s ton e conv e rte d


,

into a phosphat e by the p e rcol a t i on of water containing phosphoric


ac i d de rive d from t h e ov e rlying deposits of b i rd guano -
.

A valuabl e de pos it of rock phospha t e was d i s c over e d i n 1 90 1 a t -

Clar e n don i n t h e Province of O tago in N ew Z e alan d I t occurs


2
, ,
.

in ch e m i cally e ro ded pock e ts and hollows on th e upper surfac e of


a Mi oc e ne l i m e s tone as shown i n th e following d i agram ,

FI G . 71 .
S e ctio n o f Cl re don R o k ph o ph atea n c -
s .

A ,
L oo se ph os l i h a t ic s a n d 5 B ro k ph o p h te 5 C l i me to n e g nerally
s , c -
s a , s ,
e

gl au c oniti 5 D gla on iti c gr e


c ,
d uc e nsa n s.

The geological conditions wh i ch accompany and doubtl e ss


determ i n e th e e xist e nce of workabl e d e posi ts of phospha t e ar e th e
presenc e of a pho s pha te b e ar i ng format i on at th e surface lying in -
,

a favourabl e posi ti on for un de rground w eath e ring ov e r cons i der


able areas a n d subsequ e n t concentrat i on of phosphate by replac e
,

m e nt or s e condary e nrichmen t .

Th e phospha te d e pos it s in York e s P e n i nsula South Australia


, ,

occur in cav e s and s s u r e s i n a Cambr i an l i m e stone Th e y ar e .

r e por t e d to be of large e xt e n t high grad e and favourably s i tua te d , ,


3
for working .

To b e come of comm e rcial valu e a phosphate deposit should f u l l -

the follow i ng r e quir e ments

( )
1 B e of such magnitu de as to j ustify th e e rection of tramways .

and o t h e r surfac e plan t nec e ssary for d e velopmen t and -

winning of mineral .

Pe o e
1
nr s ,
U S G eol S u r v ey B u ll etin , N
. .

. o . 46, p . 6 0 , 1 8 98 .

J P rk f o k p o p te o O tago vol
3
. a , T he R c h s ha s -
,
T r a ns N . . Z . I ns t , .

xxxv p 391 . .
,
1 90 2 .

3
H Y . . L . Bro wn , N ote s on th e Iron a n d P h o s ph a te Depo sits o f S o uth
A u s tra l ia , S u pp l e m e n ta r y M ining Recor ds 1905 p 5 A del a i de
, , . . ,
0 112 s AN D MIN E RALS C O N S I D ERED E C O N O M I CA LLY . 179

( )
2 B of h i gh grad e av e ragin g not less t han 5 0 per cent of
e , .

t r i calcic phosphate befor e dr e ss i ng .

( )
3 I n a po s iti on easy of access to a ra i lway or s e aboard .

( 4 ) E asy to win t ha t i s in a pos i tion in wh i ch i t can b e ,

work e d wa terfr ee by op e n cuts a n d quarry i ng Th e .

ov e rburde n mus t also b e shallo w and e as i ly r e mov e d .

Wh e n it e xc ee ds 20 f eet th e cos t of s t r i pp i ng run s a wm

w it h th e p ro t .

I t is on ly in e xc e p ti onal cas e s t ha t i t pays t o m i ne phos pha t e by


underground work i n g s A t Ross F arm i n P e nn s ylvan i a dur i ng .
, ,

t h e y ear 18 99 2 000 long tons w e r e min e d from a s t ratum 30 feet


,

th i ck 4 000 f eet long a n d i ncl i n e d a t an angl e of 60 from t h e


, ,

hori zon ta l The stratum was mined to a dep t h of 30 0 fe et b e low


.

water l e v e l a n d averag e d abou t 5 6 p e r cen t of phospha te H e r e



,
. .

t h e ma t rix consis t ed of a y e llow marl e as i ly a n d cheaply brok e n , .

The produc e rs how e v e r d id no t comp ete in d i s ta n t mark e ts w it h


, ,

t h e h i gh e r grad e s of phospha te from Sout h Carol i na T e nn e ss ee , ,

a n d Flor i da but l ooked only for a r e mun e ra ti v e local mark et


1
,
.

P LA T I N UM .

Th i s valua ble m etal is g e n e rally found sparingly d i ssemina t ed


in olivi ne in ol i v i n e gabbro s e rp e n ti n e and o t h e r ul t ra bas i c rocks
,
-

, ,
-

i n Rus s ia G e rmany F ranc e and Ne w Z e aland I t i s foun d in


3
, , , .

gold plac e rs i n many part s of t h e world i n small quan tit ies .

It is commonly assoc i a ted w it h chromi te of i ron which also has ,

a pr e f e r e nc e for magn e s i an erup t ive rocks .

Pla t inum as sperryl ite t he ars e n i de of platinum occurs in t h e


, , ,

cupri fe rou s n i ck e l ores of Sudbury i n Cana da a n d i n th e cop pe r


-
, ,

or e s of Ramb le r Mi n e i n t h e M ed i c i n e Bow M oun ta i ns of Albany


,

Coun t y in t h e S ta te of Wyoming R e n e d m ethods of analy s i s


,
.

hav e shown t ha t th i s m etal i n m i nu te t rac e s e x is ts i n cupr i f e rous


sulph i d e or e s i n many pa rts of the worl d
.

Hunde shag e n records th e occurr e nc e of pla ti num in Suma t ra


m wollas ton ite wh i ch i s as soc i a te d with sch i st s gran ite a n d , ,

aug ite d i or ite He t hinks t ha t th e or e d e pos it was or i g i nally a


-
.
-

big l e ns of l i m e s to n e i mb e dded i n t h e sch i s t s s u bsequ e n t ly al te r e d ,

to garne t a n d wollasto n ite and min e r alised by ho t soluti ons carry ,

i ng copper g old and pla ti num


, ,
.

Th e worl d s suppl y of plat i num is ma i nly d e rived from placer


d e po s i ts in t h e Ural M oun ta i ns mos t ly s it ua t ed on t h e w e s te r n ,

1
2 13t A nnu a l R ep t U S G eol S u r ve y , p 4 94 , 1 8 99- 1 90 0
. . . . . .

3
J . F . Ke p m , B u ll U S G eol S u rvey , N o 1 93, p 7 2
. . . . . . .

3
L . S . H e u n d sh a ge
n , T T a n s I ns t M i n a n d 111d , .l . . . v o xiii. . 1 90 4 .
18 0 MININ G GEOLOGY .

slopes I n 1 90 4 the output of Russia amounted to


.
,
lb s .
,

equal to about 90 p e r c e nt of the world s produ c tion In .



.

S e p t ember of tha t year two lum ps of plat i num were found a t


K r e s to wos d wis c h e n s k on e weigh i ng 7 5 6 lb s the other ov e r 3 60
,
.
,

lbs. A small part of the domest i c r e quir e men t s of the Unit e d


States is obta i ned as a s e condary product from the gold plac e rs i n -

Trinity and Shasta Count ie s in Cal i fornia .

Som e of the gold plac e rs of Colombia Alaska S i beria Austral i a


-
, , , ,

a n d Ne w Zealand con ta i n plat i num but rarely in payable quant ity ,


.

Th e Fi e ld G oldfie ld i n N ew South Wal e s yi e ld e d in the y e ar


, , ,

1 90 2 3 7 5 o z of pla ti num valued at 7 5 0


, . 111 th e sam e year ,
.

Russ i a prod u c e d oz which repr e s e nt e d ov e r 90 p e r cent .


, .

of th e world s outpu t The balanc e i s mainly furn i shed by t h e



.

State of Colomb i a i n South America , .

QU I C K S I LVER .

The only valuable or e of this metal is cinnabar the sulphid e , ,

wh i ch occurs i n veins trave rsing slates and san dstones or d i s ,

seminated in al te red an desites I t is however found in rocks of .


, ,

all ag e s and all k i nds but shows a preference for sa ndstones and
, ,

i n mos t cas e s is found alon g lines of country t ha t have been


affe cted by volcanic disturban c es .

Some c i nnabar has b ee n d e pos i ted from hot solutions bro u gh t


up by volcan i c spr i ngs A t O ha e awa i Hot Springs in Ne w .
,

Zealand th e cinnabar d e pos i ts were formed in this manner as


,
-
,

probably w e r e thos e of Almaden .

The pr i nc i pal quicksilv e r prod u cing min e s at the pres e n t time -

ar e s i tua t e d at Almaden in Spain Ne w Almaden in Cal i fornia 5 , ,

I dria in t h e Provence of Carniola in Austria ; a n d Russ i a


, , .

Th e averag e yield of the Almaden or e s is from 7 to 10 per cent .


,

but or e s con t a i n i ng as little as 1 p e r c e nt hav e b ee n m i ned wi t h .

p r o t The. grade of th e Russian or e i s g e nerally u nder 1 p e r

cen t .

S I LV ER .

Among t he principal or e s of silv e r are ke r a rg yr it e or horn ,

s i lv e r embol i te and argen ti te t he subsulph i d e


, ,
L arg e mas s e s ,
.

of th e t wo form e r were found at the Brok e n H i ll m i nes in N ew ,

Sou t h Wal e s d i s s e mina t e d throughout kaolin clay


'

, .

M asses of na t ive silv e r have be e n foun d in S axony a n d Har t z

M ounta i ns but th e larg e s t masses we re d i scover e d i n Me x i co a n d


,

P e ru a n d i n th e L ak e S u p e r1or min e s assoc i ated with nativ e


, ,

copp e r .
182 MININ G G EOLOGY .

slat e s ar e of te n infe rior in durab i lity M arcasit e 1s obj ectionabl e .

in slat e as it oxidis e s readily Cubical pyrit e s do e s not oxidis e


,
.

r e adily and is ther e for e not so obj e ctionabl e


,
.

A goo d s la t e should b e capable of b e ing spl it into smooth thin


lamin ae parallel to the plan e s of slaty cl e avag e .

The s p e c ic gravity of slat e vari e s from 2 7 to 2 9 .

L arge quant i ties of slate are quarried in the Unit e d S tates ,

F rance and E ngland


,
.

S U LPH U R .

T he sulphur of comm e rc e is d e rived from native sulphur and


pyrit e s .

N ativ e sulphur is common in most volcanic region s mor e ,

e sp e cially around th e vents and s su r e s both activ e and e xtinct , .

Th e world s production of native sulphur in 1 90 4 amount e d t o


tons of which I taly produced over 93 per cent Th e


, .

balance is mined in Japan United States F ranc e Austria a n d , , , ,

G re e ce .

Th e price of crud e sulphur vari e s according to quality from

3 to 4 per ton The sulphur is principally used in the manu


.

facture of sulphuric acid .

The principal producers of pyrit e s for th e manufactur e of sul


h r ic ac i d ar e Spain F ranc e United S tates G er m any N or wa y
p u , , , , ,

I taly Canada and Russia


, ,
.

T ALC .

This min e ral in its b rou s and massive forms occurs in beds
and l e ns shaped masses in ta lcose and chloritic schists I t is
-
. .

often associated w ith granular limestone .

Th e massive form is gen e rally known as steatit e or soapston e .

Talc is used as ou r talc and as piec e s cut i nto various


-
,

Th e ou r is us e d as a base for r e p roo f paints for e l e ctric in ,

s u l a t or s for boiler and s t e a i n pipe coverings as a bas e for dyna


,
-
,

mi te in the manufactur e of wall pap e r for l e ather dr e ssing and


,
-
, ,

as a lubricant .

T h e harder vari e ties of soapstone are cut into h earthst on e s ,

l i nings for fur naces laboratory tabl e s ov e ns pencils and gas


, , , ,

t i ps Th e talc produced in th e United S tates is valued at abou t


.

3 5 s per ton
,
. .

T H O R I UM .

Th i s rare and valuable metal is obtain e d from the min e ral


monaz i te which is essentially an anhydrous phosph at e of th e
,

rare e arthy metals c e rium l a n t hanum and di dymium having the, , ,


O RES AN D MIN E RALS C O N S I D ERED E C O N O M ICA LLY . 18 3

formula (Ce L a D i) P O 4 A small but var i abl e propor t ion of thoria


.

T h O I S n e arly always pr e s e n t
( o .

M onaz i te i s d e scr i b e d by J H Pra t t as l i gh t


1
y e llo w hon e y . .
,

y e llow red d i s h brownish or y e llow i sh gre e n in colour w it h a


, , ,
-
,

r e s i nous to vi t r e ous lus t re It i s t ransluc e nt to sub t ran s luc e nt ; .

bri ttl e w it h concho idal fr ac t ur e and hardn e ss from 5 to 5 5 :


, ,

monocl i n i c and i n crystals up to 2 in long P e rfe c t crys tals ar e


, . .

generally small from g i n to T 3 i11 do wn wa rd to t hos e of m i c 1 o


,
. .

sc op i c s i ze Th e spe c ic gravity i s h i gh a n d rang e s from 4 6 4


.
,

to 5 3

It i s incompl etely in s oluble in hydrochloric ac i d bu t compl et ely ,

and readi ly i n sulphuric acid I f oxal i c acid is ad d ed to t h e v e ry .

dilu te lt e r e d s u lphuric acid solut i on or to t h e solu ti on ob ta i n e d ,

by fusing the min e ral wi th soda and i f t h e m a ss is t r e a te d wi t h ,

wa te r a n d the r e s i du e lte r e d a n d d i ssolv ed w it h hydrochlor i c


acid a pr e c i pi tate i s ob tain e d wh i ch upon igni t ion b e comes
, , , ,

brick re d due to t h e pres e nc e of c e rium ox i de


-
,
.

B e for e the blowp i p e the m i n e ral t ur ns gr e y bu t is infus i bl e , .

I f h eated with s ul phur i c acid it colours th e a m e blu i sh gr ee n -


,

due to ph osphor i c acid .

M onazite i s found i n granite gn ei ss i c rock s a n d m ica sc h is t in , ,


~

th e Mar iti me M ountain s of Braz i l i n S o u th M ounta i n reg i on of ,

N o rt h Carol i na a n d many oth e r plac e s but only in minu te


, ,

quant ity The monazi te of commerc e is d e r i v e d from sands or


.

place rs r e sul t ing from t h e de nuda ti on of th e m i n e ral b ea ri ng rock -


.

Th e Bra z i lian de pos i ts occur as b e ach sands 3


.

Tho r ium is c h ie y us e d in th e manufactur e of mantl e s for


inca nd e scen t gas ligh ts .

Th e value of monazite is about 4d per po u n d . .

The only ore of thi s m e tal of comm e rcial valu e is th e oxi de ,

cass i terite wh i ch occurs i n lodes b e d s a n d stockworks a n d i n


, , , ,

alluvia l dr i f ts .

Tin ore i s found i n grani te f e lspar porphyr y and oth e r a cid


-
,
-
,

e ruptives and in sed i m e n taries which hav e be e n in t rud e d by


,

gran ite et c ,
.

A t M ount B is c h o 3 one of th e gr e a t e s t tin m i n e s 0 11 t h e


,

glob e t he Pal aeozoic sla te s and sands t on e s ar e i n t rud ed by dyk e s


,

o ep H e P tt
1
J s h y d ra ,
M in er a l R es ou r ces of th e U n ite d S ta tes , p 11 63, .

W i gto
as h n n , 1 90 4 .

3
130 0 cit , p 95 1
. . . .

3 e
S y dn y Pote Fa v m s N s on t h e M u n
.
B isc h o fi T in M n ,
,
T r a ns o t '

i e .

. P p et
I ns t M i n a n d M e t am h l , p 16 , L n d n , 190 5
. . o o .
18 4 MININ G GEOLOGY .

of porphyritic f e lsite which c arries topaz both c rystallin e and


amorphous Th e t op a z isa tion was probably a pneumatolytic
.


proc e ss proceeding from de e p s e at e d granit e The f e lspar of th e .

ground mass is replac e d by topaz The analysis record e d by .

Baron Von G ro dde ck showed no alkali Th e rock cons i st e d .

practically of quartz topaz a n d tin Wolfram do e s not occur in


, ,
.

payabl e quant i ty in the topaz tin ore -


.

The common associa t es of tin ore are wolfram quartz mica and -
, , ,

tourmaline .

About 6 5 p e r cent of the world s supply is derived from th e tin


.

plac e rs in th e Straits S ettlements and D u tch E ast I ndies wh e r e ,

t h e tin bearing gravels cover hundr e ds of squar e m i les


-
.

The world s annual production is about



tons .

Tin containing 5 5 p e r cent of arsenic is usel e ss for commercial .

purposes and requir e s further purifying .

Tinore is bought by the smelt e rs from the results of the dry


assay and is subj ect to certain sch e dule d e d u ctions
, .

T UN G ST E N .

The principal ores of tungst e n are sche e lite th e tungstate of ,

lime 5 wolfram the t ungstat e of iron ; and 111 e g a b as ite th e


, ,

tungstat e of mangan e se .

Wolfram i s usually associated with tinston e S c h ee lite occurs .

in v ei ns in schis t s and sa ndston e s generally associat e d with ,

quartz Wh e n th e v e in stuff con ta i ns gold or silver as often


.
-
,

happ e ns th e sch e eli te can be produc e d very cheaply as a


,

b y product
-
.

The b e s t known deposit of m e g a b a s ite is that i n th e I ma


-

M inin g Company s prop e rty at Patt e rson Cr ee k in th e s tate of



,

I daho wher e i t occurs with wolfram in a ve i n varyi n g from


,

5 f e et t o 1 5 f e e t wid e and assay i ng from 5 p e r cent to 5 0 p e r c e n t


, . .

of tungstic aci d .

Th e princ i pal sourc e s of the world s tungsten are E ngland


,

Austria Hungary Saxony G ermany Ne w South Wale s and


-
, , , ,

Queenslan d .

The pric e vari e s wi th th e quality of the ore G e rman and .

E nglish buyers g i v e f rom 7s to 8s per unit . . .

I n the Un ite d States prices are somewhat higher the val u e of ,

sch ee li te conta i ning from 4 5 p e r cent to 5 5 p e r cent of tun gs ti c acid . .

b e ing about 8s per un it whil e ores conta ining from 5 5 p e r cent


.
, .

to 6 5 per c e nt of tungst i c aci d command 10 s p e r un it of scheel ite


. . .

The f e rro tungst e n ore wolfram is mainly prod uced in Cornwall


-

( E ngland ) Hungary
,
Ne w South Wal e s and , Queensland I t is ,
.

s ol d on th e tungs ti c acid basis Wolfram to be mark e tabl e mus t .


C H A P T ER V I I I .

M I N E - S A M P L I N G A N D O R E -VA L U A T I O N .

CO N T EN T S z S a m p l i n g Eq u ip m e n t S a m p l i n g I nterval s Rec ord o f S a m p le s


B rea ki ng t h e S a m ple S a m pl i ng Redu c tio n o f S am p le A s s ay o f
S a m ples C al c u la ti n g V al ue F ut ure P ro s pects S a m p l e V a l ues a n d
M i l l V a l ue s S a m p l i n g D u m p s a n d H e a p s
-
.

I N the maj ority of min e s sampling proc ee ds s i multaneously with


the mine d e v e lopment th e results being recorded 0 11 a ssa y p la ns
, ,

which are generally longitudinal or stop e plans Wh e r e the .

sampling during dev e lopment has been car e fully and s y s te m a ti


cally don e the averag e s should approximat e those obtained by th e
,

mi n e e xaminer .

S a m p ling E q u ip m e n t This include s n e w sample bags of


.

canvas or stout calico say 1 4 in long a n d 9 in wid e 5 a canvas


,
. .

she e t about 6 ft long and 5 f t wid e 5 a short handled 4 lb or


,
. .
-
.

5 lb hammer 5 a gad or two ; small linen tap e or foot ru l e ; a


.
-

numb e r of small metal tags or strips of soft wood each with a ,

distinc t iv e number or mark 5 and a stout canvas lock u p sack -

for th e safe custody of sampl e s .

S a m p l ing I nte rv a ls B e gin th e sampling of a l e v e l at t he


.

end of th e main cross cu t or at som e po i nt e asily located with


-

r e sp e ct t o a surv e y station .

Wh e n th e whole width of th e v e in or seam is expo se d 1n t he


drive it is customary to sampl e th e high e r or foo t wall portion
lying on th e back of th e lev e l as the lower po rt i on may b e par tly
,

und e rfoot and often covered wi th mud and wat e r


, .

D ivid e t h e lev e l into se c tions of 5 f t 10 f t or more according .


, .
, ,

to t h e e xt e nt of th e op e n ground and charact e r of or e M ark .

the divisions wi t h chalk or by blackening th e wall wi th a candl e


,

am e .

With r e spect to th e sampling intervals it is well to r e member ,

t hat a large number of small samples tak e n a t sho rt intervals are


often mor e reliable than a small n u mber of large sa mples taken at
wid e interval s .

Wh e n the ore is known to b e consist e nt in valu e and is ,

186
MIN E S A M P L IN G AN D O R E
- -
V A LU AT I O N . 1 87

exposed in long str e tche s th e sa m pl i ng intervals may be 2 0 f t , .

apar t ; but wh e n th e vei n i s som e wha t i rr e gular in w i dth a n d


valu e t h e 5 ft intervals will g i v e th e mos t tru s t worthy r e sults
. .

o
R e c rd O f S am p e s
l Car e fully me a sur e and r e cord t h e
.

wid t h of th e v e in in fe e t and inch e s at e ach i nterval .

A simpl e and a c curate m ethod of r e cording t h e sampling


intervals w i d t hs and sa mpl e numb e rs i s to d raw a diagram in
, ,

FI G . . o i g Reco rd o f Wi dth Value


72 S h w n d S m p l i ng Inte r l s, s, an a v a s.

e ld b ook repr e s e nting a longitudinal s e c t ion of t h e lev e l


-
Ou .

th i s d i agram which n e ed no t be drawn to scal e all t h e n e cessary


, ,

i nforma t ion can b e shown graph i cally Th i s m ethod h as also .

t h e a d van ta ge t hat the assay values can aft e rwa rds b e lle d in a t -

th e di ff ere n t intervals thus completing the r e co rd, .

<0 h b m m b h c} co cc
V V V 0 : v 00 0: 09 cc
V ' '

FI G . 73 L
. o git di
n u n al S ection o f B lo k between 15 0 c an d 30 0 feet Le ve ls .

The widths numb e rs and values ar e commonly r e corded on


, ,

m i n e assay plans in di ffer e nt coloured i nks accord i ng to th e


-

i n di v i dual fancy of the e ng i n ee r 5 but t his is not n e cessa ry in t h e


e xamin e r s e ld book which i s a p riva t e r e cord

-
, .

I n th e above g u re th e widths of ore ar e shown in inch e s und e r


188 MIN IN G GEOLOGY .

the l e vel and the valu e in dwts abov e th e level The sampling
,
. .

intervals ar e r e pr e sent e d by dots .

111 the M eyer and Charlton 1


M in e at J oh a n n e sb u rg th e , ,

values entered upon th e continuous s e ction are not th e assay


values bu t t he recovery valu e s whi c h the di ff e rent processes i n
,

use are est i mated to be capabl e of recovering .


B re a k ing t h e S a m p l e D ress the face down with a pick so ,
.

as to e xpos e a fr e s h surfac e and i f ne c essary cl e an it with , , ,

water .

With t h e hammer and gad br e ak a sample at each interval ,

allow i ng th e mat e rial to fall on to the canvas sheet or into a stiff ,

felt hat or narrow box held by an assistant .

Th e sample is taken from a groov e cut at r ig h t ang les t o the


plane of t h e dip 5 or in oth e r words a cr oss th e thickness from , ,

wall to wall as shown in g 7 2 ,


. .

I n cases wh e r e the width of th e v e in is l e ss than that of the


lev e l or stop e it is n e cessary to squar e t he or e on the back of the
,

level or stope in order that the true width of th e v e in from wall ,

to wall may be exposed for sampling


,
.

I n or e of fairly uniform hardness the width of the groove will


vary from 4 in t o 6 ii1 and from 3 in to l % in dee p T h e
. .
, . . .

sampl e will generally weigh from 2 lbs t o 1 0 lbs for every foot
'

. .

of vein or b e d .

Wh e n the v e in matt e r is arranged in distinct bands of c r u s ti


- ~

cat i on that is wi t h a ribbon structure it is advisabl e to sampl e -

e ach band s e parately to determine where the values li e .

W i de lodes shoul d also be sampl e d in widths of 2 ft or 3 ft as . .


,

sometimes th e valu e s are carried by the foot wall por t ion som e -
,

times by th e hanging wall or by the central portion I n s uch .

cas e s a singl e sampl e taken from wall to wall may convey quite
an e rron e ous impr e ssion as to th e comm e rcial valu e of th e lode .

Where a lev e l is driven on a wid e lode only a small portion of ,

th e or e is e xpos e d for examination I n such cas e s it is customary .

for th e manag e ment during th e progress of d e v e lopm e nt to cross


cut the lode at int e rvals of 2 0 ft or 5 0 ft according to th e . .
,

m et allif e rous character of the or e Th e se cross cuts w i ll a b rd .


-

th e examin e r an opportun ity of sampl i ng th e lode from wall to


wall in such manner as th e cas e may r e quire Where there ar e .

no cross cuts through the l od e from the level the ful l o r at any
-

, , ,

rat e the payable width of ore will generally be found exposed in


, ,

t h e stopes .

It of t en happens in the case of a tlying veins that the l e vel


, ,

has been driv e n on th e footwall of the vein or that the level has ,

1
T A R i c k ard T h e S a mp lin g a nd Es tim a tion of Or e in ( 1 M ine p 1 74
. .
, , .
,

N ew Y ork ,
1 90 4 .
1 90 MININ G G EOLOGY .

groov e s cut at right angles to the plane of the d i p The thick .

n e ss of ore i s m e asured and recorde d on a d iagram in the e ld


b ook togeth e r wi t h th e sample numb e r at each int e rval
,
.

R e du c ti n o fo S a m p le Th e weight of th e sample broken


.

down will vary wi t h the wi dth a n d hardness of th e or e Wh e n it .

i s larger th a n t he capaci ty of th e sampl e bag th e sh ee t mus t b e -


,

carri e d to a convenien t plac e und e rgroun d and its con te n t s ,

broken down to the si z e of a walnut When this has b ee n don e .


,

t h e sampl e i s thoroughly m i xed formed i n t o a v e ry a t t runcated ,

con e and quar te r e d


, .

T wo opposi t e quart e rs ar e r e j e cted be i ng r e mov e d c o mp le te ly ,

with all th e ir nes from the sh ee t The ma te rial in the t wo .

r e main i ng quart e rs is th e n brok e n down t o a s i z e half th e d i am ete r


of a walnu t t horoughly mix e d and again quar te red Th e two
, ,
.

quar te rs ly i ng in the pos it ion of th e t wo quart e rs retained in th e


r s t op e ra ti on ar e r e j ec t ed a n d removed from th e s h ee t .

A common m et hod of mixing th e ore on t h e sampling sheet i s -

to toss the material from one s i de to th e other I n th i s process .

care must b e t aken to insure that th e n e s are not concentrate d


in on e particular par t of th e sample but e v e nly distribu t ed ,

t hroughout the whole mass before e ach quart e ring .

I n thr ee qu a r te rin g s a sample w eigh i ng 8 0 lbs will thus be


-
,
. .

cu t down to 1 0 1b s which is about the maximum capacity of th e


.
,

sampl e bags .

The t im e required to break down a sampl e will depend upon


th e hardness and s i ze of the lode I t seldom i s l e s s than half an .

hour a n d may ext e nd to several hou rs depend i n g upon th e


, ,

number of quar t e rings needed to reduce th e sample to a conv e nien t


we i ght Th e sampling of a large mine may occupy several week s
.
,

a n d run into a cost of sev e ral hundred pounds .

A s s a y O f S a m p le s The whol e of t h e sampl e should be dri e d


. ,

crush e d in a rock breaker in t he laboratory to pass through a


-

10 m e sh sieve mixe d a n d sampled by quartering t ill reduc e d to


-
, ,

a pound or t wo in w ei ght all of which sho u ld be n a lly p u lver i sed


, ,

pass e d t hrough a 60 mesh si e ve again mixed and d ivided into


-

, ,

two portions On e portion is handed to th e assayer wh i l e t h e


.
,

o t her is r e tain e d as a duplicat e sample for subsequent referenc e


and v e r i c a t ion if the n e c e ssity should aris e .

Carelessn e ss in the labora t ory may stultify all the care exercis e d
in the sampling underground .

I f th e mi n e examiner submit his samples to an assayer whos e


-

q u a l i c a t io n s are unknown to him he should ta ke car e t o be ,

pr e sent dur i ng th e crushing pulverising and n a l division of th e


, ,

assay sampl e s .

The d upl i ca t e sampl e s should be put in t o small cal i co or s tou t


MIN E S A M P L IN G A N D
-
O RE V A LU AT I O N . 1 91

brown pa per bags lab e ll e d


-
,
s e cured in a lock u p sack which
,
and -
,

shoul d b e remov e d from the labora to ry .

Th e e xam i ner s sampl e s shoul d never b e submitt ed to th e min e


assayer 5 a n d only i n very exc e p ti onal c i rcums t anc e s shoul d t h e


sampl e s b e placed in th e han ds of an unknown assayer .

C a l c u l a t in g A v e ra g e W id t h a n d Va l u e o f V e in Th e .

a s s ay valu e s may b e expr e ssed i n p e nnyw e ights of gol d per ton 5


-

p e rc e n tag e of m e tal 5 o r in the cas e of low valu ed gold or bul li on


,
-
,

t h e mon e y valu e may b e s ta te d i n dol lars or 8 ( l p e r ton


-
. . .

Th e th i ckn e ss of t h e or e is mos t conven ie n tly e xpr e ss ed in


i nch e s for v ei ns up to 8 f ee t or 10 fe et th i ck Tak e t h e cas e of .

te n sampl e s from a gold b e ar i ng v ei n as follows ,

A s s ay - val ue
p T o n in
er I n chd w t .

p Pe n ny w e h ig t s .

Th e av e rag e w i dt h i s foun d by di vid i ng t h e sum of t he wi dths


by t h e numb e r of sampl e s Th u s i n t his cas e we have T ? 35 6
.
3
,

i n ch e s av e rag e w i d t h .

Th e av e rag e assa y val u e is foun d by d ivi ding t h e sum of t h e


-

inch dwt by th e sum of t h e w i dt hs as un d e r :


-
. d wts .

p e r ton for a w i d t h of 35 6 i nches .

When a ve i n conta i ns t wo ban ds of payable or e se para te d by a


band of no valu e wh i ch cannot b e sorted ou t economically t h e
, ,

av e rage assay valu e is asc e r ta i n ed as follows


L et band A b e 1 8 inch e s wid e and hav e an as say valu e ,

of 2 per ton .

B 6 i nch e s wi d e and wor t hless .

C 1 2 inches w i d e a n d wor t h 3 p e r ton .

per 10 11
18
1 92 MININ G G EOLOGY .

I f it is practicable to sort out half of t he worthl e ss ban d then ,

t he av e rag e assay valu e of th e ore will be found as under

2 3S . 8d P . er t0

I n est i mat i ng the n e t p r o t in sig h t i n a block of or e i t is man i ,

f e st that th e r e covery valu e and not the assay value must form
, ,

th e ba s i s of th e calculation .

H ig h A s s a y Va l u e s A sample giv i ng an e xc e pt i onally


.

h i gh as s ay valu e may b e de alt with in d i ffe ren t ways It may b e


-
.

d i scard e d e n ti rely and not includ e d i n th e av e rag e 5 or asc e r t ain


t h e av e rage valu e w i t h i t include d and replace th e orig i nal e x ce p
,

t ion a l v al u e by th i s av e rag e and then calculate the average valu e


,

for th eaverage width .

F or e xampl e : F iv e Samples gave values of 10 dwt 2 0 dwt .


,
.
,

2 5 d wt 1 2 0 dwt and 2 5 dwt per ton


.
,
.
,
The av e rage i s 4 0 dw t
. . .

Replac e the exc e pt i onal val u e 12 0 dwt by 4 0 dwt and then


, .
,
.
,

proc e ed with t he calculation of resul t s .

Th e exc e ptional value may r e present a small patch of rich or e ,

or a bunch of rich ore i ncreasing in d i mensions going upwards or


downwards or e ven a soli tary speck of g ol d The most sat i s
, .

factory manner of d e al i ng with an e xc e ptionally r i ch assay from a


sampl e is to resample th e v e in a s e cond t i me T A R i ckard 1
. . .

also r e comm e nds the tak i ng of i n t erm e diat e samples as a fur t her
precaut i on against fraud or m i stak e .

F u tu re P r o s p e c ts When sat i sfac tory valu e s hav e b ee n


.

obta i n e d around a block of ground t he na t ural i nferenc e is that ,

th e area of ore is of the same approx i mate value .

E xp e r i enc e has shown tha t wher e a block i s e xpose d on four


si des such inference is fair and reasonable Wher e the block i s
, .

e xpos e d on three sid e s the infer e nce is op e n t o doubt .

B e fore arr i ving at a de n it e conclusion as to th e future


prospects of th e mine it i s advisable for th e e xam i ner or min i ng
,

e ngine e r to c ar e fully consider the following quest i ons


( )
1 I s there any chang e of rock formation enclos i
-
ng th e lode
in any part of the mine ? I f so what in u e n c e do e s ,

this change of country e x e rcis e upon the value of th e ore ?


( )
2 I s there any i ndication of barren zones of or e e ither 111 ,

depth or hor i zontal extension along the cours e of th e ,

lo de ?
( )
3 Ar e the values i n t h e zone of oxidation l i k e ly to be mam
ta in e d in the unoxidis e d portion ?

( )
4 What are the probab i lities of impov e rishm e nt i n d e p t h "
"

T A R i c k ard Z oe cit p 4 2
1
. .
,
. .
,
. .
1 94 MININ G GEOLOGY .

( )
a E ach block can now be sampled separately by p i cking
piec e s of or e from i ts four s i d e s .

r t h e ma te r i al e xcavat e d from th e t r e nch e s can b e wh ee l ed


( )
5 O
to a cl e an p ie c e of ground s pawl e d in t o small p i ec e s , ,

m i x e d and quart e r e d rep e at e dly unt i l a sampl e of con


,

v e n ie n t s i z e i s ob t ained B e for e e ach quart e ring th e


.

larg e r pieces of ore must b e brok e n to half th e ir diam ete r


i n th e pr e c e ding quartering .

r the mat e rial from the t r e nches can be crush e d in a rock


( )
0 O
break e r mix e d and quart e r e d down t ill th e assay sampl e
, ,

i s obta i ne d .

S a m p l ing H e a p s O f T ai ling s I f t he accumulation of .

ta i lings i s larg e i t should b e sampl e d i n separate s e c t ions as ,

larg e piles of sands are liabl e t o vary consi de rably in valu e i n


d iff erent parts .

Stake o ff the heap so as to divid e it in t o sections about 5


,

yards square M ak e a diagram in e ld book corr e spon ding t o


.
-

s e c t i ons
. Record t h e d i mensions of the sections and d i stinguish ,

e ach section by a l e tt e r as A B 0 etc , , , , .

Sampl e e ach section b e g i nn i ng with s e ction A


,

( )
1 W i th a sampling i ron tak e-
s ampl e s all ov e r the s e c ti on at ,

say every foot or two


, .

( 2 ) I f t h e r e is r e ason to b e li e v e tha t t h e values ar e not the


sam e from t op to bot t om put t he top mat e r i al into on e ,

bag a n d th e lower into ano ther 5 o r i f nec e ssary separat e , ,

sampl e s can b e taken for e v e ry foot of d e pth .

( )
3 I f th e r e i s no sampling iron availabl -
e holes ar e d u
g a t ,

int e rvals of e v e ry 4 f ee t or 6 f e et Th e san ds from t h e .

holes are whe e l e d to a clean place m i x e d a n d r e duc e d by , ,

quartering to a conv e ni e nt size .

I f r e quire d th e sand obtain e d from di ffe r e nt depths can b e


,

kept separate .

S a l t ing O f M in e s By
salting is m e ant the illegal
.

e nrichmen t of th e ore w ith th e obj e ct of giv i ng th e prop e r ty


,

a c t it iou s value .

Th e m i ne e xamin e r should be fam i liar with the m e tho ds adop te d


-

by unscrupulous p e rsons so as to b e abl e t o pro te ct t h e in te r e s t s


,

of his principals .

A common metho d i s t o t amp e r with t h e e xam i n e r s sampl e s ;


a n d for th i s r e ason t h e sampl e s shoul d always b e 111 saf e custody

unt i l th e assay r e sults are known .

Cas e s ar e known where th e sample bags have b ee n e nriche d -

befor e th e sampl e s were put into them It is t her e fore a wise .

precaution to k ee p t h e sampl e bags i n a lock u p sack unt i l th e y


- -
MIN E S A M P L IN G
-
AN D O RE-V A L U ATI O N . 195

are requir ed A n d e ven then it is advisable to turn each bag


.

i nside out and shak e vigorously befor e us e .

I n the case of gold mines sof t or e has bee n a rti c ially e nriche d
-
,

to a d e pth of a foo t or mor e wi t h a strong solu ti on of c h lori de

F raud has b ee n prac t ised on m i n e e xamin e rs by str e tc hes of -

rich ore havi ng b e en sk i lfully buil t i nto t he wall of a l e v e l a t


d i ff e r e nt i n tervals and a t t he work i ng fac e t h e j o i n t s b e in g ,

obscured by libe ral splashes of m u d I n t h e same way a rt i c ia l .

ou tcrops hav e b ee n prepar e d .

D umps of ore hav e b ee n stac ke d w it h ri ch ore on t he sid e s and


top surfa c e A n impos t ur e of this k i nd is a t onc e d isclos e d by
.

t h e proc ess of tr e nch ing wh e n procur i ng sample s for assay .

Sampl e s of gold wash i n te n de d for e xam i na ti on by panning


-

have b ee n e nrich e d e i t h e r b e fore or d ur in g th e wash in g by th e


, ,

ag e ncy of gold bea r i ng tobacco ash p e ll ets of clay a n d gol d


- -
, ,

b e aring n g e r na i ls The gol d obta i n e d from t h e pa n ning of gol d


-
.

wash or ta ilings sho ul d b e e xam i n e d un der th e m i croscop e .

Bul k sampl e s of ore hav e b e en sa lted dur i ng th e proc e ss of


t r e atmen t i n t h e ba tte ry e i t her by t h e ad diti on of gold or
,

Th e exa m in e r s samples may b e unlawfully e nriched a t any


stag e from t he break i ng of t h e mate rial i n th e m i n e to th e


assay i ng i n th e la b ora to ry S t rong solu t ion s of gol d chlor i d e
.

hav e b ee n inj ec te d i n to t h e bags w ith a syr i ng e a n d gol d du s t ,


-

adde d to t h e li t harg e a n d u x e s F raud is so e as i ly prac t ise d .

in t his s tage t ha t th e e xam i n e r should eit her suppl y h i s own assay


mate r i als or te s t t hos e plac e d a t h is di s posal .

I n t h e s e day s of min e valua ti on by sys te ma ti c sampl i ng cas e s


-
,

of s tac king or sa l ttng of t h e or e i n t h e min e ar e ra r e a n d e asily ,

circumven te d by th e wa t chful e xam i n e r But b e s i d e s cov e r t ac t s .


,

inte nded to b e gu ile t he e xamin e r m a y be m i sled by t h e s u p pr e s


,

s ion of i mpo r tan t dev e lopm e n t s or by t h e blocking u of work i ngs


p ,

wh e r e unf avourabl e r e sul t s m i gh t b e ob ta in e d .

Ou h i s pa r t t h e m i ne e xam i n e r mu s t b e car e ful no t to as sum e


-

an attit u d e of r e s t ra i n t a n d d i strus t toward s thos e conn e c te d w it h


th e manag e ment I n th e writer s e xp e r ie nce min e rs ar e a s
.

,

hon e st as mos t m e n ; a n d if t h ey som eti me s put th e b e s t si d e


befor e you it is mor e from a f ee l i ng of loyal ty to t h ei r e mploy e rs
t han a d el i bera te d e s i re to d e c ei v e Probably no t mor e than on e .

i n a hun dre d woul d w i lfully m i sl ead you or u s e un lawful m e an s ,

t o e nr i ch your s ampl e s Bu t t h e hundr e dt h man i s g e n e rally


.

a cl e v e r rogu e a n d needs clo s e wa t ch i ng 5 a n d beca u s e of t h i s


,

on e man you mus t tak e no r i sks eit her i n t h e min e or i n th e ,


CH A P T ER I " .

T HE E " A M I NA T I O N A N D VA L U A T I ON O F
M I N ES .

C O N T E N T s z V al uation of M eta l M i nes D e v el ope d M i n e s a n d G oi ng


Con r n Cl i ti o f O
ce s as s ca on re in a M i ne V al uatio n o f Coal Areas
Val tio o f A ll vi l Grou d
ua n u a n .

T HE payable ore in a vein or c oal in a s eam is manifestly a


certain n ite quantity 5 therefore the greatest c oa l e ld and largest
ore deposit must eventually see a day of exhaustion And if the

-
.

total quantity of ore or coal and the annual output are know n ,

the date of exhaustion is a matter of simple c al c ulation .

A mining property bl e ssed with a good constitution that is ,

e ndowed with a considerable quan t ity of valuabl e ore from the ,

dat e of discovery to th e point of e xhaustion naturally passes


through th e successiv e stages of infancy youth full grown m a n , ,
-

hood middle age old ag e and e xtinction


, , ,
.

I nfancy is th e discov e ry stage of mine e xistence 5 youth th e ,

dev e lopmen t stage 5 full grown the payabl e going conc e rn in th e ,

meridian of lif e 5 middl e age the going concern past the meridian 5 ,

old age the period of d e cad e nc e and exhaustion But all this is
, .

tru e only of the mine that survives the early stages of e xistenc e ,

and l i ves what may be termed a full a n d pr otab l e life leaving ,

an honoured nam e behind .

Som e min e s give promise of their later vigour ev e n in e arly


infancy a n d oth e rs tha t are weakly in i nfancy d e v e lop into a
,

robus t manhood T h e gr e at e st mortality t akes place in infancy and


.

youth S cores of promis i ng m i neral d i scov e ries ar e unabl e to sur


.

viv e th e stage of d e v e lopm e nt They n e ver becom e going conc e rns


. .

But sud de n exhaustion is not an affection pecul i ar to th e v e ry


old or the very young mine Th e re ar e many notable e xampl e s of
.

v i gorous mines coming to a sudden e nd through exhaustion of the


ore reserv e s i n a way not e xpec te d or provided for by the
manag e m e n t .

Th e m i ne e xam i ner will therefor e lik e t h e careful physic i an


-
, , ,

1 96
1 98 MININ G GEOLOGY .

has bee n located by the prospector and a l e gal title obtained


l e dg e ,

for the ground forming what may be term ed a s urfa ce sh ow 5 or


,
-

e claim has b ee n pegged out on p osition alon e no vein


( )
b that t h ,

or seam of valuable m i neral be i ng e xposed a t the surfac e .

A S u rf a ce S h ow I n th i s case th e outcrop has probably been


.

prosp e cted by trench e s and shallow shaft s su ff ic ie nt to disclose ,

t h e wid th d i rection of str i k e and d i p of the deposit


, , .

Hav i ng prov i d e d h i ms e lf w i th the best topographical and


g e olog i cal maps ob t a i nabl e the mine e xaminer will p ro c e e d w ith
,
-

h is exam i nat i on which will embrac e a considera ti on of th e


,

followi n g points

( )
1 The g e olog i cal f e atur e s .

( )
2 The phys i cal f e a t ure s part i cularly with r e f e rence to t he
,

subs e quent work i ng of t h e proper ty s hould t h e r e sults ,

warrant this course 5 note such po i n t s as th e ba cks ava i l


able that s if the vein can be work e d wa t er fr ee 5 bu t
i ,

,

i f not m e nt i on i f sinking is l i kely to b e w e t or dry


, ,

m i n e t i mber and wat e rpower ava i lable etc


-

,
.

( )
3 Sample the outcrop at di fferent points noting the width ,

of v ei n and p e cul i ar i ti e s of structure .

( )
4 Me ntion th e prox i mi ty or absence of valuabl e or worthless
, ,

min e s i n the dis trict .

( )
5 Make inquirie s as to past history of the e ld ob t aining ,

o f c ial stat i stics when possible .

( )
6 G a i n a p er son a l knowl e dge of th e local pe c uliar i t i es of the
o r e d e os it s in the n e ighbour i ng m i n e s e specially noting
p ,

v e in structur e average width and value of or e accessory


-
, ,

m i n e rals country rock in u e n c e of di fferent kin ds of


,
-
,

country faults i ntrusive dykes meth ods of trea tmen t


, , , ,

mon thly output m i n i ng costs etc ,


,
.

When once 0 11 the groun d th e mineexam i ner should make a ,

point of acqu i ring all th e gen e ral a n d part i cular informa ti on he


can ob t a i n for his future ref e r e nce and g u idanc e .

Th e r e sults of th e sampling and obs e rvat i ons may b e satis


factory but the e xp e ri e nced min i ng e ngine e r will b e careful not
,

to comm it h i ms e lf to a de n it e opin i on as to th e potent i al valu e of


the prop e r ty upon surfac e in di ca t ions alon e Th e young e ngin ee r .

must no t b e afrai d t o r e por t t o h i s pr i nc i pal s that t he d e v e lop


ment work i s in s u f c ie n t to e nable m e to form a de n ite op i n i on



as to th e probabl e valu e of th e property Th e e xp e rienced .

engineer n ds no dif c u lty in doing s o .

Bear in mind that th e outcrops of silv e r l e ad z i nc a n d copp e r , , ,

lod e s ar e of te n less valuable than they ar e at some depth below the


surface 5 whil e those of gold are in many cases m or e valuable .
T HE E X A MIN A T I O N A N D V ALU AT I O N OF M I NES . 1 99

Henc e w it h t h e former t h e j udgm e nt mus t b e gui de d mor e by


, ,

m i neralogi cal and geological cons i de ra ti ons t han by sampl in g .

I f t h e ou t crop values a n d g e n e ral surround i ngs ar e sa tisfac tory ,

th e e xa m i n e r w ill i n most cas e s b e warran te d i n r e comm e nd i ng


f urth e r d e v e lopm e nt work b ei ng under ta k e n i n ord e r to op e n up
t h e ground for a f u ll e r exami nation Th e m i n e e xam i n e r from .
-
,

his knowl e dg e of t h e groun d will b e abl e t o i n di ca te to h i s ,

principals th e na t ur e e x te n t and proba bl e cos t of s uch work


, , .

111 t h i s cas e it w i ll man i f e stly be to t h e i n t er es t of t h e i n te n d


ing purchasers t o acqu i r e a working op ti on ov e r th e prop e rt y for
a per i od of s ix nin e or t w e lve mon t hs or m a y be i f t h e work t o
, , , , ,

b e unde r tak e n is consi derabl e t wo y e ars ,


.

Th e dee d of op tion s houl d b e l e gally e xecu te d be t we e n th e


int e res te d pa rt ies 5 cl ea rly s p e c ify t h e term of purchas e a n d s ta te ,

wh i ch part y is un de r obl i ga ti on t o pay ren ts tax es royal ty and , , ,

comply with t h e labo u r r e gulations e tc dur i ng t h e curr e ncy of ,


.
,

t h e op ti on .

The v e n dor may som eti m e s r e qu i re an im m e dia te ca s h payment


of an agr e ed sum of mon e y on th e e xecut i on of th e d ee d of op t ion ,

such sum t o be cons i de r e d par t of t h e purchas e mon e y s houl d th e -

prope rt y be tak e n ov e r ; or h e may cov e nant that a c e rtain


s e c i e d s u m be spent
p i n m i n e d e velopm e n t eit h e r-
monthly or ,

dur i ng t h e whole p e r i o d of t h e op ti on a s a guarante e tha t t h e ,

work w i ll b e pros e cu te d w it h v i gour .

It should be r e memb e r e d how e v e r tha t t h e engin ee r for t h e


, ,

purchas e r i s g e neral ly t h e bes t j udg e as to wha t sum shoul d b e


s p e n t i n t he d e v e lopm e n t work n e c e ssary t o e nabl e h i m t o form a

r e liabl e opinion of t he value of th e propert y O u th e o t h e r hand .


,

t h e chanc e of do i ng good bus i n e s s shoul d no t b e lost by pursu i ng


a n i ggardly pol i cy w i th t he v e ndors Th e refor e e ach case mus t .
,

b e j udg e d on its own m e r it s .

S o far we hav e a ssumed tha t t h e surface ou t crops gav e


s u f c ie n t values t o warran t furt h e r de v e lopm e n t be i ng und e r
tak e n w it h a v ie w of op e n i ng up t h e groun d for a more cr iti cal
e xam i nat i on According t o t h e c on g u ra t io n of th e s urfac e a n d
.

pos iti on of t h e ou t crops t h e or e v e in w i ll b e prosp e c te d by lev els


,
-

dri v e n
e n d on t e along . t h
. e cours e of t h e or e body or by ,

cross c u t s and l e v e l s t h e r e from or by a shaf t or s haf ts


-
,
.

I n s e l e c ti ng th e s ite s for t h e afor e sa i d l e v e ls or shaf ts i t i s i n


mos t cas e s a dvisabl e t o k ee p i n m i n d t h e poss ib i li ty of th e s e works
b ein g u ti li s ed i n th e p e rman e n t work i ng of t h e m i n e should t h e ,

r e sul t s j us t ify t h i s cours e .

Aga i n th e surfac e ou t crops may be wor t h l e ss a n d t h e prosp e c ts


,

in s u f c ie n t t o warran t any expe n dit ur e on prosp e ct i ng O n t he .

o t h e r han d t he valu e of t he prop e r ty m ay b e so obvious tha t th e


,
2 00 MININ G GEOLOGY .

m i ne examiner is j u s ti e d i n r e comm e nding th e imm e diate


-

purchas e I n this cas e no prospe c ting should b e unde r tak e n by


.

th e e xamin e r until a r m Op tion of p u r ch a se has b e en acquir e d on


b e d rock t erms
-
.

Und e veloped properties of such obvious valu e are rare and ,

h e nc e e xtrem e cau ti on must be ex e rc i se d by th e e xaminer before


recomm e n ding an i mm e diate purchase L edg e s of silver l e ad ore .
-

and gossans of pyri ti c or e bodies hav e be e n d i scov e red in s i tuations


-

t hat left littl e room for doubt as to th e ir gr e at valu e e v e n from sur ,

face sampl i ng and examination 5 and th e sam e h a s proved t ru e of not


a few valuable deposits of magnetite sp e cular iron and manganes e , , .

Bu t e ven if the exam i ner have the immediate purchase of the


property in h i s mind h e will seldom hav e much dif c u lty in
,

obta i n i ng the right (under an opt i on of purchas e ) to sp e nd a


mon t h or two in sampling a n d surv ey i ng preparato ry to the

completion of the purchas e .

P egg ed on P os ition This is generally an un de v e lop e d property


.
,

often possess i ng no surface ind i cations of valuabl e ore or mineral .

I t is how e ver not on all fours with th e cases we have already


, ,
-

d i scuss e d I n som e cases position means e verything 5 in othe rs


.
,

nothing F or exampl e an ar e a surrounded by working coal m i nes


.
,
~

iron mines or oil wells occurring in the same formation in the


-
,
-
,

FI G

. 74 .
S ectio n o f Val ble Bedded D po it
ua e s .

absence of faults or igneous dykes is an area already proved ,

valuable by its j uxtaposition to valuable mines Or a cla i m .

p e gg e d out on the strik e of a lode that has proved to be payable


up to the boundary i s a potentially valuabl e property O r a .

claim pegg e d out on the d i p of a a t lying lod e seam or b e d that -


, ,

has been proved to be valuable by th e outcrop m i nes i s a prope rt y ,

in the absence of great faults igneous dyk e s or a change of rock , ,

formation that may prov e to be of great value


, .

I n the above g u re A is an ou t crop cla i m assumed to b e


,
2 02 MININ G GEOLOGY .

( )
6 Particulars of ve i n outcrops prosp e c t ing work don e
-
, .

( 7 Values obta i n e d from sampl i ng .

( ) i scuss i on of general surroun di ngs


8 D .

( ) pinion as to futur e prospects a n d r e comm e nda tions


9 O ,
.

Thr ee cours e s may b e pursu e d accord i ng to th e circumstances ,

the property may b e


( )
a Rej e cted .

( )
b S e cur e d on working option .

P urchas e d .

I f th e e ng i n ee r r e commen ds t hat an opt i on b e s e cur e d he


should g i v e full d e tails of th e charact e r and ext e nt of the proposed
work i t s probabl e cost time r e quired for th e work its e ffe c t wh e n
, , ,

complet e d and proposed method of supervision


, .

D e v e l o p e d M in e s a n d G o ing C o n c e rn s Th e commercial .

valuation of a m i n i ng prop e rt y in th i s sta g e is based upon t h e


following cons i derations
( )
1 Th e quant i ty and valu e of or e de e Op ed, and quan t ity of
or e be ing d ev elop e d .

( )
2 Th e n e t p rot per ton .

( 3 ) Th e annual ou t put to yield a n et


p ro t per cent . 0 11 a
certa i n cap ital i sation .

( 4 ) The probable l i f e of min e .

Th e quant ity of or e that m i ght b e expected to b e Op e ne d up by


furth e r d ev e lopment work mus t not b e los t s i gh t oi But t h e .

quantity a n d valu e of such or e are unknown quanti ti es and th e ,

i mpor tance t o b e at tach e d to th e m i n calculat i ng th e mine val u e


must in e v e ry cas e b e d e t e rm i n e d by th e charact e r of t he
ore bo dy a n d the value of the or e alrea dy d e v e loped and won
-
.

I n all cas e s the fundamental basis of m i ne valuation is the ne t


p r in
ot s ig h t .

Som e ve i ns are notoriously patchy wh i l e others are e qually ,

consis te nt as m e tal produc e rs 5 hence 11 0 saf e rul e can b e laid down


-

as t o th e prosp e ct i v e valu e of un de velope d ground Th e local .

cond iti ons mus t gov e rn e ach cas e I t is how e ver well for t h e .
, ,

engineer t o r e m e mb e r that th e ore values of ve i n deposi t s are - -

mor e li able to sudd e n var i ation than thos e of b e dded de pos i ts .

As i n th e former cas e s th e min e e xam i ner will proceed t o th e


,
-

ground e qu i pp e d w i th th e best topographical and geological


maps obtainable ; also of c ia l reports a n d statisti cs if any are ,

ava i labl e .

When onc e 0 11 th e groun d t he e xam i ner will n d it a dv a n


,

t a g e ou s t o pursue t he follow i ng course of proc e dur e al though i t ,


T HE E X A MIN A T I O N A N D V ALU AT I O N 0

must b e clearly und e rstood t hat c i rcums tanc e s alter cases The .

suggestions g i ven h e re are general ra th e r t han special and must ,

b e m odi e d to su it th e n ee ds of each case


( )
a Car e fully exam i ne th e mine plan G e t t he min e manager
-
.

to e xplain th e general scop e a n d ext e n t of t h e un dergroun d


workings .

( )
b E xamine t he surface ou tc rops (ii any ) a n d no te the ,

geolog i cal and phys i cal fea tur e s .

( )
c E xamin e th e boundary l i nes and car e fully no te t h ei r pos iti on
-
,

w it h r e sp e c t t o th e dip a n d cours e of t h e v ei n or e body -

or s e am b e ing work e d i n t h e m i n e .

( )
d N ote the r e la ti on of th e u n de rg nou n d work i ngs t o th e
surface boundar ie s .

()
e Hav e a look at t h e or e coming to t h e surfac e also a t t h e ,

rock on th e d u m p .

(f ) E xam i ne and mak e a not e of t h e surfac e e qu i pm e n t i nclud ,

i ng mills and all m e tallurg i cal plant a n d appl i anc e s .

When d e s cr i b i ng s te am e ng i n e s g i v e t h e numb e r a n d
-
,

size of cylind e rs maker s name pressure of steam carri ed


,

,

by boiler e t c,
.

Th e rs t da y or t wo is spent in get t ing your bearings and ,

becom i ng ac qua i n t ed wi t h th e manag e r a n d no ti ng wha t mann e r


of a man he i s A f e w da ys occup i ed on t h e surfac e i n pr e
.

l i m i nary work i s g e nerally t ime w e ll sp e n t M ak e a not e of any .

fac t s presented or o ffer e d to you D o not no te O p i n i ons and 0 11


.
,

your side b e car e ful to o ffe r none .

(g ) E xamin e t h e u n d erground work i ngs accompan ie d by th e


m i n e manager or his d e puty According to t he e x t en t of
.

t he workings it may tak e a day 0 1 t wo to do t h i s


,

.

( )
11 Aga i n e xam i ne t h e m in e plans Y ou w i ll b e
. able t o follow
t h e m i n te llig e n tly fr om th e informat i on you have ga i n e d
undergroun d .

Y ou have now rea ch e d the cri ti cal stag e i n your e xamina ti on .

You have nex t to d ete rm i n e th e con diti on of t h e m i n e ; a n d


among th e qu e s ti on s tha t w i ll na t urally com e i n to your m i n d w i ll
be t h e follow i ng
( )
1 I s t h i s a young m i n e w i th a prosp e rous fu t u r e ahead of it ?

s thi s a young m i n e doom e d t o e arly e xhaus ti on ?


( )
2 I
( )
3 Has t h i s min e r e a ched i ts max i mum po i n t of pr od uction ?

( )
4 I s t h i s an old m i n e approach i ng e xhaus ti on ?
s t his an old mine with th e e y es p ic ke d ou t ?
( )
5 I

The answer to these questions is to be found in th e quan tity


2 04 MININ G GEOLOGY .

an d valu e of ore in s i ght D o not forget that in a vigorous w ell


.
,

manag e d m i n e the d evelopmen t work w i ll be commonly two years


ah e ad of the m i ll .

G underground with your own a ss is ta n t and sk etch out


o ,

your sch e me of sampling .

Sample the min e in a systemat i c manner This may take .

a week or s e veral weeks ac c ording to th e magnitude ,

of the workings and siz e of ore bodies ( The g e neral -


.

princ i ples of m i ne sampling are described in the chapt e r


-

treating of M in e sampling and O re


Complete your surface invest i gations G e t min e returns of .

output of ore an d values e xtracte d or of min e ral shipp e d ,

or exported min i ng and milling costs etc


,
Carefully ,
.

verify doubtful po i n t s .

Before leaving th e district make as c ompl e te an exam i na


ti on of the neighbouring mines as circumstances will
p e rmit noting character of country ore bodies being
, ,
-

worked general characteristics of said or e outpu t


, , ,

returns methods of treatment costs of mining a n d


, ,

m i lling .

Ou no account allow yourself to be hurried in your examination .

Tak e your own time Cultivate a deliberate temperament


. .

Base your est i mates on facts but be sure of your facts 5 a nd in


,

your report be car e ful to differentiate between facts and opinions .

Y our next care is the assay of your mine sampl es and in this ,

you must be gui ded by local considerations I f you are a skilful .

assayer it is pr e ferable for you to hir e an as say oice for a day or


,

two supply your own u x e s crucibles etc and perform your own
, , , .
,

assays 5 or your assistant will probably be able to do so for you .

I n whatever way the work of assaying is done it is imperat i ve ,

th at the results must be accurate and reliable .

( )
m Plot your assay values on tra c ings of mine plans and th e n -
,

consid e r th e results .

The form of your report will d e pend upon your r e com m e n da


t i ons M an i festly th e prop e rty may b e
.

( )
1 R e j ect e d .

( )
2 S e cur e d on option .

( )
3 Purchased a t onc e .

in your Opin i on t h e property should be rej ected it w i ll b e


I f, , ,

unnecessary to furn i sh elaborate details conce rn ing it B u t i f .


2 06 MININ G GEOLOG Y .

ta in e d in mo r e or l e ss rectangular blocks of limited size exposed


by workings on all s i d e s Th e y are only applied to or e that can .

be e xtracted and treated at a pr o t .

Th e phras e or e in s ig h t i s amb i guous and may m e an ore e xposed ,

0 11 o n e two or more s i des


, ,
I t may thus be misl e ading and should
.
,

th e r e for e be allow e d to fall into disus e .

A simpl e and clearly de n e d c las s i c a tion of ore is as follows


r e D e ve lop ed Blocks of ore exposed on four sides
()
i O . .

( )
ii O r e P a r tl y D e ve lop e d Blocks of ore e xposed on three or .

two sid e s .

r e E xp e cte d to be D e ve lop e d Blocks of ore that may be


( )
iii O '

r e asonably expected to exist beyond or below t he last


v i s i ble or e E xposed on one sid e . .

Philip Argall cons i de rs that th e thr ee phrases or edevelozyed ore


1
,

being dev e lop ed and ore e xp ec ta n t should cov e r all t h e estimates


,

a mining e ngineer i s called upon to make .

I n th e cas e of a v e in expose d by surfac e ou t crops only ther e ,

is no ore in sight notwithstanding that the valu e s may b e high


,
.

FI G . 76 . L ongitu dinal S e tion


c on Co r e o f L o de
u s .

t h e l e tt e rs a b e
in On e D tm ens zon I 76
'

Or e exp os ed . n fig .
, , ,

a n d cl r e pr e s e nt promin e nt outcrops on th e cours e of a lode .

The hollows between t hes e outcrops ar e assum e d to b e obscur e d


by ov e rburde n A numb e r of sampl e s s e lect e d at each ou t crop
.

show e d th e pr e sence of valuabl e or e M an i f e s tly any e stimat e of .

th e quanti ty of payabl e or e woul d b e m or e gu e sswork .

Ther e i s noth i ng t o show tha t th e payabl e or e i s con ti nuous


b e tw ee n t he di ff e r e n t ou t crops I t may or may not b e s o Again .
,

th e payable or e a t the d i ff e r e n t ou t crops may b e m e r e loca l


patch e s or the t runca te d r e ma i ns of a pay shoo t that may have
,
-

b ee n of considerabl e d i m e n s i ons pr i or t o th e later sculp t ur i ng o f

t h e country .

1
T A R i k rd T h S mp lin g
. . c a d E tim ti
, f O in M ie a
p 80 an s a on o re a n e, .
,

N w Y ork 1 90 4
e , .
T 1I 11 E X AM IN AT I O N A N D V ALU A T I O N or M I N ES . 2 07

I n th e above e xampl e we have t h e proof of th e rs t p rin cip le ,

i n accordance wi th wh i ch a n or e body e xp os e d in on e dimen sion -

a ff o rds no basis for th e e stima ti on or e in s ig h t .

O re exp osed in T wo D ime ns i ona We w i ll n o w assum e t ha t


surfac e e xcavat i ons hav e proved t h e con t inuanc e of th e pay shoo t -

from poin t s a to 0 g 7 7 and tha t a shaf t has b e en sunk on t h e


,
.
,

v e in at po i n t 6 to a d e pth of 60 f ee t .

FI G .
L o git di
n u nal S e tio n o f L ode
c .

Th e shaf t su n k at b e xposes t wo s i des or dim e ns i ons of th e


t riangles of ore a b e and c b e for a thickn e s s e qual to t h e w i dth
of t h e breast of or e e xpo sed in t h e shaf t .

Let a ft 6 ft and b e = 60 ft a n d t h e m e an
.
, .
, .
,

wi dth or th i ckn e ss of pay or e = 4 ft Assum i ng t ha t t h e payabl e


-
.

valu e s c on t inued to t h e bot tom of t h e shaf t w e hav e t wo t r i angl e s ,

of or e par t ly d e velop e d .

F rom th e above w e ge t the m i n i ng e ng i n e er s s e cond pr i nc i pl e

T h a t a n o r e body exp ose d in two d im ens ion s g iv es a tri a ng le of or e


-

only p a r tly de vel op e d .

Or e exp os ed on F ou r S ide s I n t his e xampl e a l e v e l has b ee n


.

driv e n on th e cours e of th e v ei n , a n d a r i s e pu t up from po i nt f t o


th e surfac e , a n d ano th e r ris e from 2 t o n Th e do tt ed l i n e 3 n 771 . .

s hows t h e lim it s of the pay shoo t on t h e w e s t s i d e of t h e shaf t


-
.

Th e or e de ve lop ed now i nclud e s th e r e c tangul ar block Z) 6 f c Th e .

i rr e g u lar block b s m e is e xpos e d on thr ee s i d e s , a n d th e r e for e


con ta i ns or e no t ful ly d evelop e d Th e r e l i anc e t o b e placed upon .

est i mat e s of valu e in t his block w i ll d e p e n d upon th e charac te r


is t ic s of the ore body a n d loca l con diti on s
-
Th e capac ity of th e s e .

or e bodies can eas i ly b e c alcula te d for any g i v e n wi dth


-
.

F rom the above w e g et th e th i rd pr i nc i pl e T h a t a n ,


o re- body

exp ose d in f om

dime n sion s g iv e s a r e c ta n g u la r a r ea o f or e

de vel op ed known app r oxi m a te m ea n wid th a nd v a l ue


f
o a .
2 08 MININ G GEOLOGY .

I t is manifest that three d i mensions do no t fu lly expos e a


rectangula r body of ore I f in t he abov e e xampl e we take sid e s
.

6 e e f and f e as th e known dim e nsions t hen t h e value of the


, , ,

triangle b k c is an unknown quantity Again if e b b e and e f .


, , ,

are th e known dim e nsions t hen th e t riangle of or e e h f is ,

unknown .

FI G . 78 .
-
L ongitu dinal S e ctio n o f L o de .

I n working mines with the d e velopment well in advan c e of th e


,

mill the lev e ls and rises by means of which the ore is cut up into
,

r e ctang u lar blocks for stoping a ffo rd four dimensions or sides for
e xamination and sa mpling .

O nly in exc e ptional c ases should the length of a block ex c eed


twice th e h e ight The smaller the blocks the more trustwo rthy
.

will be the estimates of or e de velop ed .

E stima tion f
o T onn a g e .
This is found
by div i ding the number
of cubic f e et of sol i d or e contain e d in the block by the number
of cubic fe e t of solid ore in a ton The number of cubic feet in a .

ton of ore depends on the specific gravity of th e or e and varies ,

from 1 2 to 1 5 cubic fe e t for a ton of 2 0 00 lbs .

I n m e asuring up ground which is f u lly d e veloped allowance must


b e mad e for faults dykes probabl e h or s es of rock and pillars of or e
, ,

that will nev e r b e tak e n out A d eduction of 10 per c e nt will . .

b e s u f c ie n t in most cas e s 5 but obviously no e mp i rical rule can


be laid down Th e c haracter of the ore body and contain i ng rock
.
-
,

and lo c al experience will a ff ord the safest gu i des to follow


, .

P r o ba bl e Or R e
e es rv es I n many cases the m i
. nee xaminer may
be j u s ti e d in assuming that the payable ore e xt e nds above 0 1

below the working faces or open gr ound I n this matte r he must .

exerc ise great caution His only guide is the general metalliferous
.
.
2 10 MININ G GEOLOGY .

I n the maj ority of cases t he e xaminer s r e port will d e al with

the following points


( )
1 S ituation and means of access .

( )
2 Area title
,
owners ,
r e nts or ,
royalty et c , .

( )
3 G eological structur e illustrat e,d wi t h cross s e c t ions -
.

( )
4 Phys i cal fea t ur e s with r e,
f e renc e to for e s t s ra i nfall wat e r , ,

pow e rs etc ,
.

( )
5 Th e area of c oa l e ld
( Th i s should
. b e shown on a colour e d
plan ) .

6) Thickness of seams and pr e senc e of ston e par t ings


, .

7 ) E xistenc e of faul t s and dyk e s .

( )
8 Probable tonnag e of coal 5 pr e s e nc e of r e c la
y and irons t one .

( )
9 Quality of coal I s it har
. d and strong or soft and friabl e ? ,

G ive an alys e s of coal state wh e th e r it i s us e ful for st e am ,

household gas sm e lting e tc purpos e s D iscuss pro


, , ,
.
, .

po rtion of sulphur pr e s e nt water ash et c , , , .

( )
1 0 S tate i f any portion of th e e ld lies so as to b e wat e r fre e -
,

and if s o what ar e a
, ,
.

( )
11 G iv e probable cos t of min e d e v e lopm e nt .

( )
1 2 Cost of su r fac e equipment .

( )
1 3 State probable cos t of produc t ion .

( )
14 State situation of mark et for coal access and probabl e ,

cost of transport of sam e .

( )
1 5 D iscuss e xtent of market probabl , e competition et c , .

( )
16 S tate the probable n et p r o t p e r ton .

I n an a r e a in wh i ch the quant i ty of coal i s d e duced from surfac e


outcrops and a f e w borehol e s it i s a ne e dless r e n e m e n t to at te mpt
to calculate t h e quant i ty of coal with math e mat i cal e xactn e ss .

Having determin e d th e approx i mat e ar e a and t h i ckn e ss of coal ,

and made du e allowanc e for brok e n coal along outcrop faults , ,

and dykes th e quantity of coal that can b e e xtract e d may be


,

c al c ul ated on the following bas i s


T o n s p e r A cre .

F or e v e ry foot of brown coal ,


10 0 0
p i tch coal , 1 10 0
b i t u m i nous coal 12 00 ,

cann e l coal , 1300


anthracit e ,
15 00

Seams of c oal a n d beds of shal e ar e sampl e d in th e sam e way as a


v e in that is by cu tt ing a narrow groove from roof t o o or a t r i gh t
,

angl e s to the plan e of t h e d i p Surfac e outcrops should b e dr e ss e d


.

down with a p i ck before th e sample is broken as ou t crop coal is ,

often wat e rlogg e d 5 and som eti m e s t he cracks ar e lle d with n e


sedim e nt or sand carried over t he exposure by running water or rain .
T HE E XA MIN AT I O N AN D V AL U AT I O N 0 11 MI NES . 2 11

VAL U AT I ON or A LL UV I A L G RO U N D .

Th e val u at i on of alluvial or placer depos its e ither for dr e dging ,

or hydraul ic sl ui cing i s a ff ec t ed by dete rm i ning th e amou n t of


,

gol d con taine d i n a m e asur e d quan tity of mater i al ob ta i n e d from


sh a f t s or boreholes placed a t reg ular i nterv als i n th e ar e a under
con s i de ration .

T h e Wor of S mp lzn g Fi rs t su r v ey the block of ground a n d


k a
.
,

plot it on pap e r to a larg e sca l e say 2 chains to th e inch for ,

areas b et w ee n 5 0 and 10 0 acr es and 1 cha in to the in ch for areas ,

und e r 5 0 a cr e s .

D ivi de th e ground on t h e plan in to bloc ks of 1 to 5 or 6 acr e s .

Th e shape of t h e blocks w i ll d ep e nd on t h e surface con tours ,

t h e di r e c ti on of th e dr a i nag e and t h e probabl e direction of th e


,

gol d leads
-
.

I n som e cas e s t h e ground i s a long narrow s t r i p s i t ua t ed on one


or bo th s i de s of a riv e r 5 in o t hers te rrac e lands i n a vall e y wh i ch , ,

ar e i n many cases in te rs e c te d by la t eral str e a m s .

M ak e a mark i n t h e c e n t r e of e ach block and th e n number t h e ,

blocks in cons e cu ti v e o rd e r Proc ee d to t h e groun d and put a


.

s tak e or ag i n th e c e ntr e of e ach bloc k Th e s e s takes mark t he .

s it e s of t h e sampling hol e s .

Th e dep t h of grav e l may vary from no t h i ng to 40 fee t or mor e i n ,

v e ry dee p groun d .

Wher e th e groun d is dry and no t d e e p i t i s cus tomary to sink


hol e s or shaf ts a t t h e s e l e c t e d po ints Th e whole of t h e ma te rial .

e xcava t ed from t h e hol e is car e fully measured i n a box of kno wn


capac ity w a shed by cra dl ing the gold con ten ts w ei ghed and t h e
, , ,

results r e c o rded .

Th e reco rd of each hole emb ra ces informa t ion on th e following


po i n ts
( )
1 D e p t h of ground .

t t e e f se b o t tom
( )
2 Character of botto m ha is wh th r slate or a l,
.

( )
3 Charac t er of grav e ls ( note pa rtic ul arly if b e d s of clay large ,

bould e rs or drif t ti mb er ex i s t in ground )


,
.

( )
4 Quant it y of mat e ri al excavated i n cubic yar d s plu s 2 0 pe r ,

c en t ( all t h e boul d ers bo t h small and gr eat must be in


.
, ,

cluded i n t h e measur e m e n t ) .

( ) Quan t i ty of gol d ob ta i ned


5 .

( )
6 Quan ti ty of gold per cubic ya rd .

I n ground wh e r e t h e si n king of hol e s woul d b e impe d ed to a ny


cons i d erabl e e xte n t by wa ter it i s usual to pu t down 5
,
inch or 6 i nch -

bor e hol es at t h e s e lected poin ts Th e holes ar e l i ned w it h tubing


-
.
,

a n d th e ma teri al ex t racted by t he san d p u m p c oll e cted in a ,

wood e n t rough w a shed a n d t he gol d conten ts w ei ghed


, ,
.
2 12 MININ G GEOLOGY .

Re c ord the depth of the hole a n d calcula t e th e cub i c cont e nts


,

from the outside diameter of t he p i pe plus 2 0 per c ent The ,


.

excess is add e d because experience has shown that the gold values
cal c ulat e d from the di splacement of the pipe alone ar e always
higher than t he actual r e turns This is no doub t larg e ly due t o
.
, ,

the c i rcumstance t hat a h i gher e xtraction or saving of the gold is


e ffe cted in th e sampl i ng t ests than i n actual pract i c e .

Wr ong M e th ods of S a mp ling The method of s e l e cting the test


samples from open fac e s or from the sides or oor of small
streams has often l e d to erroneous conclusions I n th e se places .

th e gold is generally mor e or less concentrated thus render i ng it ,

impossible for th e examiner to form an approximate estimate of


the average value of the gravels .

Pannings taken from t he to e of gr avel faces and from water


cou rs e s cut through th e gr avels are in t eresting but infer e nc e s ,

drawn from the gold ob t ained are usually v e ry misleading .

F urthermore it must not be inf erre d that a plac e r claim whi ch


,

r eturns good wag e s to a small party of working mates w i ll


necessarily pay dividends to a company working on a larg e scal e .

Working on a small scale the m i n e rs are always on the track of


t h e g old I f the lea d is lost the fact is known at once 5 but work
.
,

ing on a large scale where the shifting of quan t ity is an impo rtant
,

factor in order to insur e adequate retu r ns for the capital invested ,

ri c h and poor g ravels al i k e are moved th e reby reducing the ,

gen e ral average .

Cal cu la ting the A v er a g e Va lua Th e average value per cubic


yard is found by multiplying the numb e r of gr ains of gold per
cubi c yard found in each hole by the depth of the hole in feet ,

and dividing the sum of these produ c t s by the sum of the dep t h
in feet as follows
,

D epth o f Hole Gra i n s o f G ol d 3


1 1 0 3 113
F eet C bi Y rd 3
in .
p e r u c a .
I N DE" .

A G E S o f geol ogi l time 4 ca ,


. e i e
B lu carm n , 1 73 .

A ll v ial depo it m pli g d l


u s s , sa n an v a ua B lueg or u n d, 1 5 4 .

tio n f 2 1 12 13 o , . i o epo
B og - r n d s s, 22 it .

Al m 1 4 2 1 4 3
u , , . Bo z
n a n a s , 7 1 , 72 .

A l m i i m 14 4
u n u ,
. o t o o
B ra e f s da, d s s of 2 5
,
epo it .

A l m h ale 1 4 2 1 43
u s s, , . Bo rax , de osits of, 2 5 , 3 7, 1 4 7 .

A l ite 1 4 2 1 4 3
un , , . Bo i
r c a c i 1 2 3, 14 7
A am or ph i m 6 8
n s ,
. o ite o
B rn ,
c c u rr n c of, 42 , 5 8 e e .

A ata e 91
n s , . o e i
B s s s, 5 5 m n ral s f u nd in , 6 e o .

A de ite m i er l fo u d i 6 7 ;
n s s, n a s n n, , e o
B ras s s in c al , 30 .

f iti
a 7 ; prop y liti atio
n f 1 12
e s, s n o , ,
i e pi g
B r n s r n s a s nd ca rs f sal , 7 0 i i to o t .

o i eo i
Br m d f s l v r , ccu rr nc of, 4 4 e o e e .

A nth ra ite g fc 29 5 l ignite ,


a e o ,
B e
u n ch s , 7 1 .

ch ged to by ba al t 30
an ,
s ,
.

A ntim o n ite 1 44 , . C A I N O Z O I C period 4 ,


.

A nti m ony 1 4 4 , . C i r gorm a o iated With pp h i re


a n ,
ss c sa s,
Ap tite 1 77
a , . 22 .

Arge tite o rren e f 4 2 1 80 5 i


n ,
ccu c o , ,
n Cal mi ne 1 85
a , .

l o de 5 4 s, . C l ite verti al di trib tio f 7 6 5


a c ,
c s u n o ,

Ar eni c 1 4 4 1 4 5
s , ,
. q rtz p e dom orph f 91
ua s u s o , .

Ar e opyrite i
s n vein 6 1 1 4 4 ,
n or e s, , ,
C m brian g 4
a a e, .

1 4 5 5 m i er l a o iated with 8 4 n a s ss c , . Carbon a o iation o f prod ti ve ore


,
ss c uc s
A be to 1 4 5
s s s, . with 8 3 , .

A ph al tum 1 4 5 14 6
s , , . Carbon diox i de 1 15 1 2 1 1 34 , , ,
.

A gite a prod t o f o ntact meta


u ,
uc c C rbonation o f mineral 6 8
a s,

m orp h i m 1 2 7 s , . C rboni fero g 4


a us a e, .

Ca iterite S T i n tone
ss . ee s .

B A LK S ,
30 . C t y a oc iated with pph ire
a

s e e, ss sa s,
B ket
an ,
m d o e of o c cu rrence o f, 33, 22 .

Cell l o e ab orption o f opper


u s ,
s c by ,
B ry te 1 4 6 1 47
a s, , . 80 .

B l t affi ity f 7
a sa ,
n o , . Cem ent 1 4 7 14 8 , , .

B xite 1 4 2 1 4 3 1 44
au , , ,
. Cem e t pla er w ith g old 1 6 1 7
n c s , , .

B e he 71
nc s, . C em e t tion belt f 6 8
n a ,
o , .

Biotite h a ge f 91 ,
c n o ,
. Cer ite o rren e f 43 4 4
u ss ,
c cu c o , , .

Bi m th 14 7
s u , . C h l opy rite o rren e f 4 4 4 6
a c ,
cc u c o , , ,

Bit me S A ph lt m
u n . ee s a u . 58 5 i vei 6 1 5 verti l di
n ore ns, ca s

B l k b nd
ac 1 66
- a or e , . t ib ti
r f 7 5 5 mineral a o i t d
u on o ,
s ss c a e
Ble de i ont t depo it 3 9 12 7 5
n ,
n c ac s s, , with 8 4 , .

at Broken Hi ll 4 4 5 t B kto , a uc n, C h ly be te pri g


a i di tor o f
a s n s as n ca s

45 5 i ga h vei 52 5 i n s ns, n ore ir o 7 0 n, .

vei 6 1 5 verti l di trib tio f


n s, ca s u n o , Ch i tol ite a prod t o f onta t
as ,
uc c c

7 6 5 m i er l a o iated with 8 4 5 n a s ss c ,
m etam or ph i m 1 2 7 s , .

th mai o rce o f zi 1 85
e n s u nc , . C h im ey h oot 7 1
n -
s s, .
I N D E" . 2 15

Chl o ride o f ilver o ur e e f 5 8 s ,


cc r nc o ,
. D EEP l e a ds wi h g t old 1 4 15 1 6 , , , .

C hl ori t e min er l o iated with 84


, a s ass c ,
. D eep min i g s o n , lim it f 88 8 9 , , .

C h romi te m in eral a o iated with ,


s ss c ,
Denudati on 2 3 , ,
.

8 4 5 in peri dotite 1 0 8 1 30 5 i , ,
n Dev on ian a g e 4 , .

s erpentine 1 0 8 1 4 8 5 f 1 49 , , u se s o ,
. D i a base af n ities o f 7 , , .

C hro mi m 1 48 1 4 9 u , , . D iam o n d placers 2 1 1 5 7 , , .

C h ry l ite 1 4 5
so , . Diam onds ass oc iated With sa pp hires , ,

Ci n bar m in eral a o iated with


n a ,
s ss c ,
2 2 5 at Ki m berl ey 38 5 K im berley ,

8 4 5 depo it f 117 1 18 1 19 s s o , , , . diam o nd m in es 1 53 1 5 5 5 parent ,


-

C la ti ro k S S edim e t
s c c s . ee n s . 0 roc k 1 5 5 1 5 6 5 genes i s of 15 6 5
, , ,

C l y ab o rptive po wer f for metal


a ,
s o , , in do leri te 1 5 7 5 larges t 158 5 , ,

7 9 8 0 5 fo rm ation f 7 9 5 petro
, o ,
pply f 1 5 8
su o , .

le m ab o r bed by 8 0
u s ,
. D io rite f iti f 7 ,
a n es o ,

G oal origin f 2 72 9 5 m ode o f


,
o ,
Dip o f trata 2 6 2 7 s , ,
.

o c rre c e 2 9 5 g f 2 9 5 effe t
c u n ,
a e o c s Dip f ul t 98 a s, .

prod ed i byuc dy ke 30 5 n, s, D olerite di m ond i 1 5 7 ,


a s n, .

v rietie f 32 ; t
a i fo rma s o , s a es n D ow th row 96 1 00
n , ,
.

tion f 32 33 ; w orl prod tion D y b lo wi g pl



o , , s uc r -
18 n ace ls ,
.

o f, 1 49 . Dy ke 5 5 m i neral fo d
s, s un in , 6 5
C o l areas val ation
a , u o f,2 0 9, 2 1 0 . eff e t prod d by 30
c s uce , .

C o l e m po itio n
a s a s, s of, 2 9 5 ul fa ti n g
o f, 2 9, 3 0 . E A R T H evolution o f t h e
, ,
2 .

Cob t al , 1 4 9, 1 5 0 . Ec logite 15 6 ,
.

C obalt ore m i eral s, n s a ss o iated with


c , e ent di t b ti
El m f i s, s n u
'

on o , n th e
84 5 o rren e f ccu c o ,
15 0 . earth r t 10 7
s c us ,
.

Cob l ti e 1 4 9
a n , . Em bo l ite o rren e f 4 3 1 80 ,
ccu c o , ,
.

Col e m a n nite , 14 7 . E rgite o


na rren e f 6 2 ,
ccu c o , .

C oi
o ll ds , w r o f, po e to ab orb s m etal s, E o ene g
c 4 a e, .

80 . Equise tum s in C arbo i ferou n s ag e ,


C o m b tru tur e 6 7 s c , . 28 .

C o ngl o m erates 3 , . E m b esc ite oc rren e , cu c o f, 38 5 in


Conta t depo it 38 4 6 1 2 41 2 7
c s s, -
,
. ontac t dep it 39
c os s, .

C onta c t m et m orp h i m 12 4 12 7 a s , . Ex el io r diam o nd 1 5 8


c s , .

Copper occ rren e f 34 35 38 5


,
u c o , , ,

ore f in ontact depos it 4 0 ;


s o ,
c s, F A H L B A N D S 9 46 4 7 82 12 7 , , , , , .

ore f in ein 70 5 abs orption f


s o ,
v s, o ,
F h l e occ urren e f 4 2
a or ,
c o ,
.

by c ell l o e 8 0 5 in erpentine
u s , s ,
Fa l t in c oal eam 2 9 30 5 exte n t
u s, s s, ,

e tc 1 0 9 1 30 5
.
, o urc e nd pro , s s a f 3 0 5 alo ng vein
o ,
7 2 5 d n it i n s, e o ,

d c tion f 1 5 0 1 5 2
u o ,
-
. 93 94 5 dyn m i,
f 93 1 0 4 a cs o , ,
.

Copper gl n e in onta t depo it


-
a c c c s s, Fel pa r h an ge f to kao l i 5 8 5 to
s ,
c o ,
n,

39 5 in l od e 5 8 s, . topaz 1 8 4 ,
.

Copper in toc k works 38 5 in


ore s ,
Fern geo l ogi cal devel op m ent f 2 8
s, o , .

l od e 5 3 5 7 5 8 ; in erpe n ti ne
s, , , s F ir ec lay 15 8 , .

a n d oth er o k 7 2 7 3 5 pseudo r c s, , Flin tie s , 8 3 .

m o rp h o s after w ood 8 3 u , . o te
Fl a r , 6 7 .

C opp r py rite oc rren ce f 3 8 4 5 5


e s, cu o , ,
Fluca n , 7 2 .

in o nta c t depo it 39 1 2 7
c s s, , . o ite
Flu r ( u or s ar) 1 5 9 -
p , .

C opro lite o u rrence f 3 6 s, cc o , . o o


F l ds in c a l , 3 1 , 32 .

C o untry in n f n, vein ue ce o ,
o o re s, o e t o C bo i e o
F r s s f ar n f r u s a g e , 2 8 .

7 2 , 7 3 , 8 1 , 8 2 , 1 3 4 , 135 .

Co e
u rs s , 7 1 . G A L E N A in c ontac t depo its 3 9 1 2 7 5
,
s , ,

C eta eo g 4
r c us a e, . at Broken Hill 44 5 at B u c kto n , ,

Cr h zo e 4 2
us n ,
. 4 5 5 in gas h vein s 5 2 5 in o re ,

Cry ol ite 1 4 3 1 5 2 , , . vein s 6 1 5 vertica l di str ibu ti on o f


, ,

C llin an di m ond 1 5 8
u a , . 7 6 5 minera l s ass oc iate d with 8 4 5 ,

C prite o r ence f 38
u

, cc u r o , . p seu dom orp h s of a fter wood 1 1 6 , , .


2 16 I ND E " .

G arn ets as soc iated with g ol d 1 8 ;


, ,
Iron h a t 6 9 , .

minerals as s o c iated with 8 4 5 a ,


I ron ore in l imestone 73 , .

pro du ct o f c o n ta ct m etam orp h is m ,


Iron p y rite s in c ontact depo sits 39 , , ,

12 7 . 4 1 4 3 1 2 7 5 n ea r gran ite 4 1 5 at
, , ,

Garn ierite 173 ,


. B roken Hil l 44 5 in fahl bands 4 6 5 , ,

G aws 30 31 , , . in l o des 5 6 5 7 5 in ore vein s 6 1 ;


, , ,

G eo l ogi c al ti m e ,
2 5 period s of , 4 . verti cal di s tribu tion o f 75 76 , ,

G ol d form s o f al luvial 18 5 as so c i a tes


, , o x i dation of 7 8 5m in eral s a ss oc i ated ,

o f allu vi al 1 8 5 origin o f al lu vi al , ,
with 8 4 5 o ccu rrenc e of in s sure s
, ,

18 1 9 5 p rec ipitates of 19 2 0 5 in
, , ,
o f basalt 1 1 7 5 in m etam orph ic ,

th e R a n d b a n ket reefs 3 3 3 4 5 in , ,
ro ck s 1 2 7 5 gold reduc ed by 1 41
, ,
.

T readwell m i n es 37 38 5 in c o nta c t ,
Iro n ston e b l o ws 6 9 ,
.

depo s its 4 0 ; in s a ddle reefs 4 9 ,


-
,

5 1 5 in l o des 5 35 7 5 in vei n s 7 0 5 , ,
JU RA S S I C ag e, 4 .

in bo z 72 5 i l y 7 9 5 n a n as , n c a ,

i di ator bed f 82 8 3 5 m i er l
n c s or, ,
n a s I
KA O L N , 1 5 8 .

a o iated with 8 4 5 i ande it


ss c ,
n s e s, Kt op i
a am r h s m , 6 8 .

water

11 4 1 15 ; i,
1 35 ; n sea ,
Ke ra rgy rite , 1 5 4 .

so r e prod tio
u c s, d y iel d f uc n, an o ,
Koh -i-n or d a m nd, 1 5 8 i o .

1 5 91 6 1 5 am pl i g d val atio s n an u n

o f all vi l depo it o nt i i g u a s s c a n n ,
L A N D origi n o f s u rfa ce features o f 2
, , .

2 1 1 2 1 3 . L a teral secretio n th eory of 1 341 41 , , .

G ol d ore e o dary enri h ment f s, s c n c o ,


Laurenti an a g e 4 ,
.

i zo e o f weath e i g 77 5 dim i
n n r n ,
nu Lava 5 5 m i n era l s fo und in 6
, ,
.

tio f with depth 81 8 2


n o , ,
. Lead ores o c curren c e o f 36 5 in , ,

G ol d p l er 1 0 1 9 1 5 9 1 6 0
ac s, , , . l o des 53 5 ,in l i m estone 73 5 ,

G o a 69ss n , . s o urc es a n d
y iel d o f 1 6 8 , .

Gr n ite ti
a i 6 5 l ,
i t i n ore n, c as s ca on L eader 75 , .

o f, 7 . L ead zi n c ores in c o nta c t depo s its


-
, ,

G raph ite , ag e 1, 2 9 5
0 for matio n of, 40 .

30 5 s o re u c s and u s s e of, 165 . Lepi do den dro n s in Carboni fero u s ag e ,


e
G rav l s , 3 . 28 .

e t og i o
G r a M u l d am nd, 1 58 . L ig n ite ,
ag e of , 29 5 m d o e of o c r c u
p
G y s um , depo it s s o f , 2 5 , 36 5 s o urc s e ren ce of , 3 2 , 33 .

e
a n d u s s o f, 1 6 5 , 1 6 6 . L i m esto n e ,
3 .

L i m o n ite epo it ,
d s s o f, formed by
HAD E of fault ,
93, 94 . de e di g water
sc n n s, 2 3, 2 4, 1 66 ,
H em tite
a a ,
in o e
l d s, 5 7 ; d epo it s s of , 16 7 .

1 6 6 , 16 7 . L o des ,
ch a ac r ters
53 58 5 w d h o f, -
i t
He ve o f t 99 100
a fau l s, , . o f , 6 3, 6 4 ; l n h o f , 64, 65 5 e gt
Hor ble de n prod t o f o t t n ,
a uc c n ac t ike
s r o f, 6 5 5 dip o f, 6 5 , 6 6 5
m et m or ph i m 1 2 7 a s , . dept h , 6 6 ; arra n m n f ma r ge e t o tte
H orn sil v e r . S ee Ke rargy rite . in , 66 , 6 7 ; r c v ry f l s , 101 eo e o ot
Hor e s s, 30 , 6 7 , 6 8 . 104 .

H y dra tion o f m i e l n ra s , 68 . L y c opo di u m s in C rbo n i ferou


a s ag e ,
H y dr oge l p h i de
n su , 7 9, 1 1 1 , 118 , 28 .

M A MASG . S ee Pl to i ro k u n c c s .

I G N E OU S ro c k s S ee Plu ton i c ro c k s . . Ma ma g ti c s egreg tio o f ore a n s, 10 6


I lmenite asso c iated with ti n sto n e
, ,
1 33 .

20 ; ge f 91 ch an o , . Ma g e ite 169
n s ,
.

I m preg tio 9 4 748 na ns, , . Ma g etite i bea h nd 1 2


n ,
n c sa s,

I di ator bed 82 83 1 6 0
n c s, , , . a o iated W th g ol d 1 8 5 with ti
ss c 1 ,
n
I o dyrite o c rren e f 43 4 4 ,
cu c o , , . o re ,2 0 5 in o nt t depo it 39 5 c ac s s,
Iro o r e d pro d tio f
n , s u c s an uc n o ,
1 66 m i neral s o i ated with 84 5
s a s c ,
cc

16 8 . r e e f i m gm
cu r n c 107 ; a o ,
n a as ,
2 18 I ND E " .

Po ket 7 1
c s, . timu us formation f 3 5 e rth
c o , a

s
Pot bl ow 30 3 1
-
s, , . r t hi cy form ed f 3 5 al tera
c us c o ,

Prim ry period 4 a
, . tion f 3 o , .

P e dom orph i m o f m ineral 8 9 91


s u s s, ,
. S erpenti ne m i eral a o iated with ,
n s ss c ,
P ilom ela e depo it f 2 3 2 4 1 6 9
s n ,
s s o , , , . 84 .

Py rite S Iron pyrite . ee s . ke o


S ha n c al , 3 0 , 31 .

Pyrol ite depo its f 2 3 2 4 1 6 9


us , s o , , , . e
S h al s , 3 .

Pyro xe e m ineral a o iated with


n , s ss c ,
i e ite
S d r , 1 66 .

84 . ii
S l ca , d epo itio
s ns of, 77 1 1 1- 1 1 7 5
P rr otite o
y h , c cu rren c e of ,
4 5 , 4 6 , 1 73, b o pti e po e o ge ti o
a s r v w rs f la n u s a nd
174, 1 75 5 in l d s , 5 7 ; o e verti cal p eie
u lv r s d , 80 5 pe o op
s u d m r h o f,
di t ib tion
s r u o f, 76 5 m ineral s te oo
af r w d, 1 1 6 .

a o iate
ss it c d w h , 8 4 5 in m eta i i
S lur an a g e , 4 .

m o r p i ro k h c c s, 12 7 . i e o e e
S lv r , c c u rr nc of, 3 5 , 3 6, 4 4 5 in
b oe ei
fah l ands , 46 5 r s o f, in v ns ,
QU A R TZ a gangue o f mi neral s 5 9
,
as , ,
i e to e
7 0 5 in l m s n , 73 5 in clay , 7 9 5
6 6 6 7 ; verti cal di strib u tion o f
, ,
o e
s u rc s a n d ie
y ld o f, 1 8 0 , 1 8 1 .

75 5 ab sorption o f o x i de o f i ro n i e e oe o t t epo it
S lv r l ad r s , in c n ac d
-
s s,
by p u lveru lent 80 5 m in eral s a s ,
o e ie
40 5 s urc s a n d y l d of, 1 81 .

s oc ia t e d with 8 4 5 p s eu do m orp h o u s ,
te
S la s , 3, 1 8 1 , 1 82 .

after calc ite a n d orth oc las e 91 5 ,


i ke i e
S l c ns d s , 7 2 .

depo s its o f c hal c edo n i c 1 13 1 1 4 , , ,


ip
S l s, 2 9 .

1 15 . S mal tite 14 9 .

Quartzite 3 , . o t i
S l fa a r c ac tio po
n ; e Hec ts of, in r
Qu i c k s i lver ,
s o ur e c s an d ie
y ld o f, 1 80 . i e
du c in g m n ral d epo its s , 1 1 11 2 3 .

Spe c u lario o t t epo it


r n , in c n a c d s s,
G
R EA L A R , v r ca l d s r u n of, e ti i t ib tio 39, 1 2 7 5 a p o t o egio
r duc f r nal
76 . et o p i
m am r h sm , 1 2 7 5 d epo it s s of,
ee t
R c n ag e , 4 .

e t ite o
R dru h , e e
c c u rr n c of, 4 2 .
p e r ry l ite , 1 79 .

R ege t i o
n d am nd, 15 8 . pi e o i te it ol
S n l , as s c a d w h g d, 1 8 .

ee e t
R v rs d fau l s , 94 . S tep-
t
fau l s , 2 9, 30 , 100 .

Rhy l o ite
,
a f n itie s o f, 7 . t b te e ti
S i ni , v r cal d s r u i t ib tio
n o f, 7 6 .

i e
R d r, 6 7 . to k o k
S c w r s , 9, 3 7, 3 8 .

o k te pe t e
R c s, m ra u r o f , 8 5 , 8 8 . t ike o t t
S r f s ra a , 2 6 .

Ru bies, o i te it ol
ass c a d w h g d, 1 8 5 t ike
S r t
fa u l s , 95 , 97
-
.

it pp i e
w h sa h r s, 2 2 . p i e o oppe
S ul h d f c r S ee C opper .

b p e
R u y la c rs , 2 1 , 2 2 . pyrite s .

ti e p e o o p o o
Ru l , s u d m r h u s f rm s o f, 91 . S l ph i de o f l e d
u S G le a . ee a na .

S l p h i de o f i lver
u S Arge tite s . ee n .

S A D D L E -B A C K S , 30 . S l p h i de o f zi n
u S B lende c . ee .

S addl e ee
r fs , 42 , 45 , 4 9, 5 0, 1 60 , S ul ph i de pre ipit nt o f g old 1 9
s, c a s , ,

161 . 78 8 3 1 4 1 ; verti al di tribu tio n


, , c s
t epo it
S al , d s s of, 2 5 . o f 75 7 6 7 7 7 8 7 9 5 o x i datio
, , f
, , , n o ,

ti g o i e
S al n

f m n s , 1 94, 1 95 . 7 8 5 fo rm tio n f 1 1 4 1 4 1 5 in a o , ,

p i g et o o
S am l n , m h ds f ore , 1 8 61 96 . s il i eou inter 1 2 1 5 i er ptive
c s s s, n u
S an ds , 3 . ro k 130
c s, .

to e
S ands n s , 3 . S l p h r depo it
u u f 2 5 2 6 37 1 11
,
s s o , , , ,

pp i e p e
Sa h r lac rs , 2 2 . 1 1 7, 1 1 8, 1 19, 12 0, 12 3, 12 4 ,
po ite p o
S ca l ,
a r du c f c n ac m a to o t t et su l ph rettedu h y dr g n o e as a n in

op i
m r h sm , 12 7 . dic at or o f, a nd
yi ld 7 0 5 s u rc s o e e
ee ite
S ch l ,
184 . of, 1 8 2 .

it
S ch s s , 3 . p io i e
S u l h u r d x d , 111 , 1 2 3 .

e o igi tio
S as , r na n o f, 2 p
S u l h ur c ac d , f rma i i on 0 tio
eo
S c ndary pe io r d, 4 S we llie s , 30 , 31 .

e i e t
S d m n s , rs t 0 1 1g i11 o f, 2 5 c on

Sy n e ite ,
a nitie s of, 7 .
I ND E " . 19

VE NS , r I n o igi o
f c av i s in , 6 0 ; a ge it e
of g ol d , o ur en e
cc r c o f, o
f ll in g o f, 6 1 63 5 u c r s o f, o t op -

68 , 6 9 5 c nd i n f m a ll c c o n o it o o et i
te t
n s of, 70 ; s n f c n n s , po itio o o te t
7 1 5 w a l l m v m n s o f, 7 2 5 s c n do e e t eo
,
8 58 8 . a ry e
nri c hm n of, 7 780 5 im e t
po e i
v r sh m n of , w h d e t
h , 80 it ept
82 5 r c v ry e o e o ot
f l s , 1 0 110 4 5
t
h eo r s ie o o to
f f rm a i n o f, 12 91 39 5
val u a n o f, 1 92 , 1 93 tio
ei
V n s , s s ul e , 9, 5 2 5 8 , 1 1 2 .

2 0 5 in l d s o e ,
ei g
V ns , as h , 9, 5 1 , 5 2 .

ei eg eg te
V n s , s r a d , 9, 4 8 , 5 1 .

e
V su vian ,
ite
and po
r duc f c n ac to o t t
cc of, 4 7, et o p i
m a m r h s m 12 7 , .

72 ,
84 5 WA N T , 30 .

p e do morp h o after orth o l e


s u us, c as ,
Water tion f 2 3 1 36,
ac o , , ,
-
1 40 5
90 5 i er pti e ro k
n u v 1 30 131 c s, , ,
w h en de e di g 2 2 2 4 1 3 7 sc n n ,
-
, ,
13 9,
1 32 5 o r e
s d y ield f 1 8 3 1 8 4
u c s an o , , . 1 4 0 5 at h igh tem pe ature r s ,
1 10
T itanifero us iro n in a d 21 5 i s n s, n 1 2 3 5 w h en a end ing 12 2 sc , ,
12 3,

b lt f 6 8
Wea t h e 1i n g ,
e o , .

Wol fram m i eral a o i t d with ,


n s ss c a e ,

8 4 1 84 1 85 5 o
,
rre e f 1 73 . cc u nc o ,
.

T o rmal ine
u ,
m ineral a o iated with
s ss c , Wo lla t nite a prod t o f onta t
s o ,
uc c c
metam o rp h i m 1 2 7 s , .

W od a pre ipit nt o f g ol d 1 9 5 o f
o ,
c a ,

h o rn il ver 8 3 5 o f opper o re 8 3 5
s c s,
p dom o rph o f g le a after
se u s a n ,

116 5 d f il i after 1 1 6 an o s ca , .

W l fenit 1 72
u e, .

Z e
l N o, s u rc s a n d o
y ield f 1 85 o , .

Z inc i lim e to e 7 3
ore n s n ,
.

Z ir on a o iated with g old 1 8


c ,
ss c , .

P R IN TE D B Y NE I L L A N D CO .
, L TD E D IN B U R GH .

You might also like

pFad - Phonifier reborn

Pfad - The Proxy pFad of © 2024 Garber Painting. All rights reserved.

Note: This service is not intended for secure transactions such as banking, social media, email, or purchasing. Use at your own risk. We assume no liability whatsoever for broken pages.


Alternative Proxies:

Alternative Proxy

pFad Proxy

pFad v3 Proxy

pFad v4 Proxy